2 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
3 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
4 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
5 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
6 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
8 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
9 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
10 . unwanted vertical space.
11 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
18 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
24 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
25 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
27 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
33 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
34 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
38 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
40 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
45 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
46 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
47 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
49 .set previousversion "4.97"
50 .include ./local_params
52 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
53 .set I " "
55 .set drivernamemax "64"
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
63 . provided in the xfpt library.
64 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
66 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
68 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
70 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
71 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
73 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
74 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
76 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
77 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
78 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
80 . --- Also one for multiple option def headings be grouped in a single
81 . --- table (but without the split capability).
84 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
88 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
99 .orow "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
109 .orow "$+1" "$+2" "$+3" "$+4"
114 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
115 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
116 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
118 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
119 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
123 . --- A macro for a plain variable, including the .vitem and .vindex
129 . --- A macro for a "tainted" marker, done as a one-element table
131 .itable none 0 0 1 10pt left
136 . --- A macro for a tainted variable, adding a taint-marker
142 . --- A macro for a cmdline option, including a .oindex
143 . --- 1st arg is the option name, undecorated (we do that here).
144 . --- 2nd arg, optional, text (decorated as needed) to be appended to the name
146 .vitem &%$1%&$=2+&~$2+
150 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
151 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
152 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
156 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
160 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
168 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
169 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
170 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
171 . --- ID that ties them together.
172 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
173 . --- head, or list-item.
176 &<indexterm role="concept">&
177 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
179 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
185 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
186 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
188 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
194 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
198 &<indexterm role="option">&
199 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
201 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
206 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
207 . --- head, or varlist item.
210 &<indexterm role="variable">&
211 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
213 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
219 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
223 . use this for a concept-index entry for a header line
225 .cindex "&'$1'& header line"
226 .cindex "header lines" $1
228 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
231 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
232 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
238 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
239 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
243 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
244 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
245 <revhistory><revision>
247 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
248 </revision></revhistory>
251 </year><holder>The Exim Maintainers</holder></copyright>
256 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
257 . These implement index entries of the form "x, see y" and "x, see also y".
258 . However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
259 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
260 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
262 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
266 <indexterm role="$2">
267 <primary>$3</primary>
269 <secondary>$5</secondary>
271 <$1><emphasis>$4</emphasis></$1>
276 . NB: for the 4-arg variant the ordering is awkward
278 .seeother see "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
281 .seeother seealso "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
284 .see variable "<emphasis>$1</emphasis>, <emphasis>$2</emphasis>, etc." "numerical variables"
285 .see concept address rewriting rewriting
286 .see concept "Bounce Address Tag Validation" BATV
287 .see concept "Client SMTP Authorization" CSA
288 .see concept "CR character" "carriage return"
289 .see concept CRL "certificate revocation list"
290 .seealso concept de-tainting "tainted data"
291 .see concept delivery "bounce message" "failure report"
292 .see concept dialup "intermittently connected hosts"
293 .see concept exiscan "content scanning"
294 .see concept fallover fallback
295 .see concept filter "Sieve filter" Sieve
296 .see concept headers "header lines"
297 .see concept ident "RFC 1413"
298 .see concept "LF character" "linefeed"
299 .seealso concept maximum limit
300 .see concept monitor "Exim monitor"
301 .see concept "no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis>" "entry for xxx"
302 .see concept NUL "binary zero"
303 .see concept "passwd file" "/etc/passwd"
304 .see concept "process id" pid
305 .see concept RBL "DNS list"
306 .see concept redirection "address redirection"
307 .see concept "return path" "envelope sender"
308 .see concept scanning "content scanning"
310 .see concept string expansion expansion
311 .see concept "top bit" "8-bit characters"
312 .see concept variables "expansion, variables"
313 .see concept "zero, binary" "binary zero"
316 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
317 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
318 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
319 . chapter "Introduction"
320 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
322 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
323 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
324 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
325 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
327 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
328 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
329 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
330 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
331 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
332 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
333 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
335 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
336 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
337 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
339 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
340 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
341 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
343 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
344 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
345 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
346 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
347 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
349 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
350 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
351 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
352 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
353 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
355 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
356 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
357 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
358 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
362 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
363 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
366 .cindex "documentation"
367 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
368 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
369 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
370 capable of showing a change indicator.
373 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
374 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
375 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
376 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
377 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
378 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
379 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
382 .cindex "books about Exim"
383 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
384 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
385 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
386 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
388 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
389 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
390 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
391 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
393 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
394 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
395 Debian-specific features in the file
396 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
397 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
400 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
401 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
403 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
404 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
405 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
406 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
407 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
409 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
410 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
411 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
412 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
414 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
415 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
417 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
418 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
419 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
423 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
424 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
425 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
426 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
427 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
428 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
429 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
430 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
433 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
434 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
435 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
439 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
442 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
443 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
444 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
448 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
449 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
450 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
451 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
452 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
453 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
454 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
457 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
458 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
459 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
460 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
463 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
464 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
465 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
468 .row &'exim-announce@lists.exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
469 .row &'exim-users@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list"
470 .row &'exim-users-de@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list in German language"
471 .row &'exim-dev@lists.exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
472 .row &'exim-cvs@lists.exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
475 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
476 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
477 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
478 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
479 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
482 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
484 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
487 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
488 .cindex "bug reports"
489 .cindex "reporting bugs"
490 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
491 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
492 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
493 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
497 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
499 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
500 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
501 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
502 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
504 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
506 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
507 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
509 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
510 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
511 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
513 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
514 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
515 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
516 here are top-level directories.
518 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
519 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
521 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
522 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
523 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
524 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
528 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
530 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
531 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
532 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
533 most portable to old systems.
535 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
536 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
537 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
538 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
539 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
540 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
541 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
542 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
543 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
544 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
545 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
547 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
548 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
549 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
550 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
552 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
554 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
555 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
556 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
558 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
559 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
560 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
562 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
563 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
564 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
565 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
567 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
569 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
570 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
572 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
573 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
576 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
578 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
579 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
580 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
581 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
582 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
583 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
584 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
586 .cindex "domainless addresses"
587 .cindex "address" "without domain"
588 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
589 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
590 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
591 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
594 .cindex "transport" "external"
595 .cindex "external transports"
596 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
597 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
598 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
599 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
600 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
601 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
603 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
604 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
605 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
608 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
609 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
610 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
611 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
612 a number of common scanners are provided.
616 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
617 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
618 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
619 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
620 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
621 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
624 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
625 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
626 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
627 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
628 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
629 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
630 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
631 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
632 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
633 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
634 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
635 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
637 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
638 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
639 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
640 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
644 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
645 .cindex "terminology definitions"
646 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
647 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
648 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
649 below) by a blank line.
651 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
652 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
653 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
654 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
655 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
656 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
657 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
658 rise to further bounce messages.
660 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
661 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
662 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
665 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
666 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
667 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
670 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
671 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
672 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
674 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
675 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
676 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
677 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
678 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
679 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
680 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
681 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
683 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
684 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
685 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
686 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
687 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
688 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
691 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
692 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
693 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
694 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
695 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
697 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
698 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
699 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
700 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
701 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
702 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
704 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
705 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
708 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
709 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
710 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
711 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
712 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
714 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
715 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
716 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
717 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
718 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
720 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
721 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
722 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
723 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
724 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
725 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
735 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
736 .cindex "incorporated code"
737 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
740 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
743 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
744 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE2 library, copyright
745 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE2 is not longer shipped with
746 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE2 shipped with your system,
747 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
748 &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
750 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
751 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
752 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
753 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
754 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
755 following statements:
758 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
760 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
761 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
762 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
764 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
765 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
766 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
767 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
768 restrictions applied to it).
771 .cindex "SPA authentication"
772 .cindex "Samba project"
773 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
774 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
775 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
776 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
780 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
781 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
782 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
783 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
784 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
785 conditions expressed therein.
788 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
790 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
791 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
795 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
796 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
798 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
799 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
800 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
803 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
804 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
805 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
806 details, please contact
808 Office of Technology Transfer
809 Carnegie Mellon University
811 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
812 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
813 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
816 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
819 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
820 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
822 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
823 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
824 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
825 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
826 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
827 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
828 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
833 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
836 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
837 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
838 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
839 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
842 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
843 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
847 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
848 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
849 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
850 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
851 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
852 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
853 software without specific, written prior permission.
855 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
856 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
857 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
858 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
859 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
860 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
865 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
866 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
867 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
868 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
869 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
873 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
874 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
875 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
882 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
883 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
885 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
886 "Receiving and delivering mail"
889 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
890 .cindex "design philosophy"
891 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
892 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
893 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
894 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
895 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
896 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
899 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
900 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
901 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
902 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
903 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
904 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
905 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
908 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
909 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
910 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
911 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
912 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
913 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
914 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
915 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
916 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
919 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
920 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
922 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
923 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
924 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
925 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
927 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
928 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
929 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
930 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
931 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
933 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
934 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
935 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
937 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
938 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
939 runs at the start of every delivery process.
944 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
945 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
946 .cindex "Sieve filter"
947 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
948 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
949 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
950 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
951 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
952 of filtering are available:
955 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
958 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
959 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
962 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
966 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
967 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
968 .cindex "format" "of message id"
969 .cindex "id of message"
974 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
975 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is 23
976 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
977 example &`16VDhn-000000001bo-D342`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
978 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
979 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
980 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
981 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
982 not always case-sensitive.
984 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
985 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
986 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
987 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
988 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
989 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
993 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
994 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
995 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
996 way of representing the date and time of day).
998 After the first hyphen, the next
1000 characters are the id of the process that received the message.
1002 There are two different possibilities for the final four characters:
1004 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1005 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1006 time of reception, normally in units of
1009 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1010 systems), the units are
1013 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by
1014 500000 (250000) and added to
1015 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 2 us (4 us).
1019 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1020 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1021 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1022 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1023 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1025 The exim_msgdate utility (see section &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>&) can be
1026 used to display the date, and optionally the process id, of an Exim
1030 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1031 .cindex "receiving mail"
1032 .cindex "message" "reception"
1033 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1034 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1035 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1036 there are several possibilities:
1039 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1040 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1041 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1043 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1044 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1045 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1046 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1047 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1048 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1050 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1051 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1052 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1053 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1054 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1056 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1057 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1058 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1059 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1063 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1064 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1065 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1066 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1067 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1068 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1069 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1070 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1071 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1072 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1073 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1074 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1075 users to change sender addresses.
1077 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1078 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1079 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1080 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1081 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1082 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1083 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1085 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1086 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1087 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1088 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1089 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1090 message is received.
1096 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1097 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1098 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1099 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1100 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1101 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1102 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1103 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1105 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1106 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1107 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1108 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1109 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1110 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1111 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1112 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1113 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1114 affect file system performance.
1116 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1117 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1118 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1119 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1120 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1122 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1123 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1124 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1125 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1126 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1127 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1128 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1129 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1130 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1131 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1132 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1133 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1137 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1138 .cindex "message" "life of"
1139 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1140 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1141 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1142 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1143 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1144 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1145 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1147 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1148 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1149 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1150 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1151 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1154 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1155 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1156 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1157 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1158 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1160 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1161 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1162 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1163 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1164 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1165 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1166 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1167 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1168 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1169 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1172 .cindex "journal file"
1173 .cindex "file" "journal"
1174 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1175 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1176 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1177 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1178 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1179 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1180 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1181 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1183 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1184 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1185 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1186 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1187 deliveries caused by crashes.
1191 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1192 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1193 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1194 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1195 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1196 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1197 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1198 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1199 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1201 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1202 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1203 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1204 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1205 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1206 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1207 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1208 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1209 the driver's features in general.
1211 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1212 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1213 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1214 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1217 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1218 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1219 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1220 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1221 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1222 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1224 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1225 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1226 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1227 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1228 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1229 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1231 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1232 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1233 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1236 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1237 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1238 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1239 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1240 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1241 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1242 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1243 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1244 configured to fail the address.
1246 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1247 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1248 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1249 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1250 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1251 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1253 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1254 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1255 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1256 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1257 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1258 the address is bounced.
1262 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1263 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1264 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1265 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1266 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1267 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1268 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1269 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1271 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1272 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1273 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1274 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1275 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1276 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1277 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1278 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1283 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1284 .cindex "router" "running details"
1285 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1286 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1287 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1288 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1289 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1290 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1294 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1295 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1296 original address ceases
1297 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1298 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1299 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1300 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1301 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1304 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1305 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1306 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1307 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1308 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1310 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1311 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1312 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1313 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1314 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1316 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1317 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1318 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1319 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1320 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1322 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1323 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1324 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1326 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1327 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1328 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1329 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1331 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1332 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1335 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1336 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1337 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1338 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1339 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1341 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1342 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1343 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1344 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1345 facility for this purpose.
1348 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1349 .cindex "case of local parts"
1350 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1351 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1352 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1353 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1354 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1355 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1356 routed addresses are shown.
1360 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1361 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1362 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1363 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1364 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1365 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1368 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1369 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1370 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1371 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1372 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1373 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1374 of any other conditions.
1376 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1377 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1378 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1380 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1381 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1382 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1383 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1384 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1386 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1387 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1388 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1389 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1390 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1392 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1393 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1394 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1396 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1397 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1400 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1401 of domains that it defines.
1402 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
1403 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
1404 A match verifies the variable &$domain$& (which carries tainted data)
1405 and assigns an untainted value to the &$domain_data$& variable.
1406 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1407 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1408 refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&.
1410 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1411 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1414 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1415 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1416 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1417 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1418 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1419 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1420 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1421 the set of local parts that it defines.
1422 A match verifies the variable &$local_part$& (which carries tainted data)
1423 and assigns an untainted value to the &$local_part_data$& variable.
1424 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1425 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1426 refer to section &<<SECTlocparlis>>&.
1428 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1429 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1431 If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1432 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1433 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1434 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1435 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1436 &$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1437 and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1440 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1441 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1443 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1444 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1445 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1446 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1447 remaining preconditions.
1450 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1451 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1452 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1453 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1454 could lead to confusion.
1457 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1458 set of addresses that it defines.
1461 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1462 specified files is tested.
1465 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1466 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1467 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1468 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1470 Note that while using
1471 this option for address matching technically works,
1472 it does not set any de-tainted values.
1473 Such values are often needed, either for router-specific options or
1474 for transport options.
1475 Using the &%domains%& and &%local_parts%& options is usually the most
1476 convenient way to obtain them.
1480 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1481 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1482 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1483 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1484 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1485 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1486 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1490 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1491 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1492 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1495 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1496 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1497 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1498 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1499 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1501 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1502 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1504 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1505 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1506 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1507 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1508 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1509 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1512 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1513 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1514 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1515 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1516 processed entirely independently of each other.
1518 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1519 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1520 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1521 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1522 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1523 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1524 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1525 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1526 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1528 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1529 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1530 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1531 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1532 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1533 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1534 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1535 addresses to the same domain.
1537 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1538 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1539 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1540 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1541 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1542 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1543 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1544 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1546 .cindex "queue runner"
1547 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1548 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1549 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1550 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1551 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1552 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1553 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1554 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1555 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1557 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1558 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1559 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1560 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1561 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1562 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1564 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1565 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1566 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1567 messages to other addresses.
1569 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1570 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1571 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1574 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1575 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1576 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1582 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1583 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1584 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1585 .cindex "queue runner"
1586 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1587 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1588 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1589 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1590 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1591 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1592 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1593 passed its retry time.
1594 You can run several queue runners at once.
1596 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1597 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1598 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1599 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1600 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1605 .subsection "Temporary delivery failure" SECID20
1606 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1607 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1608 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1609 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1610 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1611 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1612 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1613 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1616 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1617 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1618 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1620 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1621 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1622 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1623 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1624 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1629 .subsection "Permanent delivery failure" SECID21
1630 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1631 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1632 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1633 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1634 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1635 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1636 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1637 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1638 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1639 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1641 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1642 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1643 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1646 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1647 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1648 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1649 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1650 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1651 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1652 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1657 .subsection "Failures to deliver bounce messages" SECID22
1658 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1659 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1660 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1661 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1662 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1663 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1664 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1673 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1674 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1676 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1677 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1678 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1679 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1682 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1683 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1685 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1686 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1687 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1688 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1692 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1693 following subdirectories are created:
1696 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1697 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1698 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1699 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1700 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1701 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1702 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1705 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1706 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1707 that may be useful to some sites.
1710 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1711 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1712 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1713 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1714 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1715 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1717 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1718 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1719 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1720 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1721 overridden if necessary.
1722 .cindex compiler requirements
1723 .cindex compiler version
1724 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1727 .section "PCRE2 library" "SECTpcre"
1728 .cindex "PCRE2 library"
1729 Exim no longer has an embedded regular-expression library as the vast majority of
1730 modern systems include PCRE2 as a system library, although you may need to
1731 install the PCRE2 package or the PCRE2 development package for your operating
1732 system. If your system has a normal PCRE2 installation the Exim build
1733 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1734 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE2_LIBS
1735 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1736 or set PCRE2_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1737 If your operating system has no
1738 PCRE2 support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE2
1739 from &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
1740 More information on PCRE2 is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1742 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1743 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1744 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1745 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1746 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1747 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1748 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1750 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1751 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1752 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1753 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1754 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1755 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1756 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1757 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1759 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1760 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1761 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1762 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1763 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1764 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1765 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1766 Berkeley DB library.
1768 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1769 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1773 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1774 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1776 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1777 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1778 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1779 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1780 filename is used unmodified.
1782 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1783 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1784 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1785 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1787 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1788 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1789 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1791 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1792 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1793 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while,
1794 but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 5.&'x'&.
1795 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased,
1796 and Exim no longer supports versions before 3.&'x'&.
1797 All versions of Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1798 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1799 page with far newer versions listed.
1800 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1801 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1802 suited to Exim's usage model.
1804 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1805 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1806 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1807 operates on a single file.
1811 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1812 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1813 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1814 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1815 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1819 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1820 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1821 You can set USE_NDBM if needed to override an operating system default.
1823 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1824 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1825 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1826 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1827 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1828 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1830 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1831 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1832 in one of these lines:
1836 DBMLIB = -lgdbm -lgdbm_compat
1838 The last of those was for a Linux having GDBM provide emulated NDBM facilities.
1839 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1840 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1841 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1842 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1845 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1846 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1848 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1849 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1853 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1854 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1855 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1856 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1857 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1858 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1859 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1860 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1861 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1862 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1863 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1864 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1866 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1867 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1868 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1869 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1870 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1871 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1873 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1874 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1875 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1876 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1877 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1878 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1881 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1882 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1883 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1884 facilities, you need to set
1886 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1888 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1889 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1892 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1893 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1894 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1895 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1896 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1897 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1898 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1900 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1901 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1902 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1903 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1904 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1909 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1910 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1912 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1913 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1914 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1915 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1916 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1917 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1918 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1920 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1921 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1922 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1923 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1924 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1928 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1932 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1933 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1934 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1935 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1936 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1937 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1938 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1939 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1940 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1943 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1944 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1947 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1951 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1953 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1956 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1958 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1959 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1962 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1963 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1965 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1966 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1969 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1971 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1972 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1975 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1977 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1978 library and include files. For example:
1981 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1982 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1984 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1985 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1988 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1991 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1992 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1993 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1998 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
2000 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
2001 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
2002 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
2003 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
2004 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
2005 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
2006 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
2007 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
2008 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
2009 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
2010 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
2011 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
2014 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
2015 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
2016 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
2018 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
2019 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
2021 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
2023 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
2024 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
2025 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
2026 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
2027 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
2028 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
2032 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
2033 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
2034 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
2035 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
2036 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
2037 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2040 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2041 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2042 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2043 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2044 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2046 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2051 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2052 .cindex "lookup modules"
2053 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2054 .cindex ".so building"
2055 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2056 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2058 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2059 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2061 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2063 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2064 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2065 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2066 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2067 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2068 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2070 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2071 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2072 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2081 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2082 .cindex "build directory"
2083 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2084 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2085 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2086 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2087 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2088 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2089 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2091 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2092 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2093 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2094 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2095 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2096 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2097 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2098 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2100 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2101 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2102 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2106 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2107 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2108 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2109 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2110 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2111 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2112 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2116 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2117 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2118 given in addition to the short output.
2122 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2123 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2124 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2125 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2126 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2127 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2128 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2131 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2132 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2134 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2135 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2136 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2137 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2139 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2140 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2141 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2142 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2143 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2144 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2145 and are often not needed.
2147 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2148 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2149 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2150 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2151 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2152 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2153 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2154 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2155 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2158 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2159 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2160 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2161 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2165 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2166 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2167 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2168 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2169 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2170 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2171 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2172 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2173 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2174 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2175 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2176 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2177 containing the lines
2182 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2183 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2185 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2186 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2187 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2190 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2191 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2192 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2193 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2194 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2195 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2196 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2197 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2198 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2199 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2205 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2206 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2207 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2208 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2209 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2210 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2211 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2212 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2215 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2216 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2217 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2218 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2219 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2220 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2221 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2222 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2223 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2224 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2225 syntax. For instance:
2228 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2230 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2231 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2232 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2235 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2236 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2237 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2241 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2242 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2244 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2245 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2246 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2247 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2248 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2249 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2252 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2253 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2255 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2256 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2259 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2260 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2262 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2263 definition of all three of these variables into your
2264 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2267 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2268 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2269 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2270 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2272 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2273 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2274 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2275 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2276 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2279 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2280 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2281 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2282 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2283 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2286 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2288 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2289 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2290 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2291 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2292 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2293 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2297 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2298 .cindex "building Eximon"
2299 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2300 where the files that are involved are
2302 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2303 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2304 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2305 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2306 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2307 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2309 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2310 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2311 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2312 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2313 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2314 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2315 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2319 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2320 .cindex "installing Exim"
2321 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2322 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2323 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2324 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2325 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2326 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2327 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2328 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2329 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2330 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2331 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2332 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2334 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2335 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2336 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2337 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2338 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2339 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2340 alternative files, no default is installed.
2342 .cindex "system aliases file"
2343 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2344 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2345 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2346 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2347 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2348 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2349 and outputs a comment to the user.
2351 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2352 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2353 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2354 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2355 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2357 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2358 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2359 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2360 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2361 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2364 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2365 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2368 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2370 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2371 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2372 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2373 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2374 but this usage is deprecated.
2376 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2377 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2378 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2379 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2380 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2381 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2383 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2384 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2385 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2386 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2387 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2388 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2389 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2391 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2392 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2393 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2396 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2398 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2399 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2400 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2401 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2404 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2406 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2407 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2410 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2411 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2413 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2417 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2419 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2421 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2422 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2423 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2425 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2430 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2431 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2432 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2433 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2434 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2437 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2438 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2439 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2443 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2444 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2445 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2446 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2447 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2453 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2454 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2455 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2456 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2457 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2461 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2462 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2463 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2464 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2465 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2468 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2470 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2472 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2474 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2475 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2476 user agent. For example:
2478 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2479 From: user@your.domain.example
2480 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2481 Subject: Testing Exim
2483 This is a test message.
2486 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2487 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2488 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2490 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2491 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2492 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2493 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2494 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2495 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2497 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2499 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2500 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2501 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2502 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2503 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2505 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2506 .cindex "lock files"
2507 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2508 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2509 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2510 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2511 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2512 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2513 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2514 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2515 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2516 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2517 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2518 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2520 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2521 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2522 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2523 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2524 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2527 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2528 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2529 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2530 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2534 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2535 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2536 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2537 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2538 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2539 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2540 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2541 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2542 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2543 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2544 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2545 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2546 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2548 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2549 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2550 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2551 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2552 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2553 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2556 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2557 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2558 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2559 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2561 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2562 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2563 favourite user agent.
2565 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2566 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2567 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2568 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2569 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2570 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2574 .section "Running the daemon" SECTdaemonLaunch
2575 The most common command line for launching the Exim daemon looks like
2579 This starts a daemon which
2581 listens for incoming smtp connections, launching handler processes for
2584 starts a queue-runner process every five minutes, to inspect queued messages
2585 and run delivery attempts on any that have arrived at their retry time
2587 Should a queue run take longer than the time between queue-runner starts,
2588 they will run in parallel.
2589 Numbers of jobs of the various types are subject to policy controls
2590 defined in the configuration.
2593 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2594 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2595 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2596 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2597 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2598 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2599 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2600 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2601 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2602 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2608 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2609 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2610 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2612 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2614 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2615 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2616 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2617 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2618 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2620 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2622 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2624 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2625 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2626 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2631 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2632 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2634 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2635 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2636 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2637 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2638 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2639 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2640 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2641 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2642 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2645 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2647 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2648 were present before any other options.
2649 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2651 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2652 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2653 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2656 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2657 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2658 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2662 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2663 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2664 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2667 .cindex "queue runner"
2668 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2669 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2670 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2672 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2673 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2674 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2675 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2676 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2677 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2678 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2679 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2682 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2683 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2684 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2685 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2686 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2687 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2690 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2691 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2692 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2693 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2694 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2695 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2697 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2698 .cindex "envelope from"
2699 .cindex "envelope sender"
2700 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2701 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2702 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2703 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2704 users to set envelope senders.
2708 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2709 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2710 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2712 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2713 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2714 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2715 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2716 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2717 that are available to trusted users.
2719 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2720 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2721 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2722 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2723 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2725 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2726 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2727 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2728 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2730 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2731 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2732 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2733 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2735 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2736 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2741 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2742 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2743 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2749 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2750 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2751 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2752 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2753 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2754 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2755 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2756 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2758 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2759 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2760 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2761 . creates a man page for the options.
2762 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2765 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2771 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2772 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2773 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2774 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2777 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2778 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2782 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2789 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2792 .cmdopt -B <&'type'&>
2794 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2795 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2796 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2797 clean; it ignores this option.
2801 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2802 .cindex "queue runner"
2803 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2804 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2805 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2807 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2808 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2809 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2810 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2812 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2813 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2814 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2815 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2817 When a listening daemon
2818 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2819 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2820 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2821 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2822 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2823 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2826 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2827 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2828 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2832 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2833 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2834 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2835 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2836 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2837 .cindex reload configuration
2838 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2839 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2840 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2841 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2842 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2843 because these are reread each time they are used.
2845 Either a SIGTERM or a SIGINT signal should be used to cause the daemon
2846 to cleanly shut down.
2847 Subprocesses handling recceiving or delivering messages,
2848 or for scanning the queue,
2849 will not be affected by the termination of the daemon process.
2852 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2853 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2856 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2857 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2858 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2859 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2860 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2861 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2863 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2864 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2865 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2866 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2867 test data. A line history is supported.
2869 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2870 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2871 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2872 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2873 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2874 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2875 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2877 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2878 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2879 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2880 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2882 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2883 defined and macros will be expanded.
2884 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2885 available to admin users.
2887 The word &"set"& at the start of a line, followed by a single space,
2888 is recognised specially as defining a value for a variable.
2890 .cindex "tainted data" "expansion testing"
2891 If the sequence &",t"& is inserted before the space,
2892 the value is marked as tainted.
2894 The syntax is otherwise the same as the ACL modifier &"set ="&.
2896 .cmdopt -bem <&'filename'&>
2897 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2898 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2899 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2900 of a file. For example:
2902 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2904 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2905 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2906 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2907 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2908 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2909 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2910 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2913 .cmdopt -bF <&'filename'&>
2914 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2915 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2916 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2917 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2918 system filters are recognized.
2920 .cmdopt -bf <&'filename'&>
2921 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2922 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2923 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2924 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2925 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2926 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2927 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2928 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2931 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2932 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2933 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2935 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2937 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2938 variables that are used by the user filter.
2940 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2945 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2946 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2947 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2950 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2951 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2952 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2953 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2955 When testing a filter file,
2956 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2957 .cindex "envelope from"
2958 .cindex "envelope sender"
2959 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2960 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2961 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2962 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2963 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2966 .cmdopt -bfd <&'domain'&>
2967 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2968 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2969 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2972 .cmdopt -bfl <&'local&~part'&>
2973 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2974 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2975 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2976 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2977 actually being delivered.
2979 .cmdopt -bfp <&'prefix'&>
2980 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2981 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2982 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2985 .cmdopt -bfs <&'suffix'&>
2986 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2987 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2988 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2991 .cmdopt -bh <&'IP&~address'&>
2992 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2993 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2994 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2995 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2996 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2997 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2998 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2999 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
3000 after a full stop. For example:
3002 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
3003 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
3005 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
3006 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
3007 conversion to the canonical form is
3008 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
3010 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
3011 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
3012 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
3013 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
3014 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
3018 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
3019 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
3020 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
3023 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
3024 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
3025 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
3027 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
3028 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
3029 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
3030 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
3031 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
3032 session were authenticated.
3034 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
3035 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
3036 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
3038 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
3039 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
3040 specialized SMTP test program such as
3041 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
3043 .cmdopt -bhc <&'IP&~address'&>
3044 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
3045 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
3046 updating the callout cache database.
3049 .cindex "alias file" "building"
3050 .cindex "building alias file"
3051 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
3052 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
3053 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
3054 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3055 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3058 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3059 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3060 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3061 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3062 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3063 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3066 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3068 .cindex "querying exim information"
3069 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3070 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3071 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3072 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3073 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3076 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3077 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3078 recognised DSCP names.
3081 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3082 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3083 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3084 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3085 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3086 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3087 way to guarantee a correct response.
3090 .cindex "local message reception"
3091 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3092 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3093 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3094 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3095 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3096 if no other conflicting option is present.
3098 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3099 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3100 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3101 suppressing this for special cases.
3103 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3104 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3106 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3107 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3108 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3111 .cindex "message" "format"
3112 .cindex "format" "message"
3113 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3114 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3115 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3116 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3117 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3119 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3120 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3122 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3123 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3124 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3125 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3126 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3128 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3129 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3130 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3131 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3132 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3134 .cmdopt -bmalware <&'filename'&>
3135 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3136 .cindex "malware scan test"
3137 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3138 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3139 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3140 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3141 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3142 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3143 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3145 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3146 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3147 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3148 This option requires admin privileges.
3150 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3151 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3152 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3155 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3156 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3157 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3158 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3159 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3160 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3161 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3163 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3164 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3165 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3166 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3167 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3169 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3170 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3171 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3172 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3176 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3177 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3178 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3179 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3180 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3181 arguments, for example:
3183 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3185 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3186 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3187 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3188 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3189 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3190 users, the output is as in this example:
3192 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3194 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3195 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3197 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3198 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3199 backward compatibility.)
3200 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3201 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3203 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3204 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3205 name will not be output.
3207 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3208 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3209 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3210 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3211 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3212 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3213 written directly into the spool directory.
3215 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3217 exim -bP +local_domains
3219 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3220 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3222 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3223 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3224 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3225 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3226 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3227 that driver are output. For example:
3229 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3231 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3232 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3233 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3234 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3235 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3238 .cindex "environment"
3239 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3240 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3243 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3244 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3245 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3246 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3247 The output format is one item per line.
3248 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3249 the exit status will be nonzero.
3252 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3253 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3254 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3255 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3256 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3257 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3258 to allow any user to see the queue.
3260 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3262 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3263 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3266 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3267 .cindex "size" "of message"
3268 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3269 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3270 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3271 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3272 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3273 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3274 before the sender address.
3276 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3277 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3278 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3280 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3281 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3282 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3283 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3284 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3289 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3290 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3291 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3296 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3297 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3298 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3299 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3303 .cindex queue "list of message IDs"
3304 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but only outputs message ids
3309 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3310 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3311 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3312 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3315 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3318 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpi%&.
3321 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3325 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3326 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3327 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3328 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3332 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3333 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3334 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3335 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3336 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3338 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3339 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3341 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3342 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3343 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3344 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3345 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3346 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3347 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3348 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3349 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3351 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3352 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3356 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3357 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3358 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3359 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3360 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3361 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3362 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3365 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3366 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3367 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3368 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3369 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3370 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3371 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3372 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3373 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3375 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3376 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3377 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3379 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3380 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3381 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3382 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3384 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3385 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3386 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3388 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3389 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3390 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3391 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3392 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3394 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3395 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3398 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3399 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3400 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3401 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3402 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3403 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3404 messages to the MTA.
3407 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3408 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3409 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3410 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3411 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3412 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3413 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3417 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3418 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3419 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3420 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3421 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3422 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3423 the listening daemon.
3426 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3427 .cindex "address" "testing"
3428 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3429 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3430 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3431 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3432 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3434 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3435 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3437 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3438 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3441 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3442 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3443 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3444 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3445 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3448 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3449 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3450 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3451 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3453 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3454 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3455 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3456 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3459 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3460 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3462 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3463 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3464 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3465 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3466 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3467 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3471 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3472 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3473 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3474 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3475 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3476 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3478 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3479 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3480 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3481 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3482 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3483 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3484 dynamic testing facilities.
3487 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3488 .cindex "address" "verification"
3489 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3490 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3491 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3492 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3493 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3494 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3496 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3497 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3498 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3500 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3501 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3503 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3504 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3507 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3508 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3509 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3510 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3511 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3513 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3514 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3515 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3516 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3517 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3518 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3521 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3522 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3523 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3526 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3527 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3528 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3529 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3531 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3532 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3533 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3534 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3537 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3538 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3544 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3545 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3546 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3547 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3549 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3550 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3551 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3552 each port only when the first connection is received.
3554 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3555 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3557 .cmdopt -C <&'filelist'&>
3558 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3559 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3560 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3561 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3562 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3563 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3564 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3565 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3566 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3568 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3569 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3570 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3571 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3572 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3573 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3574 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3575 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3576 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3578 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3579 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3580 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3581 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3582 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3583 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3584 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3586 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3587 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3588 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3589 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3590 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3591 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3592 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3594 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3595 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3596 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3599 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3600 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3601 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3602 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3603 specified by this option.
3606 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3608 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3609 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3610 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3611 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3612 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3613 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3615 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3616 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3617 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3618 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3619 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3620 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3621 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3623 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3624 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3625 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3631 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3632 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3635 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3637 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3638 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3641 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3643 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3644 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3645 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3646 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3647 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3648 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3649 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3652 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3653 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3654 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3655 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3656 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3657 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3658 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3660 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
3661 .irow acl "ACL interpretation"
3662 .irow auth "authenticators"
3663 .irow deliver "general delivery logic"
3664 .irow dns "DNS lookups (see also resolver)"
3665 .irow dnsbl "DNS black list (aka RBL) code"
3666 .irow exec "arguments for &[execv()]& calls"
3667 .irow expand "detailed debugging for string expansions"
3668 .irow filter "filter handling"
3669 .irow hints_lookup "hints data lookups"
3670 .irow host_lookup "all types of name-to-IP address handling"
3671 .irow ident "ident lookup"
3672 .irow interface "lists of local interfaces"
3673 .irow lists "matching things in lists"
3674 .irow load "system load checks"
3675 .irow local_scan "can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3676 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)"
3677 .irow lookup "general lookup code and all lookups"
3678 .irow memory "memory handling"
3679 .irow noutf8 "modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing"
3680 .irow pid "modifier: add pid to debug output lines"
3681 .irow process_info "setting info for the process log"
3682 .irow queue_run "queue runs"
3683 .irow receive "general message reception logic"
3684 .irow resolver "turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output"
3685 .irow retry "retry handling"
3686 .irow rewrite "address rewriting""
3687 .irow route "address routing"
3688 .irow timestamp "modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines"
3689 .irow tls "TLS logic"
3690 .irow transport "transports"
3691 .irow uid "changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid"
3692 .irow verify "address verification logic"
3693 .irow all "almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&"
3695 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3696 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3697 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3698 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3699 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3700 turn everything off.
3702 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3703 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3704 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3705 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3706 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3709 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3710 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3711 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3712 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3713 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3716 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3717 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3720 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3721 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3722 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3723 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3724 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3725 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3727 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3728 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3730 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3732 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3733 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3734 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3735 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3738 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3739 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3740 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3743 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3744 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3745 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3746 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3747 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3748 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3749 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3750 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3753 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3754 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3755 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3756 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3757 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3759 .cmdopt -F <&'string'&>
3760 .cindex "sender" "name"
3761 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3762 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3763 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3764 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3765 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3766 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3768 .cmdopt -f <&'address'&>
3769 .cindex "sender" "address"
3770 .cindex "address" "sender"
3771 .cindex "trusted users"
3772 .cindex "envelope from"
3773 .cindex "envelope sender"
3774 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3775 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3776 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3777 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3780 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3781 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3782 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3783 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3786 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3787 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3788 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3789 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3790 examples of shell commands:
3792 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3793 exim -f "" user@domain
3795 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3796 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3799 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3800 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3801 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3802 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3805 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3806 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3807 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3808 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3809 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3810 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3813 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3814 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3816 control = suppress_local_fixups
3818 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3819 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3822 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3825 .cmdopt -h <&'number'&>
3826 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3827 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3828 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3832 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3833 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3834 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3835 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message.
3836 Solaris 2.4 (SunOS 5.4) Sendmail has a similar &%-i%& processing option
3837 &url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf),
3838 p. 1M-529), and therefore a &%-oi%& command line option, which both are used
3839 by its &'mailx'& command.
3841 .cmdopt -L <&'tag'&>
3842 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3843 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3844 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3845 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3846 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3847 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3849 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3851 .cmdopt -M <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3852 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3853 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3854 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3855 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3856 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3857 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3858 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3861 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3862 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3863 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3864 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3865 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3866 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3868 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3869 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3870 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3871 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3873 .cmdopt -Mar <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3874 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3875 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3876 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3877 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3878 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3879 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3880 can be used only by an admin user.
3882 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&&&
3884 &~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3885 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3887 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3888 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3889 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3890 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3891 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3892 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3893 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3894 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3897 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3898 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3899 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3902 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3903 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3904 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3907 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3908 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3909 to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3911 .cmdopt -MCG <&'queue&~name'&>
3912 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3913 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3914 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3917 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3918 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3919 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3922 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3923 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3924 which Exim is connected advertised limits on numbers of mails, recipients or
3926 The limits are given by the following three arguments.
3929 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3930 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3931 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3934 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3935 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the connection
3936 t a remote server is via a SOCKS proxy, using addresses and ports given by
3937 the following four arguments.
3939 .cmdopt -MCQ <&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3940 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3941 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3942 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3943 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3944 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3945 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3947 .cmdopt -MCq <&'recipient&~address'&>&~<&'size'&>
3948 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3949 by Exim to implement quota checking for local users.
3952 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3953 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3954 ESMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3958 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3959 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3960 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3962 .vitem &%-MCr%&&~<&'SNI'&> &&&
3966 These options are not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3967 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MCt%& option, and passes on the fact that
3968 a TLS Server Name Indication was sent as part of the channel establishment.
3969 The argument gives the SNI string.
3970 The "r" variant indicates a DANE-verified connection.
3972 .cmdopt -MCt <&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3973 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3974 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3975 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3976 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3978 .cmdopt -Mc <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3979 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3980 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3981 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3982 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3983 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3984 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3985 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3986 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3987 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3988 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3989 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3990 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3991 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3993 .cmdopt -Mes <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3994 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3995 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3996 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3997 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3998 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3999 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
4000 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
4001 This option can be used only by an admin user.
4003 .cmdopt -Mf <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4004 .cindex "freezing messages"
4005 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
4006 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
4007 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
4008 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
4009 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
4010 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
4013 .cmdopt -Mg <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4014 .cindex "giving up on messages"
4015 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
4016 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
4017 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
4018 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
4019 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
4020 is sent to the sender.
4021 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
4024 .cmdopt -MG <&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4026 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
4027 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
4028 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
4029 queue to the given named queue.
4030 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
4031 string to define the default queue.
4032 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
4033 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
4035 .cmdopt -Mmad <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4036 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
4037 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
4038 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
4039 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
4040 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4042 .cmdopt -Mmd <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4043 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4044 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
4045 .cindex "removing recipients"
4046 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4047 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4048 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4049 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4050 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4051 can be used only by an admin user.
4053 .cmdopt -Mrm <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4054 .cindex "removing messages"
4055 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4056 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4057 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4058 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4059 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4060 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4061 placed in the queue.
4066 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4067 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4068 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4072 .cmdopt -Mset <&'message&~id'&>
4073 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4074 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4075 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4076 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4077 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4078 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4079 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4080 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4081 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4083 .cmdopt -Mt <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4084 .cindex "thawing messages"
4085 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4086 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4087 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4088 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4089 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4090 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4093 .cmdopt -Mvb <&'message&~id'&>
4094 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4095 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4096 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4097 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4099 .cmdopt -Mvc <&'message&~id'&>
4100 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4101 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4102 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4103 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4104 only by an admin user.
4106 .cmdopt -Mvh <&'message&~id'&>
4107 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4108 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4109 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4110 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4111 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4113 .cmdopt -Mvl <&'message&~id'&>
4114 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4115 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4116 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4117 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4120 This is a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail
4121 (&url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf)
4122 p. 1M-258), so Exim treats it that way too.
4125 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4126 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4127 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4128 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4129 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4130 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4131 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4134 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4135 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4136 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4137 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4138 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4139 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4140 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4144 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4145 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4146 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4147 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4149 .cmdopt -O <&'data'&>
4150 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4153 .cmdopt -oA <&'file&~name'&>
4154 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4155 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4156 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4160 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4161 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4162 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4163 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4164 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4165 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4168 .cindex "background delivery"
4169 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4170 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4171 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4172 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4173 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4174 processes to finish.
4176 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4177 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4178 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4179 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4181 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4182 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4183 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4184 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4187 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4188 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4189 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4190 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4191 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4192 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4194 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4195 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4198 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4199 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4201 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4202 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4203 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4204 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4208 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4212 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4213 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4214 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4215 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4216 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4217 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4218 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4219 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4220 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4221 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4225 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4226 .cindex "first pass routing"
4227 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4228 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4229 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4230 configuration file is in effect.
4232 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4233 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4234 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4235 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4236 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4237 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4238 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4239 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4240 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4244 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4245 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4246 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4249 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4251 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4252 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4253 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4254 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4257 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4258 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4259 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4260 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4261 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4264 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4265 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4266 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4267 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4268 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4271 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4272 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4276 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4277 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4281 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4282 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4283 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4284 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4285 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4286 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4289 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4291 .cmdopt -oMa <&'host&~address'&>
4292 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4293 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4294 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4295 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4296 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4297 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4299 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4300 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4302 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4304 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4305 followed by a colon and the port number:
4307 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4309 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4310 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4311 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4312 whichever one is last.
4314 .cmdopt -oMaa <&'name'&>
4315 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4316 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4317 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4318 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4319 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4320 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4322 .cmdopt -oMai <&'string'&>
4323 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4324 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4325 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4326 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4327 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4328 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4330 .cmdopt -oMas <&'address'&>
4331 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4332 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4333 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4334 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4335 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4336 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4337 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4338 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4340 .cmdopt -oMi <&'interface&~address'&>
4341 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4342 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4343 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4344 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4345 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4347 .cmdopt -oMm <&'message&~reference'&>
4348 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4349 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4350 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4351 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4352 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4353 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4354 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4356 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4357 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4358 is sending the bounce.
4360 .cmdopt -oMr <&'protocol&~name'&>
4361 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4362 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4363 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4364 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4365 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4366 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4367 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4368 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4369 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4370 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4372 .cmdopt -oMs <&'host&~name'&>
4373 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4374 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4375 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4376 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4377 uses the name it is given.
4379 .cmdopt -oMt <&'ident&~string'&>
4380 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4381 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4382 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4383 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4384 used, when there is no default.
4387 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4388 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4389 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4390 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4393 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4394 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4395 whatever that means.
4397 .cmdopt -oP <&'path'&>
4398 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4399 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4400 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4401 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4402 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4403 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4404 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4407 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4408 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4409 This option is not intended for general use.
4410 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4411 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4412 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4414 .cmdopt -or <&'time'&>
4415 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4416 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4417 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4418 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4419 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4421 .cmdopt -os <&'time'&>
4422 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4423 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4424 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4425 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4426 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4427 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4430 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4432 .cmdopt -oX <&'number&~or&~string'&>
4433 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4434 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4435 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4436 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4437 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4438 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4439 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4440 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4443 .cindex "daemon notifier socket"
4444 This option controls the creation of an inter-process communications endpoint
4446 It is only relevant when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option is also
4448 Normally the daemon creates this socket, unless a &%-oX%& and &*no*& &%-oP%&
4449 option is also present.
4450 If this option is given then the socket will not be created. This is required
4451 if the system is running multiple daemons, in which case it should
4453 The features supported by the socket will not be available in such cases.
4455 The socket is currently used for
4457 fast ramp-up of queue runner processes
4459 caching compiled regexes
4461 obtaining a current queue size
4465 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4466 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4467 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4468 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4472 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4473 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4474 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4475 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4478 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4480 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4482 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4484 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4485 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4486 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4487 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4488 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4489 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4492 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4493 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4494 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4495 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4496 and &%-S%& options).
4498 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4499 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4500 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4501 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4502 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4503 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4504 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4507 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4508 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4509 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4510 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4511 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4514 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4515 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4516 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4517 this to be repeated periodically.
4519 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4520 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4521 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4522 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4524 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4525 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4526 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4528 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4529 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4530 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4531 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4535 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4536 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4537 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4538 .cindex "first pass routing"
4539 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
4540 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4541 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4542 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4545 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4547 the &%queue_fast_ramp%& option is true
4548 and a daemon-notifier socket is available
4549 then in the first phase of the run,
4550 once a threshold number of messages are routed for a given host,
4551 a delivery process is forked in parallel with the rest of the scan.
4553 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4554 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4555 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred.
4557 After the first queue scan complete,
4558 a second, normal queue scan is done, with routing and delivery taking
4560 Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4561 delivered down a single SMTP
4562 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4563 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4564 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4565 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4567 Two-phase queue runs should be used on systems which, even intermittently,
4568 have a large queue (such as mailing-list operators).
4569 They may also be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4572 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4574 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4575 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4576 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4577 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4578 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4580 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4582 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4583 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4584 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4585 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4586 their retry times are tried.
4588 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4590 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4591 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4594 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4596 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4597 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4598 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4601 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4604 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4605 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4606 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4607 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4608 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4609 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4610 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4612 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4613 will specify a queue to operate on.
4616 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4618 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4621 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4622 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4623 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4624 starting message id. For example:
4626 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4628 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4629 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4630 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4632 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4634 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4635 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4636 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4637 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4638 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4639 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4641 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4642 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4643 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4644 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4645 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4646 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4647 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4648 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4649 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4651 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4653 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4654 process every 30 minutes.
4656 .cindex "named queues" "queue runners"
4657 It is possible to set up runners for multiple named queues within one daemon,
4660 exim -qGhipri/2m -q10m -qqGmailinglist/1h
4663 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4664 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4666 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4668 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4671 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4673 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4675 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4677 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4678 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4679 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4680 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4681 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4682 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4683 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4685 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4686 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4687 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4688 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4689 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4690 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4692 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4693 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4695 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4697 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4698 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4699 applied to each queue run.
4701 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4702 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4703 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4704 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4705 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4706 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4707 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4708 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4709 address will be skipped.
4711 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4712 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4713 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4716 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4717 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4718 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4719 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4720 an arbitrary command instead.
4723 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4725 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4727 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4728 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4729 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4730 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4731 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4732 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4734 .cmdopt -Tqt <&'times'&>
4735 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4736 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4737 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4740 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4744 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4745 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4746 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4747 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4748 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4750 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4751 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4752 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4753 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4754 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4755 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4756 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4757 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4758 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4759 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4760 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4762 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4763 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4764 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4765 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4766 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4767 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4769 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4770 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4771 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4772 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4773 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4774 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4775 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4776 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4777 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4780 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4781 compatibility with Sendmail.
4783 .cmdopt -tls-on-connect
4784 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4785 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4786 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4787 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4788 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4789 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4793 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4794 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4795 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4796 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4797 set. Exim ignores this option.
4800 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4801 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4802 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4803 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4804 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4805 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4809 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4810 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4811 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4814 .cmdopt -X <&'logfile'&>
4815 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4816 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4818 .cmdopt -z <&'log-line'&>
4819 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4820 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4821 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4829 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4830 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4831 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4832 . creates a man page for the options.
4833 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4836 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4843 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4847 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4848 "The runtime configuration file"
4850 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4851 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4852 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4853 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4854 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4855 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4856 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4857 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4858 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4861 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4862 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4863 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4864 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4865 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4866 actually alter the string.
4868 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4869 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4870 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4871 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4872 existing file in the list.
4875 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4876 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4877 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4878 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4879 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4880 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4881 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4882 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4883 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4884 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4886 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4887 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4888 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4889 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4890 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4892 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4893 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4894 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4895 compromise the Exim user account.
4897 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4898 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4899 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4900 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4901 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4902 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4907 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4908 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4909 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4910 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4911 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4912 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4913 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4914 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4915 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4916 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4917 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4919 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4920 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4921 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4922 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4923 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4924 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4925 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4926 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4927 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4930 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4931 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4932 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4933 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4934 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4936 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4937 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4938 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4939 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4940 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4941 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4943 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4944 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4945 necessarily be discarded.
4946 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4947 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4948 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4949 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4950 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4951 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4953 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4954 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4955 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4956 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4957 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4958 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4959 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4961 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4962 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4963 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4967 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4968 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4969 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4970 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4971 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4972 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4973 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4974 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4977 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4980 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4981 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4982 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4984 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4985 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4986 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4988 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4989 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4990 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4992 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4993 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4994 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4995 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4998 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4999 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
5000 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
5002 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
5003 want to use this feature, you must set
5005 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
5007 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
5008 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
5011 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
5012 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
5013 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
5014 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
5016 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
5017 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
5018 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
5019 and does not introduce a comment.
5021 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
5022 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
5023 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
5024 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
5025 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5027 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5028 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5029 change settings as required.
5031 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5032 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5033 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5034 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5035 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5040 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5041 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5042 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5043 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5044 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5045 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5048 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5049 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5051 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5052 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5053 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5054 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5055 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5058 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5059 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5060 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5061 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5063 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5064 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5067 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5070 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5071 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5076 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5077 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5078 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5079 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5080 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5081 definition, and must be of the form
5083 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5085 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5086 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5087 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5088 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5089 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5091 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5092 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5093 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5095 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5096 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5097 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5098 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5099 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5100 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5101 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5104 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5105 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5107 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5108 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5109 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5110 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5111 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5112 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5115 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5116 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5117 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5122 MAC == updated value
5124 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5125 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5126 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5127 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5131 MAC == MAC and something added
5133 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5134 from a number of other files.
5136 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5137 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5138 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5139 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5140 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5145 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5146 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5147 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5148 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5150 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5151 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5153 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5155 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5157 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5158 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5159 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5162 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5163 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5164 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5165 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5166 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5169 The following classes of macros are defined:
5171 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5172 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5173 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5174 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5175 &` _EXP_COND_* `& expansion conditions
5176 &` _EXP_ITEM_* `& expansion items
5177 &` _EXP_OP_* `& expansion operators
5178 &` _EXP_VAR_* `& expansion variables
5179 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5180 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5181 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5182 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5183 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5184 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5185 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5186 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5189 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5192 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5193 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5194 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5195 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5196 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5197 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5198 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5200 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5201 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5202 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5206 message_size_limit = 50M
5208 message_size_limit = 100M
5211 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5212 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5213 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5214 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5215 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5217 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5218 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5219 in this line"& will always be true.
5221 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5222 to clarify complicated nestings.
5226 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5227 .cindex "common option syntax"
5228 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5229 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5230 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5231 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5232 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5233 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5234 space) and then the value. For example:
5236 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5238 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5239 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5240 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5241 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5242 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5243 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5244 word &"hide"&. For example:
5246 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5248 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5250 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5252 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5253 all instances of the same driver.
5255 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5256 that are found in option settings.
5259 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5260 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5261 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5262 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5263 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5264 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5265 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5266 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5267 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5268 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5269 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5270 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5275 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5280 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5285 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5286 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5287 .cindex "format" "integer"
5288 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5289 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5290 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5291 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5294 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5295 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5296 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5298 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5299 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5300 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5304 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5305 .cindex "integer format"
5306 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5307 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5308 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5309 Such options are always output in octal.
5312 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5313 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5314 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5315 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5316 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5320 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5321 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5322 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5323 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5324 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5334 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5335 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5336 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5340 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5341 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5342 .cindex "format" "string"
5343 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5344 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5345 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5346 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5347 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5348 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5349 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5350 therefore equivalent:
5352 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5353 trusted_users = uucp:\
5354 # This comment line is ignored
5357 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5358 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5359 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5360 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5361 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5364 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5365 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5366 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5368 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5369 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5373 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5374 character, that character replaces the pair.
5376 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5377 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5378 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5379 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5380 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5381 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5384 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5385 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5386 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5387 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5388 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5389 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5390 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5391 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5392 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5393 within a quoted configuration string.
5396 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5397 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5398 .cindex "format" "user name"
5399 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5400 .cindex "format" "group name"
5401 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5402 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5403 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5404 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5407 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5408 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5409 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5410 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5411 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5412 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5413 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5414 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5415 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5416 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5417 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5419 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5420 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5421 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5422 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5423 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5424 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5427 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5429 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5431 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5432 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The spaces around the first
5433 colon in the example above are necessary. If they were not there, the list would
5434 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5436 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5437 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5438 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5439 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5440 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5441 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5442 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5443 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5445 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5447 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5448 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5449 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5451 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5452 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5453 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5454 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5455 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5456 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5457 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5458 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5459 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5461 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5463 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5464 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5465 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5466 the value in quotes. For example:
5468 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5470 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5471 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5472 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5473 enclosing an empty list item.
5477 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5478 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5479 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5480 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5482 senders = user@domain :
5484 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5485 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5486 items, the second of which is empty:
5488 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5490 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5491 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5492 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5493 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5497 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5498 is at the end of the list.
5503 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5504 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5505 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5506 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5507 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5508 a sequence of lines like this:
5510 <&'instance name'&>:
5515 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5516 followed by three options settings:
5521 transport = local_delivery
5523 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5524 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5525 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5526 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5527 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5528 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5530 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5531 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5533 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5534 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5535 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5536 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5537 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5540 .cindex "generic options"
5541 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5542 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5543 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5544 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5545 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5546 .cindex "private options"
5547 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5548 they all have default values.
5550 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5551 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5552 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5554 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5555 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5556 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5557 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5558 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5559 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5560 configuration lines:
5565 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5566 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5567 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5568 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5574 command_timeout = 10s
5576 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5577 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5580 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5581 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5582 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5590 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5591 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5593 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5594 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5595 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5596 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5597 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5598 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5599 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5600 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5601 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5602 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5603 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5607 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5608 All macros should be defined before any options.
5610 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5612 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5614 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5615 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5616 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5617 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5619 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5620 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5621 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5624 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5625 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5626 in the file, after the macros.
5627 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5629 # primary_hostname =
5631 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5632 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5633 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5634 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5636 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5638 domainlist local_domains = @
5639 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5640 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5642 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5643 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5644 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5645 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5647 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5648 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5651 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5652 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5653 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5654 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5655 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5656 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5658 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5659 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5660 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5661 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5662 domain is permitted.
5664 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5665 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5666 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5667 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5668 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5669 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5671 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5672 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5673 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5675 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5677 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5678 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5680 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5681 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5682 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5683 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5684 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5685 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5686 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5687 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5688 contents of a message to be checked.
5690 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5692 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5693 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5695 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5696 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5697 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5698 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5700 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5702 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5703 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5704 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5706 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5707 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5708 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5709 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5710 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5711 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5712 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5714 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5716 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5717 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5719 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5720 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5721 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5722 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5723 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5724 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5725 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5726 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5727 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5728 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5729 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5730 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5731 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5732 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5733 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5734 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5736 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5737 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5738 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5739 which should be used in preference to 587.
5740 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5742 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5744 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5747 # qualify_recipient =
5749 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5750 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5751 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5752 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5753 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5754 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5756 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5757 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5758 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5759 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5761 # allow_domain_literals
5763 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5764 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5765 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5766 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5767 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5768 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5770 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5774 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5775 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5776 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5777 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5778 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5779 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5780 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5781 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5783 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5784 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5789 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5790 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5791 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5792 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5793 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5794 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5797 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5798 1413 (hence their names):
5801 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5803 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5804 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5805 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5806 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5807 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5808 information, you can change this.
5810 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5811 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5816 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5817 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5818 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5819 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5821 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5822 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5824 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5825 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5827 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5830 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5831 +tls_certificate_verified
5834 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5836 # percent_hack_domains =
5838 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5839 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5840 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5842 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5843 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5844 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5845 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5846 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5847 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5848 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5849 always bounce messages.
5851 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5852 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5854 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5855 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5856 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5857 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5858 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5860 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5861 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5862 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5863 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5864 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5867 # split_spool_directory = true
5870 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5871 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5872 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5873 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5874 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5875 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5876 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5878 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5881 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5882 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5883 that are not 8-bit clean.
5885 # accept_8bitmime = false
5888 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5889 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5890 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5891 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5892 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the &%timezone%& runtime
5893 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5895 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5896 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5900 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5901 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5902 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5903 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5904 It starts with the line
5908 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5909 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5910 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5912 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5913 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5914 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5915 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5916 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5917 result of the ACL processing.
5921 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5926 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5927 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5928 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5929 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5930 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5931 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5933 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5934 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5935 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5938 deny domains = +local_domains
5939 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5940 message = Restricted characters in address
5942 deny domains = !+local_domains
5943 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5944 message = Restricted characters in address
5946 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5947 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5948 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5949 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5950 in Internet mail addresses.
5952 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5953 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5954 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5955 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5956 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5957 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5958 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5959 policy of being as safe as possible.
5961 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5962 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5963 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5964 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5965 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5966 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5968 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5969 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5970 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5971 have to modify this rule.
5973 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5974 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5975 common convention of local parts constructed as
5976 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5977 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5978 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5979 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5980 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5981 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5983 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5984 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5985 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5986 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5987 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5988 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5989 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5991 accept local_parts = postmaster
5992 domains = +local_domains
5994 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5995 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5996 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5997 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5998 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6000 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
6001 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
6002 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
6004 require verify = sender
6006 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
6007 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
6008 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
6009 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
6010 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
6011 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
6012 discusses the details of address verification.
6014 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
6015 control = submission
6017 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
6018 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
6019 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
6020 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
6021 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
6022 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
6023 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
6024 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
6025 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
6027 accept authenticated = *
6028 control = submission
6030 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6031 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6032 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6033 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6034 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6035 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6037 require message = relay not permitted
6038 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6040 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6041 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6043 require verify = recipient
6045 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6046 fails, the address is rejected.
6048 # deny dnslists = black.list.example
6049 # message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6050 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6053 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6054 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6055 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6056 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6058 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6059 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6060 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6063 # require verify = csa
6065 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6066 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6071 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6072 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6076 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6077 of this ACL are commented out:
6080 # message = This message contains a virus \
6083 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6084 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6085 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6086 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6088 # warn spam = nobody
6089 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6090 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6091 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6092 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6094 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6095 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6096 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6097 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6098 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6099 whatever the spam score.
6103 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6106 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6107 .cindex "default" "routers"
6108 .cindex "routers" "default"
6109 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6114 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6115 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6116 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6117 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6118 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6121 # driver = ipliteral
6122 # domains = !+local_domains
6123 # transport = remote_smtp
6125 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6126 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6127 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6128 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6129 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6131 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6132 macro has been defined, per
6134 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6143 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6144 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6145 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6146 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6150 driver = manualroute
6151 domains = ! +local_domains
6152 transport = smarthost_smtp
6153 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6154 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6157 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6158 specified by the line
6160 domains = ! +local_domains
6162 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6163 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6164 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6165 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6166 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6167 passed on to the following routers.
6169 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6170 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6171 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6172 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6174 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6175 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6176 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6177 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6178 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6179 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6180 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6185 domains = ! +local_domains
6186 transport = remote_smtp
6187 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6190 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6192 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6193 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6194 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6195 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6196 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6198 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6199 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6200 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6201 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6202 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6203 the address fails and is bounced.
6205 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6206 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6207 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6208 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6209 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6210 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6211 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6218 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6220 file_transport = address_file
6221 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6223 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6224 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6225 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6226 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6227 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6230 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6231 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6232 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6233 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6238 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6239 # local_part_suffix_optional
6240 file = $home/.forward
6245 file_transport = address_file
6246 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6247 reply_transport = address_reply
6249 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6250 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6251 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6252 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6253 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6256 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6257 # local_part_suffix_optional
6259 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6260 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6261 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6262 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6263 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6264 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6265 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6267 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6268 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6269 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6270 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6272 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6273 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6274 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6275 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6276 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6277 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6278 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6280 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6281 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6282 There are two reasons for doing this:
6285 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6286 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6289 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6290 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6291 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6292 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6296 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6297 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6298 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6299 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6301 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6302 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6303 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6305 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6307 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6313 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6314 # local_part_suffix_optional
6315 transport = local_delivery
6317 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6318 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6319 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6320 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6321 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6324 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6325 .cindex "default" "transports"
6326 .cindex "transports" "default"
6327 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6328 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6329 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6333 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6337 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6342 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6343 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6344 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6345 with over-long lines.
6347 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6348 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6349 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6350 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6352 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6353 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6354 usual federated system.
6359 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6363 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6364 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6365 hosts_require_tls = *
6366 tls_verify_hosts = *
6367 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this this will have no effect,
6368 # but if you have to comment it out then this will at least log whether
6369 # you succeed or not:
6370 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6372 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6373 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6374 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6375 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6376 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6377 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6379 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6380 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6383 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6390 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6391 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6392 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6393 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6394 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6395 then no other options are defined.
6396 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6397 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6398 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6399 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6400 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6401 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6402 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6403 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6404 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6405 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6406 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6408 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6410 All other options are defaulted.
6414 file = /var/mail/$local_part_data
6421 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6422 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6424 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6425 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6426 Instead we use &$local_part_data$&,
6427 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6428 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6430 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6431 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6432 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6433 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6434 show how this can be done.
6436 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6437 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6438 similarly-named options above.
6444 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6445 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6446 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6447 be returned to the sender.
6455 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6456 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6457 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6462 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6467 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6468 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6469 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6470 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6471 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6472 introduced by the line
6476 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6479 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6481 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6482 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6483 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6484 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6485 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6487 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6488 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6489 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6492 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6493 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6497 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6498 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6502 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6503 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6504 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6506 begin authenticators
6508 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6509 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6510 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6511 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6512 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6513 to support most MUA software.
6515 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6518 # driver = plaintext
6519 # server_set_id = $auth2
6520 # server_prompts = :
6521 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6522 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6524 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6527 # driver = plaintext
6528 # server_set_id = $auth1
6529 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6530 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6531 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6534 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6535 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6536 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6537 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6538 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6539 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6540 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6541 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6543 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6544 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6545 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6546 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6548 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6549 usercode and password are in different positions.
6550 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6552 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6556 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6559 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6561 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6563 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6564 uses the PCRE2 regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6565 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6566 regular expressions is discussed in
6567 online Perl manpages, in
6568 many Perl reference books, and also in
6569 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6570 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6571 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6572 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6573 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6575 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6576 are supported by PCRE2 is included in the PCRE2 distribution, and no further
6577 description is included here. The PCRE2 functions are called from Exim using
6578 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE2 options set), except that
6579 the PCRE2_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6582 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6583 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6584 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6585 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6587 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6589 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6590 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6591 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6592 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6593 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6594 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6597 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6598 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6599 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6600 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6601 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6602 match anywhere in the subject string.
6604 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6605 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6607 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6609 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6612 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6614 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6615 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6620 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6622 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6623 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6624 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6625 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6626 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6627 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6630 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6631 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6632 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6633 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6634 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6635 The key for the lookup is &*specified*& as part of the string to be expanded.
6637 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6638 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6639 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6640 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6641 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6642 Depending on the lookup type (see below)
6643 the key for the lookup may need to be &*specified*& as above
6644 or may be &*implicit*&,
6645 given by the context in which the list is being checked.
6648 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6649 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6650 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6651 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6652 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6653 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6655 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6656 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6657 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6658 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6659 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6661 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6662 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6665 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6666 The key for an expansion-style lookup must be given explicitly.
6667 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6668 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6669 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6670 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6672 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6673 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6675 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6676 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6677 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6678 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a lookup expansion"
6679 The result of the expansion is not tainted.
6682 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6683 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6685 The file could contains lines like this:
6690 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6691 matches the list item.
6693 The key for a list-style lookup is implicit, from the lookup context, if
6694 the lookup is a single-key type (see below).
6695 For query-style lookup types the query must be given explicitly.
6698 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6699 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6701 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6703 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6704 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6705 causes a second lookup to occur.
6707 The lookup type may optionally be followed by a comma
6708 and a comma-separated list of options.
6709 Each option is a &"name=value"& pair.
6710 Whether an option is meaningful depends on the lookup type.
6712 All lookups support the option &"cache=no_rd"&.
6713 If this is given then the cache that Exim manages for lookup results
6714 is not checked before doing the lookup.
6715 The result of the lookup is still written to the cache.
6717 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6718 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6719 lookup is permitted.
6722 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6723 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6724 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6725 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6728 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6729 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6730 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6731 .cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6732 The file string may not be tainted.
6734 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6735 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a single-key lookup"
6736 All single-key lookups support the option &"ret=key"&.
6737 If this is given and the lookup
6738 (either underlying implementation or cached value)
6739 returns data, the result is replaced with a non-tainted
6740 version of the lookup key.
6743 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6744 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6745 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6746 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6748 For the string-expansion kind of lookups, the query is given in the first
6749 bracketed argument of the &${lookup ...}$& expansion.
6750 For the list-argument kind of lookup the query is given by the remainder of the
6751 list item after the first semicolon.
6753 .cindex "tainted data" "quoting for lookups"
6754 If tainted data is used in the query then it should be quoted by
6755 using the &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& expansion operator
6756 appropriate for the lookup.
6759 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6760 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6761 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6766 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6767 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6768 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6773 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6774 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6775 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6776 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6779 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6780 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6781 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6782 The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6783 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6784 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6785 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6786 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6787 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6789 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6790 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6791 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6792 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6794 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6795 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6796 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6797 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6800 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6801 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6802 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6803 Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6804 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6805 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6806 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6808 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6809 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6810 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6811 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6812 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6813 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6814 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6817 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6818 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6820 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6821 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6822 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6823 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6824 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6825 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6826 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6829 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6830 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6831 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6833 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6834 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6835 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6836 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6837 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6838 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6839 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6840 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6841 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6842 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6845 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6846 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6847 The given file must be an absolute directory path; this is searched for an entry
6848 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6849 The key may not contain any forward slash characters.
6850 If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6851 .cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6852 The result is regarded as untainted.
6854 Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6855 separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6856 each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6858 Two options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6860 The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6861 the entire path for the entry. Example:
6863 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6865 The default result is just the requested entry.
6866 The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6867 are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6868 not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6870 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6872 The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6875 An example of how this
6876 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6877 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6879 .subsection iplsearch
6880 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6881 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6882 The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6883 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6884 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6885 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6886 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6888 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6889 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6890 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6891 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6893 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6894 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6895 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6896 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6897 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6899 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6900 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6901 lookup types support only literal keys.
6903 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6904 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name
6905 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6907 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6908 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6909 notation before executing the lookup.)
6911 One option is supported, "ret=full", to request the return of the entire line
6912 rather than omitting the key portion.
6913 Note however that the key portion will have been de-quoted.
6917 .cindex json "lookup type"
6918 .cindex JSON expansions
6919 The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6920 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6921 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6922 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6923 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6924 of the JSON structure.
6925 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6926 nunbered array element is selected.
6927 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6928 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6929 or array; for the latter two a string-representation of the JSON
6931 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6937 .cindex database lmdb
6938 The given file is an LMDB database.
6939 LMDB is a memory-mapped key-value store,
6940 with API modeled loosely on that of BerkeleyDB.
6941 See &url(https://symas.com/products/lightning-memory-mapped-database/)
6942 for the feature set and operation modes.
6944 Exim provides read-only access via the LMDB C library.
6945 The library can be obtained from &url(https://github.com/LMDB/lmdb)
6946 or your operating system package repository.
6947 To enable LMDB support in Exim set LOOKUP_LMDB=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
6949 You will need to separately create the LMDB database file,
6950 possibly using the &"mdb_load"& utility.
6954 .cindex "linear search"
6955 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6956 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6957 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6958 The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6959 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6960 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6961 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6962 in the file is used.
6964 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6965 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6966 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6967 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6968 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6973 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6974 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6975 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6976 wildcarding of any kind.
6978 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6979 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6980 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6981 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6982 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6983 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6984 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6985 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6986 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6989 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6990 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6991 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6992 The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6993 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6994 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6995 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6996 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6998 .subsection (n)wildlsearch
6999 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
7000 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
7001 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
7002 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
7003 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
7004 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
7005 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
7006 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
7007 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
7009 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
7010 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
7011 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
7012 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
7015 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
7017 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
7018 *fish data for anythingfish
7021 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
7022 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
7024 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
7026 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
7027 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
7028 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
7030 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7032 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
7033 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
7034 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
7036 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7039 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
7040 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
7041 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
7042 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
7043 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
7045 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
7046 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
7047 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
7048 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
7049 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
7052 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
7053 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
7054 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
7057 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
7059 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
7062 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
7063 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
7064 be followed by optional colons.
7066 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
7067 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
7068 lookup types support only literal keys.
7071 .cindex "spf lookup type"
7072 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
7073 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
7074 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method).
7075 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
7078 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
7079 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
7080 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
7081 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
7082 many of them are given in later sections.
7085 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7086 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
7087 This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
7088 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
7089 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
7092 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7093 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7094 This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7097 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7098 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7099 This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7100 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7101 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7102 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7103 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7106 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7107 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7108 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7109 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7112 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7113 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7114 This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7115 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7118 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7119 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7120 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7121 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7124 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7125 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
7126 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7127 This is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7128 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7129 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7130 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7131 password value. For example:
7133 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7137 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7138 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7139 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7140 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7143 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7144 .cindex lookup Redis
7145 The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7146 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7149 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7150 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7151 The format of the query is
7152 an SQL statement that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7155 This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7156 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7159 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7160 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7161 &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7162 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7163 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7164 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7165 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7166 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7167 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7169 require condition = \
7170 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7172 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7173 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7174 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7175 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7179 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7180 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7181 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7182 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7183 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7184 options such as a list of local domains.
7186 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7187 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7188 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7189 or may give up altogether.
7193 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7194 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7195 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7196 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7197 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7198 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7199 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7200 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7202 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7203 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7204 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7206 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7207 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7208 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7210 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7211 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7212 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7213 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7214 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7215 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7216 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7217 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7218 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7219 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7221 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7223 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7224 looks up these keys, in this order:
7230 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7231 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7232 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7233 Exim move on to try the next key.
7237 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7238 .cindex "partial matching"
7239 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7240 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7241 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7242 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7243 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7244 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7245 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7246 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7247 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7248 a key in a DBM file is
7250 *.dates.fict.example
7252 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7253 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7254 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7257 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7258 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7259 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7261 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7262 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7263 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7264 partial matching keys
7265 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7266 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7267 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7269 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7270 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7271 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7272 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7273 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7274 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7277 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7278 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7279 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7280 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7281 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7282 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7284 2250.dates.fict.example
7285 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7286 *.dates.fict.example
7289 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7292 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7293 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7294 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7295 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7296 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7297 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7299 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7301 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7302 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7303 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7304 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7306 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7308 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7309 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7311 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7312 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7313 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7316 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7318 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7319 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7321 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7322 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7323 for &"*"& on its own.
7325 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7329 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7330 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7331 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7332 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7333 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7334 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7335 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7337 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7338 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7339 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7340 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7341 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7343 When the lookup is done from a string-expansion,
7344 the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild and non-wild parts of the key
7345 during the expansion of the replacement text.
7346 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
7351 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7352 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7353 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7354 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7355 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7356 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7357 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7359 If an option &"cache=no_rd"& is used on the lookup then
7360 the cache is only written to, cached data is not used for the operation
7361 and a real lookup is done.
7363 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7364 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7365 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7366 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7367 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7368 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7370 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7371 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7377 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7378 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7379 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7380 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7381 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7382 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7386 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7387 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7389 [name="$local_part"]
7391 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7392 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7393 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7394 of the following form is provided:
7396 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7398 For example, the way to write the NIS+ query is
7400 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7402 .cindex "tainted data" "in lookups"
7403 &*All*& tainted data used in a query-style lookup must be quoted
7404 using a mechanism appropriate for the lookup type.
7405 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7406 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7407 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7412 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7413 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7414 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7415 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7416 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7417 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7418 an expansion string could contain:
7420 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7422 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7423 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7424 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7425 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7427 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7428 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7429 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7431 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7432 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7433 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7434 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7435 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7437 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7439 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7440 white space is ignored.
7441 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7442 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7443 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7445 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7446 When the type is PTR,
7447 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7448 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7450 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7452 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7453 altered and nothing is added.
7455 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7456 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7457 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7458 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7459 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7460 The field separator can be modified as above.
7462 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7463 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7464 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7465 unless a field separator is specified.
7466 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7468 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7470 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7471 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7472 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7474 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7475 white space is ignored.
7477 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7478 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7479 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7480 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7483 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7486 .subsection "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" SECTdnsdb_mod
7487 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7488 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7489 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7490 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7491 each followed by a comma,
7492 that may appear before the record type.
7494 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7495 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7496 a defer-option modifier.
7497 The possible keywords are
7498 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7499 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7500 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7501 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7502 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7503 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7504 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7506 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7507 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7509 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7510 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7512 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7513 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7514 The possible keywords are
7515 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7516 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7518 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7519 is not labelled as authenticated data
7520 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7521 The default is &"lax"&.
7523 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7525 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7526 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7527 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7528 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7530 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7532 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7533 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7534 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7536 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7537 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7539 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7540 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7541 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7544 .subsection "Pseudo dnsdb record types" SECID66
7545 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7546 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7547 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7548 the pseudo-type MXH:
7550 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7552 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7555 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7556 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7557 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7558 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7559 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7560 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7561 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7562 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7564 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7565 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7567 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7568 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7569 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7571 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7572 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7573 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7574 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7575 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7578 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7579 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7580 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7581 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7582 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7583 result of a successful lookup such as:
7585 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7587 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7588 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7589 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7591 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7592 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7593 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7594 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7596 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7600 .subsection "Multiple dnsdb lookups" SECID67
7601 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7602 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7603 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7604 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7606 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7607 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7608 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7610 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7611 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7612 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7613 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7615 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7616 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7617 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7622 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7623 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7624 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7625 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7626 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7627 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7628 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7629 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7630 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7631 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7632 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7633 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7635 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7636 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7637 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7638 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7639 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7641 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7642 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7644 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7645 the way they handle the results of a query:
7648 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7651 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7652 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7654 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7655 from all of them are returned.
7659 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7660 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7661 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7662 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7665 .subsection "Format of LDAP queries" SECTforldaque
7666 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7667 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7668 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7670 data = ${lookup ldap \
7671 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7672 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7674 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7675 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7676 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7677 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7679 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7680 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7681 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7683 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7684 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7685 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7686 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7687 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7688 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7689 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7690 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7694 .subsection "LDAP quoting" SECID68
7695 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7696 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7697 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7698 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7699 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7701 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7702 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7710 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7711 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7715 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7717 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7721 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7723 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7725 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7727 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7728 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7729 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7733 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7734 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7735 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7737 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7741 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7743 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7745 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7747 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7748 authentication below.
7751 .subsection "LDAP connections" SECID69
7752 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7753 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7754 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7755 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7758 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7760 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7761 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7762 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7763 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7764 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7765 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7766 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7767 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7768 failures, and timeouts.
7770 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7771 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7772 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7773 doubled. For example
7775 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7777 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7778 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7779 the local host) is used.
7781 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7782 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7783 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7784 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7787 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7788 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7789 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7790 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7792 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7794 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7795 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7797 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7799 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7800 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7801 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7802 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7803 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7804 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7805 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7808 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7809 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7810 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7813 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7816 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7820 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7821 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7825 .subsection "LDAP authentication and control information" SECID70
7826 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7827 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7828 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7829 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7830 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7831 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7832 them. The following names are recognized:
7833 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
7834 .irow DEREFERENCE "set the dereferencing parameter"
7835 .irow NETTIME "set a timeout for a network operation"
7836 .irow USER "set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind"
7837 .irow PASS "set the password, likewise"
7838 .irow REFERRALS "set the referrals parameter"
7839 .irow SERVERS "set alternate server list for this query only"
7840 .irow SIZE "set the limit for the number of entries returned"
7841 .irow TIME "set the maximum waiting time for a query"
7843 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7844 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7845 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7846 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7848 .cindex LDAP timeout
7849 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7850 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7851 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7852 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7853 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7854 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7855 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7856 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7857 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7858 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7860 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7861 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7863 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7864 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7865 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7866 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7867 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7868 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7869 alternate list (colon-separated).
7871 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7872 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7875 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7876 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7879 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7880 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7881 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7882 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7884 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7885 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7886 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7888 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7889 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it to the LDAP library.
7891 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7892 quoting has two advantages:
7895 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7896 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7898 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7901 For example, a setting such as
7903 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7905 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7907 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7908 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7909 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7910 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7914 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7915 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7920 .subsection "Format of data returned by LDAP" SECID71
7921 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7922 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7923 as a sequence of values, for example
7925 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7927 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7928 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7929 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7930 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7931 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7934 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7935 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7936 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7937 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7939 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7940 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7941 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7942 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7943 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7944 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7945 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7946 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7947 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7949 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7950 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7951 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7952 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7953 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7956 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7959 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7962 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7963 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7965 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7966 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7968 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7969 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7972 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7973 results of LDAP lookups.
7974 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7975 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7976 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7977 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7978 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7979 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7984 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7985 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7986 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7987 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7988 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7989 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7990 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7991 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7993 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7995 might return the string
7997 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7998 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
8000 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
8002 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
8008 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
8009 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
8010 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
8014 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
8015 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
8016 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8017 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8018 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8019 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8020 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8021 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8022 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8023 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8024 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8025 .cindex lookup Redis
8026 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
8028 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
8031 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
8034 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
8035 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
8037 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
8042 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
8044 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
8045 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
8046 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
8050 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
8051 with a newline between the data for each row.
8054 .subsection "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" SECID72
8055 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8056 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8057 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8058 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8059 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8060 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8061 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8062 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8063 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8064 .cindex lookup Redis
8065 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
8066 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
8067 or &%redis_servers%&
8068 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8070 .oindex &%mysql_servers%&
8071 .oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
8072 .oindex &%oracle_servers%&
8073 .oindex &%ibase_servers%&
8074 .oindex &%redis_servers%&
8075 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
8076 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
8077 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
8079 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
8080 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
8081 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
8082 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
8084 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
8086 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
8087 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
8088 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
8090 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
8091 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
8093 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
8094 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
8095 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
8096 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
8097 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
8098 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
8100 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
8101 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
8102 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8104 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
8105 host, database number, and password.
8107 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8108 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8109 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8111 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8113 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8116 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8117 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8118 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8119 itself are escaped with backslashes.
8121 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8122 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8124 .subsection "Specifying the server in the query" SECTspeserque
8125 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8126 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8127 done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8129 &`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8131 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8133 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8134 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8135 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8138 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8140 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8141 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8142 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8144 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8145 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8146 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8149 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8153 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8155 ${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8157 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8158 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8159 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8161 ${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8165 A now-deprecated syntax places the servers specification before the query,
8166 semicolon separated:
8168 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8170 The new version avoids issues with tainted
8171 arguments explicitly expanded as part of the query.
8172 The entire string within the braces becomes tainted,
8173 including the server sepcification - which is not permissible.
8174 If the older sytax is used, a warning message will be logged.
8175 This syntax will be removed in a future release.
8178 &*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8181 .subsection "Special MySQL features" SECID73
8182 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8183 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8184 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8185 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8186 the default value is &"exim"&.
8187 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8189 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8190 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8192 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8193 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8195 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8198 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8199 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8201 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8202 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8203 is zero because no rows are affected.
8206 .subsection "Special PostgreSQL features" SECID74
8207 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8208 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8209 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8210 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8213 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8215 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8216 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8217 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8219 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8220 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8223 .subsection "More about SQLite" SECTsqlite
8224 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8225 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8226 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8227 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8228 daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8230 .oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8231 There are two ways of
8232 specifying the file.
8233 The first is by using the &%sqlite_dbfile%& main option.
8234 The second, which allows separate files for each query,
8235 is to use an option appended, comma-separated, to the &"sqlite"&
8236 lookup type word. The option is the word &"file"&, then an equals,
8238 The filename in this case cannot contain whitespace or open-brace charachters.
8240 A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8241 separated by white space.
8243 .cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8244 the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8245 the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8248 In all the above cases the filename must be an absolute path.
8250 Here is a lookup expansion example:
8252 sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8254 ${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8256 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8258 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8259 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8261 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8262 quote, which it doubles.
8264 .cindex timeout SQLite
8265 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8266 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8267 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8268 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8269 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8270 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8271 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8274 .subsection "More about Redis" SECTredis
8275 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8276 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8277 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8280 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8281 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8284 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8285 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8286 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8287 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8290 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8291 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8292 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8299 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8300 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8302 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8303 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8304 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8305 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8306 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8307 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8308 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8309 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8310 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8312 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8313 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8314 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8315 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8317 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8318 support all the complexity available in
8319 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8323 .section "Results of list checking" SECTlistresults
8324 The primary result of doing a list check is a truth value.
8325 In some contexts additional information is stored
8326 about the list element that matched:
8329 A &%hosts%& ACL condition
8330 will store a result in the &$host_data$& variable.
8332 A &%local_parts%& router option or &%local_parts%& ACL condition
8333 will store a result in the &$local_part_data$& variable.
8335 A &%domains%& router option or &%domains%& ACL condition
8336 will store a result in the &$domain_data$& variable.
8338 A &%senders%& router option or &%senders%& ACL condition
8339 will store a result in the &$sender_data$& variable.
8341 A &%recipients%& ACL condition
8342 will store a result in the &$recipient_data$& variable.
8345 The detail of the additional information depends on the
8346 type of match and is given below as the &*value*& information.
8351 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8352 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8353 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8354 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
8355 &*Note*&: As a result, if any componend was tainted then the
8356 entire result string becomes tainted.
8358 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8359 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8362 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8363 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8364 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8365 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8366 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8369 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8370 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8371 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8373 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8374 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8375 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8376 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8377 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8379 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8380 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8382 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8383 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8384 senders based on the receiving domain.
8389 .subsection "Negated items in lists" SECID76
8390 .cindex "list" "negation"
8391 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8392 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8393 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8394 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8395 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8396 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8398 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8399 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8400 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8401 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8402 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8404 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8406 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8407 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8408 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8410 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8412 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8413 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8414 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8416 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8417 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8422 .subsection "File names in lists" SECTfilnamlis
8423 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8424 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8425 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8426 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8427 filenames are not allowed,
8428 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8429 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8433 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8434 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8436 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8437 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8438 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8440 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8444 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8445 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8446 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8447 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8449 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8450 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8452 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8454 and the file contains the lines
8459 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8460 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8464 .subsection "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" SECID77
8465 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8466 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8467 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8468 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8469 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8470 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8471 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8473 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8474 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8475 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8476 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8481 .subsection "Named lists" SECTnamedlists
8482 .cindex "named lists"
8483 .cindex "list" "named"
8484 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8485 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8486 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8487 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8488 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8489 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8490 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8492 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8494 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8495 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8496 configured with the line
8498 domains = +local_domains
8500 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8501 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8505 domains = ! +local_domains
8506 transport = remote_smtp
8509 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8510 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8511 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8512 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8514 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8515 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8517 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8519 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8520 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8521 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8523 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8524 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8525 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8527 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8528 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8530 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8531 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8532 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8534 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8536 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8537 referenced lists if you can.
8539 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8540 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8541 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8542 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8543 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8544 word &"hide"&. For example:
8546 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8550 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8551 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8552 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8554 domains = +local_domains
8556 on several of your routers
8557 or in several ACL statements,
8558 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8559 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8560 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8561 the same each time they are referenced.
8563 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8564 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8565 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8566 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8570 .subsection "Named lists compared with macros" SECID78
8571 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8572 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8573 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8574 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8577 ALIST = host1 : host2
8578 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8580 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8582 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8584 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8587 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8588 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8590 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8592 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8596 .subsection "Named list caching" SECID79
8597 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8598 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8599 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8600 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8601 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8602 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8603 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8604 message. For example:
8606 domainlist special_domains = \
8607 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8609 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8610 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8611 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8612 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8613 same list each time.
8615 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8616 cache the result anyway. For example:
8618 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8620 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8621 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8625 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8626 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8627 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8628 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8629 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8632 .cindex "primary host name"
8633 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8634 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8635 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8636 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8637 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8638 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8639 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8640 differ only in their names.
8642 The value for a match will be the primary host name.
8646 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8647 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8648 .cindex "domain literal"
8649 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8650 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8651 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8652 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8653 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8654 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial;
8655 see the &%allow_domain_literals%& main option.
8657 The value for a match will be the string &`@[]`&.
8662 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8663 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8664 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8665 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8666 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8667 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8668 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8669 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8670 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8671 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8672 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8674 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8675 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8676 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8677 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8678 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8680 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8681 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8682 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8683 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8684 on a router). For example:
8686 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8688 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8689 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8691 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8692 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8693 contain negative items.
8695 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8696 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8697 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8699 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8700 an.other.domain : ...
8702 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8703 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8705 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8706 an.other.domain ? ...
8708 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting &`@mx_`&).
8712 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8713 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8714 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8715 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8716 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8717 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8718 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8719 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8720 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8723 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the asterisk).
8724 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the matched string
8725 and &$1$& to the variable portion which the asterisk matched.
8728 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8729 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8730 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8731 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8732 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8733 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8734 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8735 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8736 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8738 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8739 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8740 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8741 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8742 expression by expansion, of course).
8744 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the circumflex).
8745 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the string matching the regular expression,
8746 and &$1$& (onwards) to any submatches identified by parentheses.
8751 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8752 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8753 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8754 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8755 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8756 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8758 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8760 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8761 key. In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used; Exim is interested
8762 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8763 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8764 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the value is preserved in the
8765 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8766 other statements in the same ACL.
8767 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8768 .cindex "de-tainting" "using ACL domains condition"
8769 The value will be untainted.
8771 &*Note*&: If the data result of the lookup (as opposed to the key)
8772 is empty, then this empty value is stored in &$domain_data$&.
8773 The option to return the key for the lookup, as the value,
8774 may be what is wanted.
8778 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8779 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8781 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8783 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8784 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8787 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8788 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8789 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8790 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8791 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8792 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8796 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8797 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8798 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8799 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8801 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8802 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8804 In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8805 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8806 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8807 &%domains%& option on a router, the value is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8808 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8809 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8810 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
8811 The value will be untainted.
8814 If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8815 of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8816 followed by a comma and options,
8817 The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8818 Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=" sign.
8821 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8822 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8823 between the pattern and the domain.
8825 The value for a match will be the list element string.
8826 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8827 Note that this is commonly untainted
8828 (depending on the way the list was created).
8829 Specifically, explicit text in the configuration file in not tainted.
8830 This is a useful way of obtaining an untainted equivalent to
8831 the domain, for later operations.
8833 However if the list (including one-element lists)
8834 is created by expanding a variable containing tainted data,
8835 it is tainted and so will the match value be.
8839 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8841 domainlist funny_domains = \
8844 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8845 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8846 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8847 nis;domains.byname : \
8848 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8850 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8851 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8852 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8853 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8854 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8859 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8860 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8861 .cindex "list" "host list"
8862 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8863 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8864 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8865 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8866 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8867 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8868 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8871 .subsection "Special host list patterns" SECID80
8872 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8873 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8874 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8875 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8876 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8879 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8880 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8881 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8885 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by IP address" SECThoslispatip
8886 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8887 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8888 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8889 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8890 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8891 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8894 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8895 inspecting its IP address:
8898 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8899 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8900 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8901 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8902 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8903 with the IP address of the subject host.
8905 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8906 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8907 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8908 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8909 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8912 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8913 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8914 domain name, as just described.
8917 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8918 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8919 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8920 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8921 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8922 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8923 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8924 that can never match a client host.
8927 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8928 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8929 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8930 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8932 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8936 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8937 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length, for
8942 , it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8943 host under the given mask. This allows an entire network of hosts to be
8944 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8945 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8946 significant end of the address.
8948 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8949 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8950 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8951 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8955 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8956 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8959 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8961 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8962 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8964 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8965 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8968 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8970 could make use of a file containing
8975 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8976 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8977 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8979 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8982 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8988 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8990 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8991 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8992 address, the pattern takes this form:
8994 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8998 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
9000 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
9001 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
9002 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
9003 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
9004 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
9005 returned by the lookup is not used.
9007 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9008 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
9009 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
9010 patterns of this form:
9012 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9016 net24-dbm;/networks.db
9018 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
9019 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
9020 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
9021 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
9022 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
9024 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
9025 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
9026 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
9027 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
9028 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
9029 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
9030 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
9031 converted using colons and not dots.
9032 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
9033 addresses are always used.
9034 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
9036 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
9037 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
9038 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
9041 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
9042 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
9043 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
9044 case the IP address is used on its own.
9048 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by host name" SECThoslispatnam
9049 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
9050 .cindex "unknown host name"
9051 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9052 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
9053 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
9054 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
9055 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
9058 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
9059 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
9060 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
9061 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
9062 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
9063 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
9064 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
9066 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
9067 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
9069 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
9070 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
9071 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
9072 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
9073 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
9074 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
9075 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
9076 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
9077 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
9079 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
9080 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9082 .cindex "host" "alias for"
9083 .cindex "alias for host"
9084 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
9085 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
9088 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9089 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
9090 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
9091 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
9092 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
9095 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
9096 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
9097 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
9098 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
9099 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
9100 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
9101 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
9106 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
9107 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
9108 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
9109 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
9110 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9112 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
9114 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
9115 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
9116 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
9123 .subsection "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" SECTbehipnot
9124 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
9125 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
9126 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
9127 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
9128 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
9130 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
9131 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
9133 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
9134 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
9135 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
9136 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
9137 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
9138 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
9139 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
9140 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
9141 not recognized in an indirected file).
9144 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
9145 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
9147 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
9149 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
9150 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
9153 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
9154 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
9157 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
9160 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
9161 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
9162 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
9165 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
9166 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
9169 .subsection "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
9171 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
9173 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
9174 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
9175 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
9178 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
9179 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
9180 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
9182 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
9184 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
9185 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
9186 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
9187 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
9188 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
9189 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
9190 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
9193 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
9194 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9196 accept hosts = *.friend.example
9197 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9199 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9200 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9201 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9206 .subsection "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9208 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9209 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9210 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9211 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9212 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9213 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9214 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9215 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9216 host lists such as whitelists.
9220 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9222 .cindex "unknown host name"
9223 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9224 If a pattern is of the form
9226 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9230 dbm;/host/accept/list
9232 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9233 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9236 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9237 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9238 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"&
9239 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
9240 There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9241 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9242 lookup, both using the same file.
9246 .subsection "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" SECID81
9247 If a pattern is of the form
9249 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9251 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9252 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9253 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9255 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9256 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9258 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9259 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9260 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9263 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9264 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9265 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9267 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9268 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9269 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9270 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9271 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9272 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9278 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9279 .cindex "list" "address list"
9280 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
9281 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
9282 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9283 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9284 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9285 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9286 using this option setting:
9290 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9291 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9292 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9293 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9295 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9298 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9300 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9301 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9302 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9303 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9304 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9305 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9306 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9308 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9309 *@+hostile_domains:\
9310 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9311 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9313 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9314 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9315 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9316 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9317 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9319 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9320 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9321 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9322 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9323 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9325 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9328 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9329 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9333 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9334 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9335 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9336 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9337 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9338 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9339 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9341 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9342 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9344 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9345 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9348 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9349 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9350 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9353 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9354 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9355 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9357 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9358 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9359 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9360 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9362 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9363 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9365 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9366 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9367 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9368 default. For example, with this lookup:
9370 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9372 the file could contains lines like this:
9374 user1@domain1.example
9377 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9380 nimrod@jaeger.example
9384 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9385 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9387 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9389 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9390 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9392 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9393 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9394 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9398 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9399 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9404 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9405 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9406 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9407 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9408 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9409 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9410 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9411 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9412 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9414 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9415 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9416 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9417 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9418 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9421 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9423 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9425 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9427 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9429 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9430 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9431 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9432 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9433 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9434 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9436 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9439 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9442 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9443 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9444 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9445 might have entries like
9447 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9448 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9451 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9452 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9453 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9454 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9456 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9457 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9458 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9461 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9462 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9463 can only return a single list of local parts.
9466 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9467 in these two examples:
9470 senders = *@+my_list
9472 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9473 example it is a named domain list.
9478 .subsection "Case of letters in address lists" SECTcasletadd
9479 .cindex "case of local parts"
9480 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9481 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9482 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9483 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9484 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9485 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9486 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9487 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9490 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9491 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9492 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9493 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9494 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9495 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9496 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9499 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9500 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9501 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9502 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9503 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9504 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9505 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9506 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9510 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9511 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9512 .cindex "local part" "list"
9513 These behave in the same way as domain and host lists, with the following
9516 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9517 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9518 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9519 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9520 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9521 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9522 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9523 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9525 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9526 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9527 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9528 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9529 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9530 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9531 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9533 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9538 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9539 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9541 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9542 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9543 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9544 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9546 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9547 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9548 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9549 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9550 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9551 escape character, as described in the following section.
9553 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
9554 If any porttion of the result string is tainted, the entire result is.
9556 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9557 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9558 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9559 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9560 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9562 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9563 .cindex "tainted data" definition
9564 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9565 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9566 is not permitted (including acessing a file using a tainted name).
9568 Common ways of obtaining untainted equivalents of variables with
9570 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
9571 come down to using the tainted value as a lookup key in a trusted database.
9572 This database could be the filesystem structure,
9573 or the password file,
9574 or accessed via a DBMS.
9575 Specific methods are indexed under &"de-tainting"&.
9579 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9580 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9581 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9582 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9583 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9584 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9585 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9586 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9588 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9589 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9590 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9591 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9593 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9595 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9596 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9601 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9602 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9603 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9604 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9605 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9606 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9607 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9610 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9611 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9612 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9615 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9616 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9617 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9619 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9620 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9621 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9622 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9623 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9624 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9625 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9628 When reading lines from the standard input,
9629 macros can be defined and ACL variables can be set.
9633 set acl_m_myvar = bar
9635 Such macros and variables can then be used in later input lines.
9637 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9638 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9639 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9642 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9643 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9644 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9645 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9647 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9649 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9650 Exim message identifier. For example:
9652 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9654 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9655 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9658 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9659 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9660 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9661 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9662 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9663 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9664 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9665 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9666 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9667 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9668 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9669 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9675 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9676 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9677 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9678 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9679 white space is significant.
9682 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9683 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9684 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9689 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9690 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9691 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9692 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9693 given, the expansion fails.
9695 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9696 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9697 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9698 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9702 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9703 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9704 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9705 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9706 string easier to understand.
9708 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9709 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9710 expansion item below.
9713 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9714 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9715 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9716 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9717 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9718 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9719 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9720 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9721 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9722 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9723 the result of the expansion.
9724 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9725 the expansion result is an empty string.
9726 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9729 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9730 .cindex authentication "results header"
9731 .chindex Authentication-Results:
9732 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9733 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9734 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9736 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9737 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9738 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9747 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9749 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9751 This is safe even if no authentication results are available
9752 and would generally be placed in the DATA ACL.
9755 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9756 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9757 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9758 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9759 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9760 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9761 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9762 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9766 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9767 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9772 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9776 If the field is found,
9777 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9778 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9779 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9780 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9782 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9783 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9786 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9788 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9789 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9791 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9792 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9793 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9794 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9795 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9796 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9797 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9798 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9800 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9801 take an optional modifier of "int"
9802 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9803 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9804 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9806 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9807 newline-separated by default,
9808 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9809 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9810 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9812 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9813 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9814 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9815 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9816 if so the element tags are omitted.
9818 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9820 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9821 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9823 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9824 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9828 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9829 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9830 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9832 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9835 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9836 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9837 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9838 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9839 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9840 must have the following type:
9842 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9844 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9845 function should return one of the following values:
9847 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9848 into the expanded string that is being built.
9850 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9851 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9853 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9854 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9856 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9858 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9859 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9860 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9863 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9864 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9865 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9866 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9868 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9869 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9870 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9872 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9873 appear, for example:
9875 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9877 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9878 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9880 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9882 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9885 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9886 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9889 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9890 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9891 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9892 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9893 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9894 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9895 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9896 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9898 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9901 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9902 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9903 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9904 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9905 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9906 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9907 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9908 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9909 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9911 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9912 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9913 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9916 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9917 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9919 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9920 appear, for example:
9922 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9924 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9925 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9927 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9928 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9929 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9930 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9931 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9932 .cindex JSON expansions
9933 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9934 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9935 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9936 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9938 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9941 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9942 the spaces are optional.
9943 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9944 For the &"json"& variant,
9945 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9947 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9948 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9949 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9951 The results of matching are handled as above.
9954 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9955 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9956 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9957 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9958 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9959 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9960 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9961 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9962 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9963 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9964 <&'string3'&> as before.
9966 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9967 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9968 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9969 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9970 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9971 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9972 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9973 provided. For example:
9975 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9979 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9981 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9982 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9985 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9986 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9987 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9988 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9989 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9990 .cindex JSON expansions
9991 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9992 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9994 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9995 there is no choice of field separator.
9996 For the &"json"& variant,
9997 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9999 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10000 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10003 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
10004 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
10005 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
10007 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10008 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10010 in this list, its value is placed in &$item$&, and then the condition is
10012 Any modification of &$value$& by this evaluation is discarded.
10013 If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
10014 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
10015 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
10016 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
10018 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
10020 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
10021 to what it was before.
10022 See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10025 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10026 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10027 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10028 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
10029 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
10030 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
10032 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
10033 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
10034 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
10035 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10037 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10039 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
10040 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
10041 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
10042 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
10043 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
10045 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
10047 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
10048 letters appear. For example:
10050 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
10051 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
10052 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
10055 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10056 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10057 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10058 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10059 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10060 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10061 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10062 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10063 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
10064 .vindex "&$header_$&"
10065 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
10066 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
10067 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
10068 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
10069 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
10070 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
10071 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
10075 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
10076 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
10077 lines) may be present.
10079 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
10080 the data in the header line is interpreted.
10083 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
10084 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
10085 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
10088 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
10089 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
10090 are multiple headers with a given name.
10091 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
10092 list-processing facilities can be used.
10093 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
10094 the content is &"raw"&.
10097 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
10098 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
10099 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
10100 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
10101 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
10102 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
10103 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
10104 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
10107 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
10108 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
10109 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
10110 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
10111 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
10112 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
10115 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
10116 command of the following form:
10118 headers charset "UTF-8"
10120 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
10121 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
10122 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
10123 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
10124 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
10127 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
10128 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
10129 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
10130 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
10132 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
10133 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
10134 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
10135 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
10136 router or transport are not accessible.
10138 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
10139 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
10140 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
10141 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
10142 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
10143 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
10144 point they are added.
10145 When any of the above ACLs are
10146 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
10148 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
10149 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
10150 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
10151 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
10152 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
10153 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
10154 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
10157 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
10158 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
10159 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
10160 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
10161 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
10162 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
10163 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
10164 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
10166 .cindex "tainted data" "message headers"
10167 When the headers are from an incoming message,
10168 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
10171 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10172 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
10174 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
10175 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
10176 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
10177 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
10178 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
10179 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
10180 present. For example:
10182 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
10184 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
10187 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
10189 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
10190 an Exim configuration:
10192 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
10194 In a router or a transport you could then have:
10197 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
10198 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
10199 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
10201 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
10202 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
10203 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
10204 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
10205 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
10206 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
10209 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10210 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
10211 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
10212 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
10213 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
10214 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
10216 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
10218 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
10219 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
10220 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
10221 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
10222 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10224 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10225 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10226 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10228 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10232 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10237 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10238 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
10239 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10240 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10241 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10242 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10246 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10247 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10248 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10249 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10250 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10251 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10252 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10253 some of the braces:
10255 ${length_<n>:<string>}
10257 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10258 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10259 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10260 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10263 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10264 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10265 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10266 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10267 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10268 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10269 apart from an optional leading minus,
10270 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10272 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10273 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10275 The first field of the list is numbered one.
10276 If the number is negative, the fields are
10277 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10278 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10279 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10281 If the modulus of the
10282 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10283 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10287 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10291 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10293 yields &"result: 42"&.
10295 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10296 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10298 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10301 .vitem &*${listquote{*&<&'separator'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10302 .cindex quoting "for list"
10303 .cindex list quoting
10304 This item doubles any occurrence of the separator character
10305 in the given string.
10306 An empty string is replaced with a single space.
10307 This converts the string into a safe form for use as a list element,
10308 in a list using the given separator.
10311 .vitem "&*${lookup&~{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10312 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10313 "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10314 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10315 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10316 .cindex "file" "lookups"
10317 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10318 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10319 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10320 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10321 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10323 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10324 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10325 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10326 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10327 out by the system administrator.
10329 .vindex "&$value$&"
10330 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10331 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10332 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10333 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10334 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10335 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10336 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10337 original lookup fails.
10339 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10340 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10341 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10342 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10343 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10344 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10345 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10346 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10348 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10349 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10350 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10351 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10353 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10354 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10355 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10356 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10358 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10360 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10362 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10363 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10365 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10370 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10371 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10373 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10374 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10376 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10377 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10378 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10379 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10381 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10383 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10384 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10385 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10387 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10388 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10389 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10390 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10391 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10392 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10393 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10395 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10397 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10398 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10399 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10400 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10403 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10405 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10409 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10410 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10411 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10412 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10413 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10414 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10415 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10416 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10418 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10419 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the entire expansion is
10420 forced to fail, in the same way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item
10421 does (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). Whatever you return is evaluated
10422 in a scalar context, thus the return value is a scalar. For example, if you
10423 return a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10426 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10427 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10428 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10430 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10431 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10434 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10435 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10436 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10437 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10438 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10439 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10440 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10441 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10443 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10444 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10445 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10446 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10447 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10448 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10449 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10450 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10451 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10452 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10454 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10455 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10456 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10457 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10459 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10460 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10461 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10462 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10463 is the expansion of the third argument.
10465 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10466 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10467 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10469 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10470 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10471 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10472 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10473 The filename and end-of-line (eol) string are first expanded separately. The file is
10474 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10475 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10476 newlines are left in the string.
10477 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10478 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10479 the string expansion fails.
10481 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10482 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10486 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10487 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10488 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10489 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10490 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10491 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10492 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10495 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10496 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10498 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10499 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10500 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10501 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10502 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10505 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10507 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10508 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10509 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10510 (unless it is an empty string; no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10511 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10512 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10513 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10515 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10518 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10519 and must be present if any options are given.
10520 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10523 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10526 The following option names are recognised:
10529 Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10530 request in the same process.
10531 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10532 If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10533 will be invalidated.
10537 Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10538 sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10539 (preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10543 Controls the use of Server Name Identification on the connection.
10544 Any nonempty value will be the SNI sent; TLS will be forced.
10548 Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10549 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10550 If it is enabled, a shutdown as described above is never done.
10554 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10555 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10556 turns them into spaces:
10558 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10560 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10561 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10562 addition, the following errors can occur:
10565 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10567 Failure to connect the socket;
10569 Failure to write the request string;
10571 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10574 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10575 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10576 errors occurs. For example:
10578 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10581 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10582 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10583 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10584 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10585 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10587 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10588 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10591 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10592 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10593 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10594 .vindex "&$value$&"
10596 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10597 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10598 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10599 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10600 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10601 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10602 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10603 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10604 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10605 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10607 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10609 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10612 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10614 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10615 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10618 . A bit of a special-case logic error in writing an expansion;
10619 . probably not worth including in the mainline of documentation.
10620 . If only we had footnotes (the html output variant is the problem).
10623 . &*Note*&: if an &'expansion condition'& is used in <&'string3'&>
10624 . and that condition modifies &$value$&,
10625 . then the string expansions dependent on the condition cannot use
10626 . the &$value$& of the reduce iteration.
10629 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10630 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10631 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10633 .vitem "&*${run<&'options'&> {*&<&'command&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10634 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10635 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10636 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10637 This item runs an external command, as a subprocess.
10638 One option is supported after the word &'run'&, comma-separated
10639 and without whitespace.
10641 If the option &'preexpand'& is not used,
10642 the command string before expansion is split into individual arguments by spaces
10643 and then each argument is separately expanded.
10644 Then the command is run
10645 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10646 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10647 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10648 The command name may not be tainted, but the remaining arguments can be.
10650 &*Note*&: if tainted arguments are used, they are supplied by a
10651 potential attacker;
10652 a careful assessment for security vulnerabilities should be done.
10654 If the option &'preexpand'& is used,
10655 the command string is first expanded as a whole.
10656 The expansion result is split apart into individual arguments by spaces,
10657 and then the command is run as above.
10658 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10659 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10660 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10661 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10662 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10663 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10664 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10665 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10666 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10668 Neither the command nor any argument may be tainted.
10670 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10671 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10672 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10673 .vindex "&$value$&"
10674 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10675 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10676 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10677 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10678 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10681 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10682 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10683 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10684 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10686 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10687 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10688 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10691 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10692 log_message = Output of id: $value
10694 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10695 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10697 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10699 Note that &$value$& will not persist beyond the reception of a single message.
10701 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10702 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10703 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10705 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10706 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10710 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10711 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10714 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10715 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10716 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10717 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10719 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10720 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10723 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10724 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10725 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10726 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10727 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10728 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10729 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10730 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10732 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10734 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10735 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10736 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10738 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10740 yields &"defabc"&, and
10742 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10744 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10745 the regular expression from string expansion.
10747 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10748 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10751 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10752 .cindex sorting "a list"
10753 .cindex list sorting
10754 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10755 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10756 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10757 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10758 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10759 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10760 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10761 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10762 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10763 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10764 to give values for comparison.
10766 The item result is a sorted list,
10767 with the original list separator,
10768 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10772 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10774 sorts a list of numbers, and
10776 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10778 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10782 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
10783 SRS encoding. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
10787 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'start'&>&*}{*&<&'len'&>&*}{*&<&'subject'&>&*}}*&
10788 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10789 .cindex "substring extraction"
10790 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10791 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10792 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10793 if <&'start'&> and <&'len'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10794 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10796 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<subject>}
10798 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10799 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10802 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10803 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10804 length required. For example
10806 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10808 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10809 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10810 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10811 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10813 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10814 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10815 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10817 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10819 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10820 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10821 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10823 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10825 yields an empty string, but
10827 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10831 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10832 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10833 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10834 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10837 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10839 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10841 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10845 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10846 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10847 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10848 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10849 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10850 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10851 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10852 replacement list. For example
10854 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10856 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10857 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10858 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10861 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10867 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10868 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10869 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10870 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10871 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10872 following operations can be performed:
10875 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10876 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10877 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10878 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10879 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10880 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10882 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10885 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10886 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10887 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10888 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10889 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10890 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10891 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10892 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10893 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10895 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10896 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10897 character. For example:
10899 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10901 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10902 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10903 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10904 separator explicitly:
10906 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10909 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10910 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10911 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10914 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10915 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10916 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10917 email address separator. For the example header line:
10919 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10921 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10922 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10923 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10924 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10925 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10926 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10927 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10929 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10930 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10932 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10933 Last:user@example.com
10934 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10936 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10940 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10941 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10942 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10943 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10944 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10945 Only lowercase letters are used.
10947 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10948 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10949 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10950 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10951 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10953 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10954 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10955 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10956 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10957 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10958 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10959 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10960 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10961 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10963 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10964 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10965 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10966 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10967 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10968 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10971 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10972 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10973 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10974 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10975 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10976 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10978 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10979 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10982 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10983 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10984 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10985 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10986 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10989 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10990 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10991 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10992 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10993 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10996 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10997 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10998 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10999 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
11000 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
11001 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
11002 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
11004 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11005 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
11006 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
11007 If the string contains any characters with the most significant bit set,
11008 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
11009 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
11012 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11013 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
11014 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
11015 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
11016 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
11017 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
11018 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
11019 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
11020 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
11021 C programming language):
11023 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
11024 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
11025 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
11026 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
11027 .irow "" "and (&&)"
11029 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
11031 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
11032 space is permitted before or after operators.
11034 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
11035 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
11036 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
11037 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
11038 times, which often do have leading zeros.
11040 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
11042 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
11043 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
11046 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
11047 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
11048 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
11049 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
11050 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
11051 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
11052 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
11053 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
11054 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
11055 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
11056 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
11059 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
11063 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
11066 {$recipients_count} \
11067 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
11070 message = Too many bad recipients
11072 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
11073 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
11076 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11077 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
11078 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
11081 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
11083 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
11084 and then re-expands what it has found.
11087 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11089 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
11090 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
11091 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
11092 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
11093 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
11094 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
11095 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
11096 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
11097 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
11099 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
11100 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
11101 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
11102 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
11103 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
11104 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
11105 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
11108 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11109 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
11110 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
11111 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
11112 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
11113 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11115 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11117 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
11118 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
11122 .vitem &*${headerwrap_*&<&'cols'&>&*_*&<&'limit'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11123 .cindex header "wrapping operator"
11124 .cindex expansion "header wrapping"
11125 This operator line-wraps its argument in a way useful for headers.
11126 The &'cols'& value gives the column number to wrap after,
11127 the &'limit'& gives a limit number of result characters to truncate at.
11128 Either just the &'limit'& and the preceding underbar, or both, can be omitted;
11129 the defaults are 80 and 998.
11130 Wrapping will be inserted at a space if possible before the
11131 column number is reached.
11132 Whitespace at a chosen wrap point is removed.
11133 A line-wrap consists of a newline followed by a tab,
11134 and the tab is counted as 8 columns.
11138 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
11139 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
11140 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
11141 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
11142 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
11143 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
11147 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11148 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
11149 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
11150 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
11151 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
11152 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
11153 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
11156 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11157 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
11158 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11159 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
11160 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
11161 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11162 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11164 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11165 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
11166 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11167 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
11168 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
11169 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
11170 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
11171 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11172 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11175 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11176 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11177 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11178 .cindex "lower casing"
11179 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11180 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
11181 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
11185 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11187 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11188 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
11189 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
11190 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
11191 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
11192 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
11194 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
11196 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
11197 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
11198 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
11199 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11202 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11203 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
11204 .cindex "list" "item count"
11205 .cindex "list" "count of items"
11206 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
11207 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
11210 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
11211 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
11212 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
11213 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
11214 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
11215 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
11216 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
11217 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
11218 matching list is returned.
11219 &*Note*&: Neither string-expansion of lists referenced by named-list syntax elements,
11220 nor expansion of lookup elements, is done by the &%listnamed%& operator.
11223 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11224 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
11225 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
11226 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
11227 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
11229 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11232 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*& &&&
11233 &*${mask_n:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
11234 .cindex "masked IP address"
11235 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
11236 .cindex "CIDR notation"
11237 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
11238 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
11239 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
11240 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
11241 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
11242 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
11243 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
11245 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
11247 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&.
11249 Since this operation is expected to
11250 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the
11253 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
11254 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
11256 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
11260 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
11262 If the optional form &*mask_n*& is used, IPv6 address result are instead
11263 returned in normailsed form, using colons and with zero-compression.
11264 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
11267 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11269 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
11270 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11271 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
11272 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
11273 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
11275 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11276 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11279 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11280 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
11281 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
11282 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
11283 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
11284 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11286 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11288 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
11291 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11292 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11293 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11294 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11295 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11296 is an empty string or
11297 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11298 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11299 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11300 respectively For example,
11308 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11309 variable or a message header.
11311 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11312 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11313 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11314 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
11315 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11316 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11317 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11319 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11320 will likely use the quoting form.
11321 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11324 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11325 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11326 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11327 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11328 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11330 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
11336 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11337 yields an unchanged string.
11340 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11341 .cindex "random number"
11342 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11343 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11344 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11345 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11346 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11347 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11348 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11349 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11353 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11354 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11355 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11356 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11357 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11358 for DNS. For example,
11360 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11361 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11366 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11370 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11371 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11372 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11373 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11374 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
11375 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11376 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11377 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11378 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11381 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11383 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11384 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11388 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11389 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11390 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11391 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11392 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
11393 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11394 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11395 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11397 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11398 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11399 to use this operator as well.
11403 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11404 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11405 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11406 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11407 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11408 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11409 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11412 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11413 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11414 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11415 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11416 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11417 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11418 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11420 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11421 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11424 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11425 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11426 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11427 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11428 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11429 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11430 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11431 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11432 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11433 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11435 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11437 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11438 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11440 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11441 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11442 Finally, if an underbar
11443 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11444 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11445 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11448 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11449 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11450 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11451 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11452 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11453 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11455 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11457 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11458 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11459 with 256 being the default.
11461 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11462 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11463 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11464 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11467 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11468 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11469 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11470 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11471 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11472 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11473 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11474 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11475 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11476 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11477 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11478 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11479 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11481 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11482 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11483 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11485 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11486 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11487 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11491 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11492 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11493 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11494 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11495 The item is replaced by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11496 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11497 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11500 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11501 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11502 .cindex "substring extraction"
11503 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11504 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11505 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11506 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11508 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11510 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11511 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11512 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11514 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11515 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11516 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11517 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11520 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11521 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11522 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11523 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11524 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11525 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11528 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11529 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11530 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11531 .cindex "upper casing"
11532 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11533 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11534 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11535 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11537 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11538 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11539 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11540 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11541 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11542 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11543 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11544 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11545 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11546 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11547 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11548 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11549 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11550 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11552 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11554 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11555 literal question mark).
11557 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11558 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11559 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11560 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11561 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11562 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11564 .cindex internationalisation
11565 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11566 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11567 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11568 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11569 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11570 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11578 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11579 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11580 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11581 while expanding strings:
11584 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11585 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11586 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11587 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11590 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11591 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11592 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11593 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11595 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
11597 .irow "== " "equal"
11598 .irow "> " "greater"
11599 .irow ">= " "greater or equal"
11601 .irow "<= " "less or equal"
11605 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11607 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11608 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11609 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11610 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11611 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11614 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11615 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11616 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11619 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11620 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11621 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11622 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11623 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11624 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11625 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11626 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11627 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11628 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11629 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11630 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11631 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11632 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11634 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11635 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11636 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11637 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11638 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11639 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11641 An empty string is treated as false.
11642 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11643 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11644 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11646 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11647 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11650 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11654 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11655 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11656 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11657 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11658 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11659 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11660 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11661 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11663 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11665 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11666 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11667 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11668 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11669 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11670 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11671 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11672 included in the binary.
11674 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11675 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11676 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11677 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11678 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11679 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11680 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11681 string in LDAP form is:
11683 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11685 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11686 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11688 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11690 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11695 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11696 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11697 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11698 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11699 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11700 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11704 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11705 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11706 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11707 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11708 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11709 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11712 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11713 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11714 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11715 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11716 whatever its length.
11719 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11720 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11721 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11722 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11724 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11725 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11726 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11727 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11728 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11729 support &[crypt16()]&.
11731 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11732 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11733 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11734 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11735 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11737 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11738 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11739 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11741 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11742 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11743 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11744 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11745 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11747 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11748 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11749 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11750 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11751 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11752 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11754 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11756 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11757 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11759 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11760 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11761 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11762 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11763 exists in the message. For example,
11765 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11767 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11768 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11770 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11771 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11772 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11773 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11774 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11775 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11776 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11777 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11778 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11779 case is defined per the system C locale.
11781 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11782 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11783 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11784 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11785 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11786 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11787 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11788 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11790 &*Note:*& Testing a path using this condition is not a sufficient way of
11792 Consider using a dsearch lookup.
11794 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11795 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11796 .cindex "first delivery"
11797 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11798 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11799 .cindex retry condition
11800 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11801 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11804 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11805 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11806 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11807 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11808 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11810 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11811 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11812 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11813 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11814 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11815 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11817 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11818 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11819 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11821 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11822 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11823 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11825 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11826 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11827 that the condition must be false for at least one item.
11831 ${if forany{$recipients_list}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11833 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11834 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11836 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11838 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11839 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11840 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11841 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11842 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11843 .cindex JSON expansions
11844 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11845 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11846 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11847 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11848 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11850 The array separator is not changeable.
11851 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11852 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11856 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11857 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11858 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11859 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11860 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11861 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11862 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11863 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11864 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11866 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11868 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11869 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11870 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11871 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11872 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11873 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11874 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11875 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11876 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11878 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11881 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
11882 SRS decode. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
11885 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*& &&&
11886 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*&
11887 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11888 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11889 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11890 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11892 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11894 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11895 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11897 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11898 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11899 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11900 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11903 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
11904 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
11905 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
11906 .cindex "de-tainting" "using an inlist expansion condition"
11907 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
11909 ${if inlist {$h_mycode:} {0 : 1 : 42} {$value}}
11911 can be used for de-tainting.
11912 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
11915 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11916 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11917 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11918 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11919 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11920 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11921 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11922 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11923 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11924 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11925 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11927 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11928 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11929 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11930 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11931 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11933 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11934 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11936 This is no longer the case.
11938 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11939 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11941 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11943 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11945 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11946 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11947 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11948 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11949 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11950 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11951 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11952 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11953 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11954 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11955 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11956 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11957 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11961 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11962 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11963 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11964 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11965 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11966 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11967 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11968 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11969 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11971 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11973 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11974 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11975 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11976 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11977 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11978 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11979 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11980 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11981 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11983 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11986 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11987 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11988 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11989 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11990 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11991 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11992 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11993 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11994 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11995 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11996 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11999 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
12001 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
12002 backslashes is also required.
12004 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
12005 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
12006 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
12007 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
12008 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
12009 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
12010 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
12011 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
12013 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
12014 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
12015 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
12016 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
12017 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
12018 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
12019 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
12020 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
12022 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12023 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
12024 See &*match_local_part*&.
12026 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12027 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
12028 See &*match_local_part*&.
12030 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12031 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
12032 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
12033 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
12034 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
12035 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
12037 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
12039 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
12042 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
12044 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
12046 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
12047 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
12048 in a single test such as
12049 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12050 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
12051 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
12052 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
12054 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
12056 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
12058 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
12060 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists
12061 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&),
12062 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
12063 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
12064 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
12065 masks. For example:
12067 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
12069 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
12070 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
12071 address mask, for example:
12073 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
12075 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
12076 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
12078 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
12082 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12083 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12085 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
12087 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12088 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12089 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12091 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12092 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
12093 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
12094 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
12095 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
12096 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
12097 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
12098 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
12101 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
12103 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
12104 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
12105 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
12106 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
12108 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
12110 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
12111 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
12112 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
12113 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
12116 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12117 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12118 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
12119 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a match_local_part expansion condition"
12120 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
12122 ${if match_local_part {$local_part} {alice : bill : charlotte : dave} {$value}}
12124 can be used for de-tainting.
12125 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12127 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12128 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12130 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
12131 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
12132 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
12133 matched using &%match_ip%&.
12135 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
12136 .cindex "PAM authentication"
12137 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
12138 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
12139 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
12140 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
12141 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
12142 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
12143 available in Solaris
12144 and in some GNU/Linux distributions.
12145 The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
12146 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
12150 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
12151 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
12153 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
12154 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
12155 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
12156 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
12157 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
12158 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
12159 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
12161 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
12162 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
12164 The &%listquote%& expansion item can be used for this.
12165 For example, the configuration
12166 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
12168 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${listquote{:}{$auth2}}}}
12170 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
12171 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
12172 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
12173 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
12176 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12177 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
12179 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
12180 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
12181 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
12182 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
12183 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
12184 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
12186 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12187 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12188 building Exim. For example:
12190 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
12192 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12193 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12194 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
12195 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
12197 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
12198 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
12199 configuration, you might have this:
12201 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
12203 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
12205 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
12207 .vitem &*queue_running*&
12208 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
12209 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
12210 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
12211 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
12212 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
12215 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
12217 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
12218 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
12219 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
12220 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
12221 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
12224 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
12225 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
12226 this library, you need to set
12228 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
12230 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
12231 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
12233 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
12235 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
12236 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
12237 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
12239 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
12240 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
12241 the authentication is successful. For example:
12243 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
12247 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
12248 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
12249 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
12251 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
12252 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
12253 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
12254 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
12255 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
12256 by a process that is not running as root.
12258 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12259 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12260 building Exim. For example:
12262 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
12264 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12265 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12266 from the Cyrus SASL library.
12268 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
12269 two are mandatory. For example:
12271 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
12273 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
12274 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
12275 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
12280 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
12281 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
12282 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
12283 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
12284 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
12285 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
12286 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
12290 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12291 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
12292 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
12293 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12294 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
12297 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
12299 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
12300 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
12301 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
12303 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12304 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
12305 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
12306 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12307 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
12308 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
12309 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
12310 parsed but not evaluated.
12312 .ecindex IIDexpcond
12317 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
12318 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
12319 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
12320 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
12321 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
12322 .cindex "tainted data"
12323 Variables marked as &'tainted'& are likely to carry data supplied by
12324 a potential attacker.
12325 Variables without such marking may also, depending on how their
12326 values are created.
12327 Such variables should not be further expanded,
12329 or used as command-line arguments for external commands.
12332 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
12333 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
12334 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
12335 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
12336 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
12337 In the expansion condition case
12338 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12339 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12340 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12341 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12342 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12343 matching condition.
12344 If the subject string was tainted then any captured substring will also be.
12346 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12347 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12348 any arguments are copied to these variables,
12349 any unused variables being made empty.
12351 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12352 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12353 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12354 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12355 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12356 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12357 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12358 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12359 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12360 during subsequent delivery.
12362 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12363 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12364 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12365 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12366 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12367 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12368 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12369 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12372 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
12373 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12374 this variable has the number of arguments.
12376 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12377 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12378 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12379 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers of the verb.
12380 The message can be preserved by coding like this:
12382 warn !verify = sender
12383 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12385 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12386 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12388 &*Note*&: The variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
12390 .vitem &$address_data$&
12391 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12392 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12393 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12394 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12395 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12396 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12399 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12400 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12401 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12402 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12403 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12404 from the child's routing.
12406 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12407 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12408 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12411 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12412 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12413 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12415 .vitem &$address_file$&
12416 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
12417 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12418 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12419 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12420 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12422 /home/r2d2/savemail
12424 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12425 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12426 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12427 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12428 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12429 to the relevant file.
12431 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
12432 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12433 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12434 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12436 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth4$&"
12437 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12438 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12439 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12441 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12442 .cindex "authentication" "id"
12443 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12444 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12445 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12446 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12447 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12448 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12449 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12451 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12452 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12453 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12454 command line option.
12455 This second case also sets up information used by the
12456 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12458 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12459 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12460 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12461 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12462 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12463 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12464 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12465 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12466 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12470 .tvar &$authenticated_sender$&
12471 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12472 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12473 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12474 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12475 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12476 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12477 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12478 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12479 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12481 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12482 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12483 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12484 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12485 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12488 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12489 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12490 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12491 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12492 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12493 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12494 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12495 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12496 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&).
12497 Failure includes cancellation of a authentication attempt,
12498 and any negative response to an AUTH command,
12499 (including, for example, an attempt to use an undefined mechanism).
12501 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12502 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12503 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12504 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12505 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12506 the ACL malware condition.
12508 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12509 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12510 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12511 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12512 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12513 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12515 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12516 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12517 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12518 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12519 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12520 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12521 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12523 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12524 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12525 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12526 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12527 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12529 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12530 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12531 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12532 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12533 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12535 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12536 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12537 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12538 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12539 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12540 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12541 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12543 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12544 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12545 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12546 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12547 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12548 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12549 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12551 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12552 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12553 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12554 address that was connected to.
12556 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12557 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12558 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12559 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12560 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12562 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12563 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12564 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12565 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12566 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12567 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12569 .vitem &$config_file$&
12570 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12571 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12573 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12574 Results of DKIM verification.
12575 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12577 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12578 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12579 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12580 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12581 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12583 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12584 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12585 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12586 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12587 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12588 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12589 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12590 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12591 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12592 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12593 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12594 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12595 &$dkim_key_length$&
12596 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12597 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12599 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12600 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12601 When a message has been received this variable contains
12602 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12603 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12605 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12606 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12607 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12608 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12609 Results of DMARC verification.
12610 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12612 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12613 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12614 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12616 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12617 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12618 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12619 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12620 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12621 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12622 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12623 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12624 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12627 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12628 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12629 case for &$domain$&.
12631 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12632 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12633 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12634 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12636 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12637 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12638 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12639 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12640 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12641 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12643 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12644 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12645 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12647 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12650 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12651 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12652 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12653 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12654 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12655 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12656 the &(smtp)& transport.
12659 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12660 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12661 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12662 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12665 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12666 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12667 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12668 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12669 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12670 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12673 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12674 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12675 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12676 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12679 .cindex "tainted data"
12680 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12681 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and may not
12682 be further expanded or used as a filename.
12683 When an untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12684 looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12685 Often &$domain_data$& is usable in this role.
12688 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12689 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12690 When the &%domains%& condition on a router
12693 against a list, the match value is copied to &$domain_data$&.
12694 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12695 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12696 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12698 If the router routes the
12699 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12700 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12703 &$domain_data$& set in an ACL is available during
12704 the rest of the ACL statement.
12706 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12707 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12708 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12710 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12711 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12712 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12714 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12715 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12716 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12718 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12719 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12720 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12721 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12722 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12723 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12724 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12726 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12728 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12729 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12730 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12731 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12732 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12734 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12735 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12736 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12737 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12738 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12742 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12743 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12744 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12745 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12746 by a setting on the transport itself.
12748 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12749 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12750 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12754 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12755 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12756 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12757 to local and remote transports.
12759 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12760 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12761 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12762 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12763 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12764 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12765 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12768 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12769 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12770 client is connected.
12773 .vitem &$host_address$&
12774 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12775 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12776 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12777 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12779 .vitem &$host_data$&
12780 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12781 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12782 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12783 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12785 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12786 message = $host_data
12789 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12790 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12791 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12792 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12793 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12794 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12795 variables is set to &"1"&.
12798 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12799 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12802 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12803 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12804 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12807 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12808 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12809 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12810 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12811 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12812 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12813 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12814 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12815 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12816 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12818 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12819 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12820 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12823 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12824 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12825 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12827 .vitem &$host_port$&
12828 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12829 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12830 for an outbound connection.
12832 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12833 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12834 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12835 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12836 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12837 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12840 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12841 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12842 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12843 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12844 a unique name for the file.
12846 .vitem &$interface_address$& &&&
12848 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12849 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12850 These are obsolete names for &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12854 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12855 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12856 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12860 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12861 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12862 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12865 .vitem &$load_average$&
12866 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12867 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12868 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12869 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12871 .tvar &$local_part$&
12872 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12873 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12874 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12875 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12877 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12878 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12879 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12880 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12883 .cindex "tainted data"
12884 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12885 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and
12886 may not be further expanded or used as a filename.
12888 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
12890 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12892 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12893 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
12894 &$local_part_data$& variable rather than this one.
12895 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12896 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12897 rather than this variable.
12898 Often &$local_part_data$& is usable in this role.
12899 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
12900 the retrieved data.
12902 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12903 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12904 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12907 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12908 local part of the recipient address.
12910 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12911 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12912 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12914 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12917 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12918 abc\:xyz@test.example
12920 the value of &$local_part$& is
12924 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12925 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12928 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12930 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12931 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12932 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12934 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12935 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12936 When the &%local_parts%& condition on a router or ACL
12937 matches a local part list
12938 the match value is copied to &$local_part_data$&.
12939 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12940 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12941 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12943 The &%check_local_user%& router option also sets this variable.
12945 .vindex &$local_part_prefix$& &&&
12946 &$local_part_prefix_v$& &&&
12947 &$local_part_suffix$& &&&
12948 &$local_part_suffix_v$&
12949 .cindex affix variables
12950 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12951 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12952 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12953 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12954 .cindex "tainted data"
12955 If the specification did not include a wildcard then
12956 the affix variable value is not tainted.
12958 If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
12959 the affix matched by the wildcard is in
12960 &$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate,
12961 and both the whole and varying values are tainted.
12963 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12964 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12965 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12966 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12968 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12969 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12970 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12972 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12973 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12974 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12975 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12976 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12977 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12978 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12979 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12981 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12982 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12983 This contains the expanded value of the
12984 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12987 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12988 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12989 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12990 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12991 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12992 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12994 .vitem &$log_space$&
12995 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12996 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12997 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12998 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12999 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
13000 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
13003 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
13004 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
13005 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
13006 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
13007 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13008 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
13009 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
13010 and &"yes"& if it was.
13011 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
13012 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
13013 as authenticated data.
13015 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
13016 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
13017 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
13018 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
13019 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
13020 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
13021 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
13024 .vitem &$malware_name$&
13025 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
13026 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
13027 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
13028 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
13030 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
13031 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
13032 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
13033 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
13034 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
13035 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
13037 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13039 .vitem &$message_age$&
13040 .cindex "message" "age of"
13041 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
13042 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
13043 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
13046 .tvar &$message_body$&
13047 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13048 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13049 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
13050 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
13051 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
13052 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
13053 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
13054 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
13056 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
13057 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
13058 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
13059 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
13060 zeros are always converted into spaces.
13062 .tvar &$message_body_end$&
13063 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13064 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13065 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
13066 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
13069 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
13070 .cindex "body of message" "size"
13071 .cindex "message body" "size"
13072 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
13073 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
13074 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
13075 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
13076 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13078 If the spool file is wireformat
13079 (see the &%spool_wireformat%& main option)
13080 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
13082 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
13083 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
13084 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
13085 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
13086 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
13087 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
13088 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
13089 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
13091 .tvar &$message_headers$&
13092 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
13093 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
13094 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
13095 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
13097 .tvar &$message_headers_raw$&
13098 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
13099 contents of header lines is done.
13101 .vitem &$message_id$&
13102 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
13104 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
13105 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
13106 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
13107 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
13108 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
13109 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
13110 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
13111 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
13112 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
13113 from the body is not counted.
13115 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
13116 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
13117 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
13118 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
13119 header and the body).
13121 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
13124 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
13125 message = Too many lines in message header
13127 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
13128 message has not yet been received.
13130 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13132 .vitem &$message_size$&
13133 .cindex "size" "of message"
13134 .cindex "message" "size"
13135 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
13136 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
13137 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
13138 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
13139 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
13140 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
13141 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
13142 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
13143 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13145 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
13146 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
13147 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
13148 value may not, of course, be truthful.
13150 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
13151 &$mime_anomaly_text$& &&&
13152 &$mime_boundary$& &&&
13153 &$mime_charset$& &&&
13154 &$mime_content_description$& &&&
13155 &$mime_content_disposition$& &&&
13156 &$mime_content_id$& &&&
13157 &$mime_content_size$& &&&
13158 &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$& &&&
13159 &$mime_content_type$& &&&
13160 &$mime_decoded_filename$& &&&
13161 &$mime_filename$& &&&
13162 &$mime_is_coverletter$& &&&
13163 &$mime_is_multipart$& &&&
13164 &$mime_is_rfc822$& &&&
13165 &$mime_part_count$&
13166 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
13167 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
13168 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
13170 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
13171 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
13172 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
13174 .tvar &$original_domain$&
13175 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13176 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13177 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
13178 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
13179 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
13180 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
13181 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
13182 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
13184 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13185 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13186 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13188 .tvar &$original_local_part$&
13189 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13190 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13191 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
13192 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
13193 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
13194 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
13195 the original address.
13197 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
13198 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
13199 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
13200 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
13201 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
13203 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13204 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13205 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13207 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
13208 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
13209 .cindex "sender" "gid"
13210 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
13211 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
13212 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
13213 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
13214 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
13215 normally the gid of the Exim user.
13217 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
13218 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
13219 .cindex "sender" "uid"
13220 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
13221 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
13222 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
13223 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
13224 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
13227 .tvar &$parent_domain$&
13228 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
13229 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13231 .tvar &$parent_local_part$&
13232 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
13233 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13236 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
13238 This variable contains the current process id.
13240 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
13241 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
13242 .cindex "transport" "filter"
13243 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
13244 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
13245 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
13246 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
13247 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
13248 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
13249 variable"& error if encountered.
13250 &*Note*&: This value permits data supplied by a potential attacker to
13251 be used in the command for a &(pipe)& transport.
13252 Such configurations should be carefully assessed for security vulnerbilities.
13254 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
13255 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
13256 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
13257 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
13258 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
13259 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
13260 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
13263 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
13264 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
13265 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
13266 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
13268 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
13270 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
13272 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
13273 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
13274 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
13275 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
13277 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$& &&&
13278 &$prvscheck_keynum$& &&&
13279 &$prvscheck_result$&
13280 These variables are used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13281 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13282 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13284 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
13285 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
13286 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
13288 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
13289 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
13290 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
13291 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
13293 .vitem &$queue_name$&
13294 .vindex &$queue_name$&
13295 .cindex "named queues" variable
13296 .cindex queues named
13297 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
13299 .vitem &$queue_size$&
13300 .vindex "&$queue_size$&"
13301 .cindex "queue" "size of"
13302 .cindex "spool" "number of messages"
13303 This variable contains the number of messages queued.
13304 It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
13305 If there is no daemon notifier socket open, the value will be
13310 .cindex router variables
13311 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13312 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13313 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13314 and the eventual transport.
13316 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13317 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13318 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13319 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13320 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13322 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13323 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13324 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13325 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13326 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13327 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13329 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13330 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13331 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13332 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13333 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13335 .vitem &$received_count$&
13336 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
13337 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13338 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13339 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13342 .tvar &$received_for$&
13343 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13344 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13345 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13346 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13348 .vitem &$received_ip_address$& &&&
13350 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13351 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
13352 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, these
13353 variables are set to the address and port on the local IP interface.
13354 (The remote IP address and port are in
13355 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13356 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13359 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13360 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13361 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13362 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13363 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13365 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13367 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
13368 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13369 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13370 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13371 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13372 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13373 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13374 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13375 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13377 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13378 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13379 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13380 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13381 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13382 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13384 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13385 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13386 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13388 .vitem &$received_time$&
13389 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
13390 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13391 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13393 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
13394 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13395 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13396 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13397 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13399 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13400 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13402 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13403 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13404 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13405 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13407 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13408 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13409 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13410 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13413 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13414 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13417 &"route"&: Routing failed.
13420 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13421 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13425 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13428 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13431 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13432 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13434 .tvar &$recipients$&
13435 .tvar &$recipients_list$&
13436 These variables both contain the envelope recipients for a message.
13438 The first uses a comma and a space separate the addresses in the replacement text.
13439 &*Note*&: an address can legitimately contain a comma;
13440 this variable is not intended for further processing.
13442 The second is a proper Exim list; colon-separated.
13444 However, the variables
13445 are not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13446 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use either of them only in these
13450 In a system filter file.
13452 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13453 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13454 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13455 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13457 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13461 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13462 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13463 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13464 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13465 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13466 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13469 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13470 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13471 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13472 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13474 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13475 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13476 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13477 these variables contain the
13478 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13479 If the subject string was tainted then so will any captured substring.
13482 .tvar &$reply_address$&
13483 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13484 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13485 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13486 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13487 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13489 .vitem &$return_path$&
13490 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13491 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13492 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13493 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13494 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13495 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13496 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13497 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13498 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13499 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13502 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13503 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13504 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13506 .vitem &$router_name$&
13507 .cindex "router" "name"
13508 .cindex "name" "of router"
13509 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13510 During the running of a router, or a transport called,
13511 this variable contains the router name.
13514 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13515 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13516 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13517 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13518 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13519 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13520 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13523 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13524 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13525 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13526 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13527 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13528 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13529 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13530 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13532 .tvar &$sender_address$&
13533 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13534 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13535 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13536 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13538 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13539 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13540 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13541 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13542 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13543 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13544 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13545 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13547 .tvar &$sender_address_domain$&
13548 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13550 .tvar &$sender_address_local_part$&
13551 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13553 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13554 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13555 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13556 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13557 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13560 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13561 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13563 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13564 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13565 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13566 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13568 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13569 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13570 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13571 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13572 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13573 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13574 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13575 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13576 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13577 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13578 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13579 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13580 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13582 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13583 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13584 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13585 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13586 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13588 .tvar &$sender_helo_name$&
13589 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13590 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13591 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13592 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13594 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13595 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13596 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13597 this variable contains that
13598 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13600 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13601 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13602 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13603 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13604 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13605 &$authenticated_id$&.
13607 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13608 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13609 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13610 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13611 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13612 resolver library states that both
13613 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13614 other times, this variable is false.
13616 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13617 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13618 library, by setting:
13623 In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13624 default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13625 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13626 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13627 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13628 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13633 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13634 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13636 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13637 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13639 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13640 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13641 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13642 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13645 .tvar &$sender_host_name$&
13646 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13647 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13648 other means, this variable is empty.
13650 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13651 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13652 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13653 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13654 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13655 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13656 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13658 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13659 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13660 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13661 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13663 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13664 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13665 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13668 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13669 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13670 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13671 following are true:
13674 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13676 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13677 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13678 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13680 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13681 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13682 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13684 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13685 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13686 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13688 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13689 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13690 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13691 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13693 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13695 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13696 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13700 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13701 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13702 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13703 number that was used on the remote host.
13705 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13706 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13707 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13708 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13709 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13712 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13713 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13714 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13715 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13717 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13718 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13719 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13720 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13721 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13722 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13723 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13724 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13725 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13726 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13727 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13730 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13731 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13732 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13733 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13734 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13736 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13737 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13738 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13739 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13740 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13742 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13743 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13744 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13745 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13746 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13747 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13748 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13750 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13751 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13752 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13753 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13754 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13756 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13757 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13758 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13759 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13760 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13761 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13763 .tvar &$smtp_command$&
13764 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13765 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13766 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13771 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13772 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13773 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13774 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13776 .tvar &$smtp_command_argument$&
13777 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13778 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13779 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13780 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13781 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13783 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13784 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13785 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13786 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13787 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13790 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13791 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13792 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13793 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13794 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13795 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13796 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13797 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13798 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13799 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13800 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13802 .vitem &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
13803 .vindex "&$smtp_notquit_reason$&"
13804 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, this variable is set to a string
13805 that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP connection.
13807 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13808 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13809 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13810 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13811 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13812 message is junk mail.
13814 .vitem &$spam_score$& &&&
13815 &$spam_score_int$& &&&
13817 &$spam_report$& &&&
13819 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13820 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13821 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13823 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13824 &$spf_received$& &&&
13826 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13827 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13828 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13829 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13831 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13832 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13833 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13835 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13836 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13837 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13838 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13839 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13840 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13842 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13843 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13844 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13845 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13846 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13847 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13848 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13849 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13851 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13853 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13856 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13857 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13858 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13859 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13860 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13861 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13863 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13864 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13865 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13866 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13867 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13868 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13869 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13870 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13872 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13873 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13876 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13877 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13878 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13879 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13880 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13881 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13883 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13884 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13885 .cindex certificate variables
13886 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13887 inbound connection when the message was received.
13888 It is only useful as the argument of a
13889 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13890 or a &%def%& condition.
13892 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13893 when a list of more than one
13894 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13895 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13897 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13898 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13899 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13900 inbound connection when the message was received.
13901 It is only useful as the argument of a
13902 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13903 or a &%def%& condition.
13904 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13905 which is not the leaf.
13907 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13908 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13909 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13910 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13911 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13912 or a &%def%& condition.
13914 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13915 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13916 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13917 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13918 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13919 or a &%def%& condition.
13920 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13921 which is not the leaf.
13923 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13924 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13925 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13926 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13928 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13929 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13932 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13933 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13934 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13935 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13936 and &"0"& otherwise.
13938 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13939 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13940 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13941 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13942 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13943 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13944 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13945 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13946 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13948 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13949 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13950 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13952 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13953 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13954 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13956 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13957 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13959 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13960 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13961 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13962 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13964 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13965 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13966 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13968 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13969 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13970 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13972 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13973 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13974 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13975 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13977 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13978 1 No response to request
13979 2 Response not verified
13980 3 Verification failed
13981 4 Verification succeeded
13984 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13985 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13986 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13987 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13988 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13990 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13991 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13992 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13993 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13994 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13995 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13996 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13997 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13998 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13999 which is not the leaf.
14001 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
14002 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14005 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
14006 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
14007 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14008 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
14009 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14010 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14011 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14012 which is not the leaf.
14015 .vitem &$tls_in_resumption$& &&&
14016 &$tls_out_resumption$&
14017 .vindex &$tls_in_resumption$&
14018 .vindex &$tls_out_resumption$&
14019 .cindex TLS resumption
14020 Observability for TLS session resumption. See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
14023 .tvar &$tls_in_sni$&
14024 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
14025 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14027 .cindex SNI "observability on server"
14028 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
14029 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
14030 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
14031 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
14032 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
14033 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
14034 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
14036 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
14037 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14040 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
14041 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
14042 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14044 .cindex SNI "observability in client"
14046 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
14049 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14050 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14051 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14053 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
14054 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
14055 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14056 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
14058 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
14059 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
14060 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14061 this variable is set to the protocol version.
14064 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
14065 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
14066 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
14067 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
14069 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
14070 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
14071 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14073 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
14074 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
14075 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14077 .vitem &$tod_full$&
14078 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
14079 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
14080 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
14081 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
14082 values for those that are behind (west).
14085 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14086 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
14087 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
14089 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
14090 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
14091 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
14092 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
14095 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
14096 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14097 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
14100 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
14101 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
14102 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
14103 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
14105 .vitem &$transport_name$&
14106 .cindex "transport" "name"
14107 .cindex "name" "of transport"
14108 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
14109 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
14112 .vindex "&$value$&"
14113 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
14114 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
14115 &*reduce*& expansion.
14117 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
14118 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
14119 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
14120 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
14123 .vitem &$version_number$&
14124 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
14125 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
14126 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
14128 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
14129 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
14130 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14131 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14133 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
14134 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
14135 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14136 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14142 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14143 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14145 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
14146 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
14147 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
14148 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
14149 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
14150 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
14155 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
14158 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
14159 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
14160 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
14161 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
14162 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
14163 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
14164 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
14165 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
14166 a newly created Perl interpreter.
14168 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
14169 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
14170 should usually be something like
14172 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
14174 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
14175 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
14176 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
14177 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
14178 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
14179 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
14180 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
14181 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
14185 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
14186 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
14187 a startup when Exim is entered.
14189 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
14190 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
14193 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
14194 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
14197 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
14198 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
14199 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
14200 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
14201 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
14202 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
14205 &*Note*&: This is entirely separate from Exim's tainted-data tracking.
14208 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
14209 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
14210 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
14211 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
14215 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
14216 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
14218 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
14219 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
14220 with an error message of the form
14222 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
14224 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
14225 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
14226 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
14227 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
14228 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
14229 that was passed to &%die%&.
14232 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
14233 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
14234 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
14237 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
14239 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
14240 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
14241 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
14243 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
14244 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
14245 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
14246 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
14248 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
14249 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
14250 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
14251 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
14252 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
14253 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
14254 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
14257 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
14258 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
14259 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
14260 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
14261 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
14262 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
14263 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
14264 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
14265 avoided, but the output is lost.
14267 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
14268 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
14269 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
14270 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
14271 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
14272 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
14273 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
14275 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
14277 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
14278 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
14279 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
14280 as the first subroutine argument.
14284 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14285 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14287 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
14288 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
14289 "Starting the daemon"
14290 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
14291 .cindex "interface" "listening"
14292 .cindex "network interface"
14293 .cindex "interface" "network"
14294 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
14295 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
14296 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
14297 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14298 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
14299 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
14300 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
14301 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
14302 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
14303 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
14304 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
14307 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
14308 and ports to listen on.
14310 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
14311 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
14312 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
14313 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
14314 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
14315 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
14316 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
14317 as an error situation.
14319 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
14320 for the outgoing connection.
14324 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
14325 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
14326 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
14327 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
14328 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
14330 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14331 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14332 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14333 chapter describes how they operate.
14335 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14336 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14340 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14341 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14342 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14346 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14348 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14350 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14351 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14354 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14355 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14356 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14357 colons. For example:
14359 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14362 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14364 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14365 in &%local_interfaces%&:
14368 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14369 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14371 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14372 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14375 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14376 with a colon separator, for example:
14378 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14379 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14383 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14384 default setting contains just one port:
14386 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14388 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14389 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14390 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14391 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14392 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14396 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14397 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14398 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14399 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14400 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14401 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14403 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14405 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14407 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14409 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14413 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14414 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14415 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14416 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14417 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14418 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14421 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14422 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14423 If there are any items that do not
14424 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14425 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14426 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14427 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14431 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14434 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14436 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14437 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14438 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14442 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14443 .cindex "submissions protocol"
14444 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14445 .cindex "smtps protocol"
14446 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14447 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14448 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14449 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14450 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14451 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14452 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14453 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14454 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14457 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14458 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14459 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14461 The common use of this option is expected to be
14463 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14466 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14467 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14469 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14470 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14471 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14472 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14473 connections via the daemon.)
14478 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14479 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14480 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14481 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14482 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14483 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14484 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14485 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14487 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14489 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14490 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14491 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14492 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14493 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14494 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14496 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14498 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14499 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14500 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14501 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14502 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14504 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14505 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14506 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14507 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14508 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14509 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14510 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14511 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14512 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14513 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14514 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14515 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14517 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14518 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14519 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14520 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14521 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14525 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14526 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14528 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14529 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14531 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14532 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14533 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14534 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14536 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14538 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14540 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14542 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14543 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14545 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14546 IPv4 loopback address only:
14548 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14550 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14552 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14554 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14558 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14559 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14560 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14561 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14564 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14565 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14566 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14567 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14569 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14570 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14571 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14572 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14573 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14574 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14575 used for listening. Consider this example:
14577 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14579 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14581 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14583 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14584 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14587 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14588 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14589 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14590 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14591 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14592 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14593 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14594 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14598 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14599 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14600 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14601 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14602 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14603 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14610 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14612 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14613 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14614 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14615 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14618 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14619 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14621 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14622 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14623 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14625 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14626 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14627 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14628 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14632 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14633 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14634 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14635 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14636 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14637 listed in more than one group.
14639 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14641 .row &%add_environment%& "environment variables"
14642 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14643 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14644 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14645 .row &%keep_environment%& "environment variables"
14646 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14647 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14648 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14649 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14650 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14651 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14652 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14653 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14657 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14659 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14660 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14661 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14662 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14663 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14664 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14669 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14671 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14672 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14673 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14674 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14675 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14676 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14677 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14678 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14679 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14680 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14681 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14682 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14687 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14689 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14690 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14691 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14692 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14693 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14694 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14695 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14696 .row &%panic_coredump%& "request coredump on fatal errors"
14697 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14698 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14699 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14700 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14701 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14702 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14703 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14704 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14709 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14711 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14712 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14713 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14714 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14719 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14721 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14722 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14723 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14724 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14725 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14726 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14727 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14728 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14729 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14730 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14731 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14732 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14733 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14734 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14735 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14740 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14742 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14743 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14748 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14750 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14751 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14752 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14757 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14759 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14760 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14761 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14762 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14763 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14764 .row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14765 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14766 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14767 .row &%smtp_backlog_monitor%& "level to log listen backlog"
14772 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14774 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14775 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14776 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14777 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14778 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14779 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14780 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14781 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14782 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14783 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14784 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14785 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14786 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14787 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14788 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14789 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14791 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14792 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14793 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14794 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14795 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14800 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14802 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14803 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14804 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14805 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14806 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14807 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14808 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14809 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14810 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14811 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14812 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14813 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14814 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14815 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14816 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14817 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14818 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14819 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14820 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14821 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14822 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14823 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14825 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14826 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14827 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14828 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14829 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14830 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14831 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14832 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14833 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14834 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14835 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14836 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14837 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14838 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14839 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14840 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14841 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14842 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14843 .row &%proxy_protocol_timeout%& "timeout for proxy protocol negotiation"
14844 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14845 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14846 .row &%spf_smtp_comment_template%& "template for &$spf_smtp_comment$&"
14851 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14853 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14855 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14857 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14858 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14859 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14864 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14866 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14867 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14868 .row &%hosts_require_alpn%& "mandatory ALPN"
14869 .row &%hosts_require_helo%& "mandatory HELO/EHLO"
14870 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14871 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14872 .row &%tls_alpn%& "acceptable protocol names"
14873 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14874 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14875 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14876 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14877 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14878 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14879 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14880 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14881 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14882 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14883 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14884 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14885 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14890 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14892 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14893 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14894 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14895 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14896 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14897 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14898 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14899 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14904 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14906 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14907 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14908 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14909 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14910 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14911 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14912 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14913 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14919 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14921 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14928 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14929 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14932 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14933 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14934 .row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
14935 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14936 .row &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& "DMARC sender for report messages"
14937 .row &%dmarc_history_file%& "DMARC results log"
14938 .row &%dmarc_tld_file%& "DMARC toplevel domains file"
14939 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14940 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14941 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14942 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14943 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14944 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14945 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14946 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14947 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14948 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14949 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14950 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14951 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14952 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14954 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14955 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14956 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14957 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14958 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14959 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14960 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14961 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14962 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14963 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14964 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14965 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14966 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14967 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14968 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14969 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14974 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14976 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14977 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14978 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14979 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14980 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14981 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14982 .row &%limits_advertise_hosts%& "advertise LIMITS to these hosts"
14983 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14984 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14985 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14986 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14987 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14992 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14994 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14995 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14996 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14997 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14999 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15000 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15001 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
15002 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
15003 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
15004 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
15005 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15006 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
15007 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
15008 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
15013 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
15015 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
15016 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
15018 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
15019 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
15020 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
15021 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
15022 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
15027 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
15029 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
15030 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
15031 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
15032 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
15033 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
15034 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
15035 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
15036 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
15037 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
15038 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
15039 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
15040 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
15041 .row &%queue_fast_ramp%& "parallel delivery with 2-phase queue run"
15042 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
15043 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
15044 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
15045 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
15046 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
15047 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
15048 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
15049 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
15050 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
15051 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
15052 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
15053 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
15058 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
15060 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
15061 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
15062 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
15063 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
15064 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
15065 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
15066 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
15067 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
15068 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
15069 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
15070 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
15071 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
15072 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
15073 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15074 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
15079 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
15080 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
15083 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
15085 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15086 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15087 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
15088 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" 8BITMIME
15089 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
15090 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
15091 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
15092 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
15094 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
15095 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
15096 It now defaults to true.
15097 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
15099 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
15102 To log received 8BITMIME status use
15104 log_selector = +8bitmime
15107 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
15108 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
15109 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15110 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
15111 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
15114 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15115 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
15116 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
15119 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
15120 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
15121 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15122 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
15123 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15125 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
15126 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
15127 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
15128 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
15129 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15131 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
15132 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
15133 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
15134 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15136 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
15137 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
15138 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
15139 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
15140 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15142 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
15143 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
15144 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
15145 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
15146 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
15147 This option defines the ACL that,
15148 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
15149 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
15150 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
15151 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15153 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
15154 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
15155 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
15156 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
15157 of a received message.
15158 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
15160 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
15161 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
15162 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
15163 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15165 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
15166 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
15167 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
15168 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15170 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
15171 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
15172 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
15173 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
15174 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15177 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
15178 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
15179 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
15180 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15182 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
15183 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
15184 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
15185 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
15186 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15188 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15189 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
15190 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
15191 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
15192 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
15194 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
15195 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
15196 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
15197 ends without a QUIT command being received.
15198 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15200 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
15201 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
15202 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
15205 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
15206 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
15207 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
15208 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15210 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
15211 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
15212 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
15213 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15215 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
15216 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
15217 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
15218 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15220 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
15221 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
15222 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
15223 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15225 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
15226 .cindex "environment" "set values"
15227 This option adds individual environment variables that the
15228 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
15229 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
15231 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
15233 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15234 .cindex "admin user"
15235 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
15236 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
15237 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
15238 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
15239 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
15240 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
15241 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
15243 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
15244 .cindex "domain literal"
15245 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
15246 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
15247 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
15248 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
15250 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
15251 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
15252 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
15253 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
15254 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
15255 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
15256 the local host's IP addresses.
15258 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
15259 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
15260 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
15261 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
15262 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
15263 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
15264 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
15265 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
15266 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
15268 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
15269 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
15270 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
15271 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
15272 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
15273 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
15274 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
15276 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
15277 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
15278 letters, digits, and hyphens.
15280 If Exim is built with internationalization support
15281 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
15282 this option can be left as default.
15284 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
15285 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
15286 suitable setting is:
15288 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
15289 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
15291 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
15293 dns_check_names_pattern =
15295 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
15298 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15299 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
15300 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
15301 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
15302 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
15303 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
15304 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
15305 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
15306 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
15307 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
15308 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
15309 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
15311 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
15312 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
15313 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
15314 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
15315 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
15316 which Exim advertises AUTH.
15318 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
15319 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
15320 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
15321 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
15323 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
15325 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
15326 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
15327 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
15328 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
15331 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
15332 .cindex "thawing messages"
15333 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
15334 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
15335 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
15336 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
15337 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
15338 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
15340 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
15341 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
15342 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
15345 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
15346 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15347 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15349 sophie:/var/run/sophie
15351 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15352 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15355 .option bi_command main string unset
15357 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15358 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15359 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15360 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15363 .option bounce_message_file main string&!! unset
15364 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15365 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15366 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15367 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15368 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
15369 .cindex bounce_message_file "tainted data"
15370 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
15371 absolute and untainted.
15372 See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15375 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
15376 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15377 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15378 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15380 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15381 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15382 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15383 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15384 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15385 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15386 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15387 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15388 point at which the error was detected are returned.
15389 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15391 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15392 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15393 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15394 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15395 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15396 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15397 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15398 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15399 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15400 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15402 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15403 during reception of a message.
15404 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15406 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15409 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15410 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15411 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15412 &%bounce_return_body%&.
15415 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15416 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15417 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15418 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15419 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15420 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15421 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15422 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15423 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15425 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15426 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15427 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15428 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15429 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15432 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15433 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15434 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15435 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15436 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15437 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15438 connection. A typical setting might be:
15440 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15442 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15444 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15446 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15449 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15450 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15451 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15452 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15453 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15454 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15457 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15458 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15459 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15460 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15463 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15464 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15465 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15466 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15469 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15470 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15471 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15472 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15475 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15476 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15477 callout verification. The default value is
15479 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15481 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15484 .options check_log_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15485 check_log_space main integer 10M
15486 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15488 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15489 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15490 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15491 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15492 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15493 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15494 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15495 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15496 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15497 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15500 .options check_spool_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15501 check_spool_space main integer 10M
15502 .cindex "checking disk space"
15503 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15504 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15505 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15506 message is accepted.
15508 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15509 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15510 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15511 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15512 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15513 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15514 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15515 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15518 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15519 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15521 check_spool_space = 100M
15522 check_spool_inodes = 100
15524 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15525 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15528 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15529 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15530 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15532 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15533 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15534 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15535 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15536 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15537 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15539 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15540 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15541 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15543 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15544 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15545 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15547 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15548 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15549 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15550 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15552 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15553 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15554 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15555 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" CHUNKING
15556 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15558 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15560 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15561 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15562 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15563 administrative user.
15564 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15566 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15567 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15568 .cindex memory debugging
15569 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15570 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15571 it should normally be left as default.
15573 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15574 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15575 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15576 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15577 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15578 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15580 .options daemon_startup_retries main integer 9 &&&
15581 daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15582 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15583 These options control the retrying done by
15584 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15585 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15586 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15587 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15589 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15590 .cindex "warning of delay"
15591 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15592 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15593 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15594 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15595 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15596 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15597 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15598 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15601 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15603 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15604 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15605 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15606 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15610 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15611 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15613 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15615 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15616 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15617 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15619 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15620 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15621 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15622 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15623 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15624 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15625 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15626 not sent. The default is:
15628 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15629 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15630 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15631 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15634 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15635 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15636 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15637 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15639 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15640 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15641 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15642 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15643 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15644 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15645 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15646 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15648 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15649 .cindex "load average"
15650 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15651 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15652 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15653 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15654 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15657 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15658 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15659 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15660 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15661 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15662 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15663 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15664 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15666 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15667 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15668 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15669 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15670 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15671 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15672 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15673 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15675 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15676 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15677 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15678 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15681 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15682 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15683 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15684 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15685 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15686 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15687 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15690 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15691 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15692 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15693 and an order of processing.
15694 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15696 Acceptable values include:
15703 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15705 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15706 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15707 and an order of processing.
15708 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15711 .option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15712 This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15713 The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15714 Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15716 The default enforces the RFC 8301 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15718 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15719 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15722 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15723 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15724 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15725 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15726 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15727 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15730 .option dmarc_forensic_sender main string&!! unset &&&
15731 dmarc_history_file main string unset &&&
15732 dmarc_tld_file main string unset
15733 .cindex DMARC "main section options"
15734 These options control DMARC processing.
15735 See section &<<SECDMARC>>& for details.
15738 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15739 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15740 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15741 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15742 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15743 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15744 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15745 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15746 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15747 by a setting such as this:
15749 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15751 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does,
15752 except for TLSA lookups (where knowing about such failures
15753 is security-relevant).
15754 It also applies when the
15755 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15756 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15757 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15758 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15759 options are applied after this global option.
15761 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15762 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15763 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15764 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15765 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15766 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15767 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15768 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15769 value of this option. The default pattern is
15771 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15772 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15774 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15775 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15776 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15777 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15778 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15781 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15782 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15783 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15785 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15786 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15787 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15788 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15790 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15791 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15792 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15793 not do it internally.
15794 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15795 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15797 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15798 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15799 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15802 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15803 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15804 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15805 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15806 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15807 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15809 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15811 On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
15812 will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
15813 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
15814 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
15815 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
15816 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
15822 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15823 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15824 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15825 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15826 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15827 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15828 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15829 domain matches this list.
15831 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15832 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15833 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15834 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15835 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15836 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15839 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15840 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15841 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15842 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15843 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15844 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15845 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15846 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15847 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15848 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15849 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15850 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15852 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15855 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15856 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15859 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15860 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15861 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15862 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15863 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15864 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15865 match with this expanded domain list.
15867 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15868 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15869 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15870 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15871 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15872 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15874 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15875 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15876 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15878 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15879 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15880 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15881 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15882 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15884 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15885 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15886 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15887 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15888 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15889 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15890 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15891 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15894 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15896 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15897 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15898 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15901 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15902 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15903 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15904 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15906 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15907 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15908 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15909 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15910 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" DSN
15911 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15912 and accepted from, these hosts.
15913 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ORCPT options on RCPT TO commands,
15914 and RET and ENVID options on MAIL FROM commands.
15915 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15916 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15918 &*Note*&: Supplying success-DSN messages has been criticised
15919 on privacy grounds; it can leak details of internal forwarding.
15921 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15922 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15923 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15924 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15925 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15926 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15928 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15930 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15931 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15933 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15934 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15935 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15936 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15937 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15938 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15939 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15940 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15941 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15944 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15945 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15946 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15947 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15948 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15949 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15950 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15951 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15952 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15954 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15955 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15956 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15957 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15958 are examined. For example:
15960 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15961 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15962 postmaster@mydomain.example
15964 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15965 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15966 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15967 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15968 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15969 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15970 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15973 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15974 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15975 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15977 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15979 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15980 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15981 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15982 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15983 overrides the default.
15985 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15986 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15987 and warning messages. For example:
15989 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15991 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15992 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15993 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15994 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15998 .option event_action main string&!! unset
16000 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
16001 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
16004 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
16005 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
16006 .cindex "Exim group"
16007 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16008 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
16009 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
16010 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
16011 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
16015 .option exim_path main string "see below"
16016 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
16017 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
16018 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
16019 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
16020 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
16022 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
16023 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
16024 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
16025 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
16028 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
16029 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
16030 .cindex "Exim user"
16031 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16032 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
16033 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
16034 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
16036 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
16037 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
16038 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
16039 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
16042 .option exim_version main string "current version"
16043 .cindex "Exim version"
16044 .cindex customizing "version number"
16045 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
16046 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
16047 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
16050 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
16051 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
16052 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
16053 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
16056 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16057 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16059 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
16060 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
16062 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
16063 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
16064 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
16065 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
16066 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
16067 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
16068 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
16069 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
16070 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
16071 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
16075 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
16076 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
16077 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
16078 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
16079 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
16080 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
16081 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
16082 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
16085 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
16086 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
16087 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
16088 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
16092 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
16093 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16094 .cindex "frozen messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16095 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
16096 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
16097 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
16098 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
16099 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
16100 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
16101 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
16102 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
16103 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
16104 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
16105 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
16106 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
16107 logging that you require.
16110 .options gecos_name main string&!! unset &&&
16111 gecos_pattern main string unset
16113 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
16114 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
16115 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
16116 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
16117 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
16118 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
16119 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
16120 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
16122 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
16123 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
16124 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
16127 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
16128 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
16129 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
16130 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
16132 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
16137 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
16138 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
16139 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
16140 implementations of TLS.
16143 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
16144 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
16145 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
16148 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
16153 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
16154 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
16155 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
16156 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
16157 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
16158 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
16162 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
16163 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
16164 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
16165 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
16166 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
16167 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
16168 sections are rejected.
16171 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
16172 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
16173 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
16174 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
16175 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
16176 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
16177 zero means &"no limit"&.
16182 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16183 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
16184 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
16185 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
16186 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
16187 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
16188 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
16189 if you want to do semantic checking.
16190 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
16194 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
16195 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
16196 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
16197 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
16198 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
16199 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
16200 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
16202 helo_allow_chars = _
16204 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
16207 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
16208 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16209 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16210 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
16211 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
16212 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
16213 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
16217 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16218 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
16219 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
16220 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
16221 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
16222 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
16223 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
16224 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
16225 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
16226 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
16227 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
16228 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
16230 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
16231 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
16232 EHLO command either:
16235 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
16237 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
16238 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
16239 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
16240 calling host address, or
16242 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
16245 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
16246 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
16247 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
16249 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
16250 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16251 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
16253 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16254 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
16255 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
16256 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
16257 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
16258 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
16259 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
16260 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
16261 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
16264 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16265 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
16266 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
16267 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
16268 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
16269 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
16270 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
16271 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
16272 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
16274 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
16275 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
16276 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
16277 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
16278 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
16280 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
16281 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
16282 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
16283 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
16286 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
16287 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
16288 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
16289 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
16290 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
16291 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
16292 default configuration file contains
16296 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
16297 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
16299 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
16300 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
16301 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
16303 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
16304 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
16305 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
16306 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
16307 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
16308 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
16311 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
16312 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
16313 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
16314 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
16315 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
16318 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
16319 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
16320 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
16321 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
16325 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
16326 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
16327 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
16328 as soon as the connection is made.
16329 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
16330 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
16331 connections immediately.
16333 If the connection is on a TLS-on-connect port then the TCP connection is
16334 just dropped. Otherwise, an SMTP error is sent first.
16336 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
16337 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
16338 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
16339 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
16340 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
16343 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
16344 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
16345 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
16346 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
16347 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
16348 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
16349 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
16350 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
16351 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16353 hosts_connection_nolog = :
16355 The hosts affected by this option also do not log "no MAIL in SMTP connection"
16356 lines, as may commonly be produced by a monitoring system.
16359 .option hosts_require_alpn main "host list&!!" unset
16360 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in server"
16362 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
16363 If the TLS library supports ALPN
16364 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any client
16365 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
16366 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
16368 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
16369 managed by this option, and should be done separately.
16372 .option hosts_require_helo main "host list&!!" *
16373 .cindex "HELO/EHLO" requiring
16374 Exim will require an accepted HELO or EHLO command from a host matching
16375 this list, before accepting a MAIL command.
16378 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16379 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16380 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16381 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16384 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16385 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16386 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
16387 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16388 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16390 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16391 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16393 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16394 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16395 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16396 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16397 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16398 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16399 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16402 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16403 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16404 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16405 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16406 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16410 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16411 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16412 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
16413 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16414 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16415 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16417 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16418 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16419 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16420 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16421 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16422 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16423 for frozen messages. For example,
16425 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16427 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16428 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16429 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16430 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16431 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16432 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16435 .options ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
16436 ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16437 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16438 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16439 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16440 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16441 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16442 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16443 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16444 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16445 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16449 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16450 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16451 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16452 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16453 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16454 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16455 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16456 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16457 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16459 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16460 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16462 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16463 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16464 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16465 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16467 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16468 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16469 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16472 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16473 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16474 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16478 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
16479 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16480 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16481 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16485 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16486 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16487 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16488 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16489 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16490 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16491 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16492 and constrained to be a directory.
16495 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16496 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16497 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16498 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16499 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16500 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16501 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16502 and constrained to be a file.
16505 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16506 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16507 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16508 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16509 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16510 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16513 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16514 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16515 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16516 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16517 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16518 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16519 identity to be proven.
16522 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16523 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16524 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16525 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16526 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16529 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16530 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16531 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16532 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16533 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16537 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16538 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16539 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16540 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16541 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16542 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16546 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16547 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16548 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16549 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16550 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16552 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16553 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16554 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16557 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16558 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16559 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16560 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16561 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16562 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16563 has been built with LDAP support.
16568 .option limits_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16569 .cindex LIMITS "suppressing advertising"
16570 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
16571 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16572 LIMITS extension (RFC 9422) to specific hosts.
16573 If permitted, Exim as a servier will advertise in the EHLO response
16574 the limit for RCPT commands set by the &%recipients_max%& option (if it is set)
16575 and the limit for MAIL commands set by the &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%&
16579 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16580 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16581 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16582 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16583 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16584 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16585 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16587 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16588 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16589 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16591 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16592 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16593 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16594 and the default qualify domain.
16596 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16597 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16598 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16599 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16601 .cindex "envelope from"
16602 .cindex "envelope sender"
16603 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16604 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16605 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16607 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16608 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16609 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16614 .options local_from_prefix main string unset &&&
16615 local_from_suffix main string unset
16616 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16617 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16618 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16619 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16620 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16621 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16624 local_from_prefix = *-
16626 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16628 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16630 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16631 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16635 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16636 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16637 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16638 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16639 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16640 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16641 &%local_interfaces%& is
16643 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16645 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16647 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16650 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16651 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16652 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16653 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16654 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16655 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16656 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16657 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16661 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16662 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16663 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16664 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16665 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16666 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16667 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16668 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16673 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16674 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16675 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16676 .cindex multiple "systems sharing a spool"
16677 .cindex "multiple hosts" "sharing a spool"
16678 .cindex "shared spool directory"
16679 .cindex "spool directory" sharing
16680 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16681 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16682 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required
16683 (eg. because they share a spool directory),
16684 each host must set a different
16685 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16686 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16687 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16688 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16689 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16690 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number%& is set, the final four
16691 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16692 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16693 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16697 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16698 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16699 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16700 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16701 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16702 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16703 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16704 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16705 A path must start with a slash.
16706 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16707 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16708 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16709 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16710 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16711 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16712 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16713 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16716 .option log_selector main string unset
16717 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16718 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16719 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16720 minus characters. For example:
16722 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16724 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16725 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16728 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16729 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16730 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16731 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16732 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16733 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16734 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16735 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16736 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16737 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16738 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16739 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16740 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16743 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16744 .cindex "too many open files"
16745 .cindex "open files, too many"
16746 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16747 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16748 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16749 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16750 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16751 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16752 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16753 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16754 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16755 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16756 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16757 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16760 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16761 .cindex "length of login name"
16762 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16763 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16764 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16765 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16766 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16767 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16770 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16771 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16772 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16773 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16774 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16775 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16776 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16777 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16780 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16781 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16782 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16783 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16784 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16785 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16786 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16789 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16790 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16791 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16792 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16793 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16794 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16795 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16796 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16797 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16798 empty string, the option is ignored.
16801 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16802 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16803 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16804 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16805 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16806 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16807 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16808 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16809 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16810 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16811 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16812 colons will become hyphens.
16815 .option message_logs main boolean true
16816 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16817 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16818 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16819 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16820 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16821 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16822 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16823 which is not affected by this option.
16826 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16827 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16828 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16829 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16830 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16831 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16832 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16833 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16834 optionally followed by K or M.
16836 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
16837 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
16838 If nonzero the value will be advertised as a parameter to the ESMTP SIZE
16839 service extension keyword.
16841 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16842 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16843 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16844 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16845 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16847 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16848 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16849 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16850 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16851 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16852 message that an individual transport can process.
16854 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16855 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16856 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16857 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16858 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16859 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16860 some problems may result.
16862 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16863 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16864 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16867 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16868 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16869 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16871 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16873 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16874 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16875 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16876 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16877 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16880 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16881 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16882 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16883 contains a full description of this facility.
16887 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16888 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16889 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16890 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16891 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16894 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16895 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16896 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16897 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16898 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16901 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16902 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16903 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16904 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16905 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16907 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16908 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16911 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16913 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16914 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16918 .option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
16919 This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
16920 listens for work and information-requests.
16921 Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
16922 should need to modify the default.
16924 The option is expanded before use.
16925 If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
16926 is used with a nul byte prefixed.
16928 it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
16931 If this option is set as empty,
16932 or the command line &%-oY%& option is used, or
16933 the command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&,
16934 then a notifier socket is not created.
16937 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16938 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16939 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16940 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16941 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16943 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16944 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16945 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16946 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16947 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16948 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16949 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16951 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16952 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16953 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16954 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16955 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16957 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16959 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16960 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16961 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16962 some now infamous attacks.
16966 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16967 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16968 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16970 # Disable older protocol versions:
16971 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16974 Possible options may include:
16978 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16980 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16982 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16986 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16988 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16990 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16992 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16994 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16996 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
17000 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
17014 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
17018 &`single_ecdh_use`&
17020 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
17022 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
17024 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
17028 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
17031 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
17032 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
17033 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
17034 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
17035 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
17036 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
17039 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
17040 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
17041 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
17042 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
17043 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
17046 .option panic_coredump main boolean false
17047 This option is rarely needed but can help for some debugging investigations.
17048 If set, when an internal error is detected by Exim which is sufficient
17049 to terminate the process
17050 (all such are logged in the paniclog)
17051 then a coredump is requested.
17053 Note that most systems require additional administrative configuration
17054 to permit write a core file for a setuid program, which is Exim's
17055 common installed configuration.
17057 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17058 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
17059 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
17060 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
17061 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
17062 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
17063 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
17064 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
17065 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
17066 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
17069 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
17070 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
17071 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
17072 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
17073 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
17074 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
17075 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
17078 .options perl_at_start main boolean false &&&
17079 perl_startup main string unset
17081 These options are available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
17082 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of their use.
17084 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
17086 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
17089 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
17090 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
17091 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
17092 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
17093 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
17094 PostgreSQL support.
17097 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
17098 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
17099 .cindex "pid file, path for"
17100 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
17101 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
17104 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
17106 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
17108 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
17109 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
17110 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
17113 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17114 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
17115 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
17116 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
17117 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
17118 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
17119 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
17120 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
17121 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
17122 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
17124 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17125 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
17126 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
17127 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPECONNECT
17128 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
17129 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
17130 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
17131 commands are acceptable.
17132 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
17134 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
17136 The SMTP service extension keyword advertised is &"PIPECONNECT"&;
17137 it permits the client to pipeline
17138 TCP connection and hello command (inclear phase),
17139 or TLS-establishment and hello command (encrypted phase),
17140 on later connections to the same host.
17143 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
17144 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
17145 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
17146 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
17147 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
17148 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
17149 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
17150 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
17151 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
17153 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
17154 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
17155 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
17156 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
17157 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
17158 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
17159 volume of mail. Use with care!
17162 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
17163 .cindex "name" "of local host"
17164 .cindex "host" "name of local"
17165 .cindex "local host" "name of"
17166 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17167 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
17168 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
17169 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
17170 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
17171 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
17173 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
17174 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
17175 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
17176 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
17177 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
17178 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
17181 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
17182 .cindex "printing characters"
17183 .cindex "8-bit characters"
17184 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
17185 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
17186 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
17187 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
17188 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
17191 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
17192 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
17193 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
17194 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
17195 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
17199 .option process_log_path main string unset
17200 .cindex "process log path"
17201 .cindex "log" "process log"
17202 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
17203 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
17204 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
17205 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
17206 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
17207 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
17208 different spool directories.
17211 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
17212 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17216 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
17217 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
17218 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17221 .option proxy_protocol_timeout main time 3s
17222 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
17223 This option sets the timeout for proxy protocol negotiation.
17224 For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
17227 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
17228 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
17229 .cindex "address" "qualification"
17230 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
17231 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
17232 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
17233 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
17234 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
17235 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
17237 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
17238 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
17239 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
17240 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
17241 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
17242 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
17243 &%primary_hostname%& value.
17246 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
17247 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
17248 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
17252 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17253 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
17254 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17255 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
17256 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
17257 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
17258 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
17259 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
17262 .option queue_fast_ramp main boolean true
17263 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
17264 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
17265 If set to true, two-phase queue runs, initiated using &%-qq%& on the
17266 command line, may start parallel delivery processes during their first
17267 phase. This will be done when a threshold number of messages have been
17268 routed for a single host.
17271 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
17272 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17274 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
17275 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
17276 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
17277 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17280 .option queue_only main boolean false
17281 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17282 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
17283 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
17284 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
17285 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
17286 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
17288 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
17289 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
17290 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
17291 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
17294 .option queue_only_file main "string list" unset
17295 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17296 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
17297 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
17298 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
17299 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
17300 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
17301 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
17302 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
17304 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
17306 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
17307 &_/some/file_& exists.
17310 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
17311 .cindex "load average"
17312 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17313 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
17314 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
17315 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
17316 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
17317 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
17318 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17321 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
17322 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
17323 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
17324 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17327 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
17328 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
17329 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
17330 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
17331 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
17332 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
17333 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
17334 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
17335 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
17336 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17337 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
17338 re-evaluated for each message.
17341 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
17342 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17343 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
17344 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
17345 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
17346 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
17349 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
17350 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
17351 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
17352 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
17353 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
17354 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
17355 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
17356 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
17357 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
17358 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
17359 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
17360 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
17361 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
17365 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
17366 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
17367 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
17368 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
17369 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
17370 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
17371 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
17372 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
17373 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
17375 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
17376 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
17377 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
17378 the daemon's command line.
17380 .cindex queues named
17381 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
17382 To set limits for different named queues use
17383 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
17385 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17386 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17387 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
17388 .cindex "first pass routing"
17389 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
17390 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
17391 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
17392 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
17393 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
17394 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
17395 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
17396 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
17397 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
17398 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
17402 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
17403 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
17404 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
17405 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
17406 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
17407 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
17408 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
17410 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
17411 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
17412 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
17413 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
17414 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
17415 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
17416 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
17417 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
17418 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
17420 The default setting is:
17423 received_header_text = Received: \
17424 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17425 {${if def:sender_ident \
17426 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17427 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17428 by $primary_hostname \
17429 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17430 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17431 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17432 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17433 ${if def:sender_address \
17434 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17435 id $message_exim_id\
17436 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17439 The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17440 omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17441 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17442 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17443 header lines such as the following:
17445 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17446 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17447 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17448 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17449 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17450 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17451 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17453 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17454 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17455 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17456 message was accepted.
17459 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
17460 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
17461 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
17462 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17463 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17464 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17465 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17466 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17469 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17470 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17471 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17472 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17473 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17474 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17475 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17476 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17477 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17478 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17479 option was not set.
17482 .option recipients_max main integer&!! 50000
17483 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17484 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17485 If the value resulting from expanding this option
17486 is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17487 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17488 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17489 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17490 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17494 For SMTP message the expansion is done after the connection is
17495 accepted (but before any SMTP conversation) and may depend on
17496 the IP addresses and port numbers of the connection.
17497 &*Note*&: If an expansion is used for the option,
17498 care should be taken that a resonable value results for
17502 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17503 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17504 RCPT commands in a single message.
17507 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17508 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17509 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17510 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17511 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17512 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17513 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17516 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 4
17517 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17518 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17519 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17520 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17521 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17522 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17523 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17524 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17525 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17526 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17527 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17528 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17529 tagged with its process id.
17531 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17532 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17533 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17534 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17537 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option,
17538 and the &%serialize_hosts%& smtp transport option.
17540 .cindex "number of deliveries"
17541 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17542 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17543 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17544 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17545 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17546 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17547 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17548 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17549 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17550 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
17552 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17553 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17554 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17555 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17558 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17559 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17560 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17561 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17562 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17564 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17566 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17567 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17570 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17571 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17572 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17573 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17574 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17578 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17579 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17580 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17581 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17582 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17583 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17584 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17588 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
17589 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17590 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
17591 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17592 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17593 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17594 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17595 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17596 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17597 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17600 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17601 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17604 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17606 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17607 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17608 an item in the list.
17609 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17612 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17613 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17614 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17615 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17616 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17619 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17620 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17621 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17622 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17623 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17624 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17625 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17626 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17627 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17628 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17631 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17632 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17633 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17634 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17635 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17636 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17637 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17641 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17642 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17643 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17644 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17645 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17646 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17647 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17648 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17649 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17650 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17651 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17655 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17656 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17657 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17659 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17660 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17661 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17662 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17663 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17664 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17666 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17667 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17668 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17669 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17672 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17673 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17674 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17675 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17676 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17677 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17678 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17679 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17681 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17682 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17683 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17684 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17685 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17686 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17687 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17688 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17691 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17692 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17693 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17694 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17698 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17699 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17700 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17701 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17702 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17703 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17704 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17705 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17706 . the option name to split.
17708 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer&!! 1000 &&&
17709 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17710 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17711 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17712 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17713 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17714 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17715 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17716 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17718 The option is expanded after the HELO or EHLO is received
17719 and may depend on values available at that time.
17720 An empty or zero value after expansion removes the limit.
17723 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17724 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17725 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17726 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17727 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17728 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17729 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17730 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17731 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17732 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17733 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17735 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17736 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17737 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17738 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17739 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17740 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17744 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17745 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17746 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17747 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17748 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17749 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17750 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17751 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17752 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17753 to all messages received in the same connection.
17755 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17756 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17757 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17758 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17761 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17763 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17764 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17765 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17766 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17767 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17768 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17769 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17770 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17771 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17772 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17773 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17774 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17775 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17778 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17779 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17780 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17781 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17782 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17783 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17784 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17785 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17786 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17787 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17788 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17791 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17792 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17793 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17794 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17797 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17798 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17799 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17800 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17801 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17802 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17803 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17804 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17805 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17807 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17808 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17809 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17810 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17812 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17813 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17814 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17815 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17816 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17819 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17820 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17823 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17824 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17825 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17826 &%helo_data%& value.
17828 .option smtp_backlog_monitor main integer 0
17829 .cindex "connection backlog" monitoring
17830 If this option is set to greater than zero, and the backlog of available
17831 TCP connections on a socket listening for SMTP is larger than it, a line
17832 is logged giving the value and the socket address and port.
17833 The value is retrived jsut before an accept call.
17834 This facility is only available on Linux.
17836 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17837 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17838 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17839 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17840 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17841 If a connect ACL does not supply a message,
17842 this string (which is expanded every time it is used) is output as the initial
17843 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17845 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17846 $version_number $tod_full
17848 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error;
17849 a forced fail just closes the connection.
17850 If you want to create a
17851 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17852 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17853 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17854 multiline response).
17857 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17858 .cindex "checking disk space"
17859 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17860 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17861 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17862 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17863 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17864 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17865 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17868 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17869 .cindex "connection backlog" "set maximum"
17870 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17871 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17872 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17873 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17874 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17875 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17876 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17877 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17878 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17879 attacks by SYN flooding.
17882 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17883 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17884 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17885 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17886 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17887 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17888 fewer, but they still exist.
17890 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17891 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17892 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17893 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17894 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17895 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17896 does detect many instances.
17898 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17899 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17900 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17901 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17905 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17906 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17907 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
17908 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17909 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17910 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17911 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17912 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17913 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17916 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17917 $sender_host_address
17919 If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
17920 be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
17921 In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
17922 if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
17924 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17925 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17926 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17927 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17928 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17932 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17933 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17934 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17935 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17936 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17939 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17940 .cindex "load average"
17941 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17942 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17943 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17944 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17945 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17946 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17950 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17951 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17952 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17953 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17954 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17956 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17958 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17959 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17960 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17961 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17962 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17964 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17965 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17966 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17967 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17968 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17969 not count towards the limit.
17973 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17974 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17975 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17976 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17977 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17980 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17981 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17985 .options smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
17986 smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset &&&
17987 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17988 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17989 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17990 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17991 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17992 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17995 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17996 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17997 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17998 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
18000 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
18001 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
18002 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
18003 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
18007 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
18009 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
18010 fractional parts are allowed here.
18012 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
18014 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
18015 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
18018 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
18019 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
18021 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
18022 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
18024 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
18025 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
18026 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
18027 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
18031 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
18032 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
18033 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
18034 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
18035 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
18036 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
18037 the message is abandoned.
18038 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
18040 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
18041 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
18043 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
18044 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
18046 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
18047 expanded before use and may depend on
18048 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
18052 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
18053 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
18054 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
18055 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
18056 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
18059 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18060 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
18061 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
18064 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
18065 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
18066 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
18067 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
18068 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
18069 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
18070 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
18071 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
18072 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
18073 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
18075 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
18076 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
18080 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18081 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
18082 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
18083 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
18084 the availability thereof is advertised in
18085 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18086 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
18089 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
18090 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
18091 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
18092 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
18096 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
18097 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
18098 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
18100 .option spf_smtp_comment_template main string&!! "Please%_see%_http://www.open-spf.org/Why"
18101 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support. It
18102 allows the customisation of the SMTP comment that the SPF library
18103 generates. You are strongly encouraged to link to your own explanative
18104 site. The template must not contain spaces. If you need spaces in the
18105 output, use the proper placeholder. If libspf2 can not parse the
18106 template, it uses a built-in default broken link. The following placeholders
18107 (along with Exim variables (but see below)) are allowed in the template:
18111 &*%{L}*&: Envelope sender's local part.
18113 &*%{S}*&: Envelope sender.
18115 &*%{O}*&: Envelope sender's domain.
18117 &*%{D}*&: Current(?) domain.
18119 &*%{I}*&: SMTP client Ip.
18121 &*%{C}*&: SMTP client pretty IP.
18123 &*%{T}*&: Epoch time (UTC).
18125 &*%{P}*&: SMTP client domain name.
18127 &*%{V}*&: IP version.
18129 &*%{H}*&: EHLO/HELO domain.
18131 &*%{R}*&: Receiving domain.
18133 The capitalized placeholders do proper URL encoding, if you use them
18134 lowercased, no encoding takes place. This list was compiled from the
18137 A note on using Exim variables: As
18138 currently the SPF library is initialized before the SMTP EHLO phase,
18139 the variables useful for expansion are quite limited.
18142 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
18143 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
18144 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
18145 .cindex "directories, multiple"
18146 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
18147 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
18148 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
18149 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
18150 arrival of the message.
18152 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
18153 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
18154 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
18155 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
18156 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
18158 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
18159 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
18160 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
18161 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
18162 automatically deleted.
18164 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
18165 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
18166 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
18167 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
18168 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
18169 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
18170 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
18171 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
18172 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
18175 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
18176 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
18177 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
18178 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
18179 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
18180 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
18181 &$primary_hostname$&.
18183 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
18184 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
18185 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
18186 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
18187 as failures in the configuration file.
18189 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
18190 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
18192 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
18193 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
18194 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
18195 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
18196 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
18197 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
18200 The following variables will not have useful values:
18202 $max_received_linelength
18207 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
18208 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
18209 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
18210 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
18212 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
18213 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
18214 The transmission benefit is maintained.
18216 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
18217 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
18218 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
18219 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
18221 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
18222 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
18223 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
18224 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
18225 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
18226 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
18228 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
18229 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
18230 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
18231 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
18232 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
18233 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
18234 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
18237 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
18238 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
18239 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
18240 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
18241 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
18242 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
18243 domain causes a syntax error.
18244 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
18248 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
18249 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
18250 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
18251 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
18252 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
18253 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
18254 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
18255 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
18256 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
18257 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
18258 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
18259 the LOG_ALERT priority.
18262 .option syslog_facility main string unset
18263 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
18264 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18265 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
18266 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
18267 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18268 details of Exim's logging.
18271 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
18272 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
18273 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
18274 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
18275 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
18276 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
18277 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18281 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
18282 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
18283 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18284 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
18285 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18289 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
18290 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
18291 .cindex timestamps syslog
18292 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
18293 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18294 details of Exim's logging.
18297 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
18298 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
18299 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
18300 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
18301 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
18302 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
18303 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
18304 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
18305 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
18306 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
18307 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
18308 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
18311 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
18312 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18313 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
18314 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
18315 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
18316 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18319 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
18320 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
18321 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
18322 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
18323 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18325 .option system_filter_group main string unset
18326 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
18327 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
18328 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
18329 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
18331 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
18332 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
18333 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18334 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
18335 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
18336 contains the pipe command.
18339 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
18340 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
18341 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
18342 is used in a system filter.
18345 .option system_filter_user main string unset
18346 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
18347 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
18348 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
18349 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
18350 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
18351 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
18352 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
18353 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
18354 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
18356 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
18357 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
18358 transport option overrides.
18361 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
18362 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
18363 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
18364 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
18365 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
18366 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
18367 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
18368 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
18369 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
18370 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
18371 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
18372 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
18376 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
18377 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
18378 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
18379 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
18380 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
18381 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
18382 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
18383 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
18384 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
18385 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
18387 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
18388 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
18389 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
18392 .option timezone main string unset
18393 .cindex "timezone, setting"
18394 .cindex "environment" "values from"
18395 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
18396 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
18397 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
18398 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
18402 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
18403 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
18404 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
18405 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
18406 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
18407 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
18410 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18411 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
18412 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
18413 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
18414 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
18415 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
18416 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
18417 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18418 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
18419 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
18420 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
18421 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
18424 .option tls_alpn main "string list&!!" "smtp : esmtp"
18425 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
18427 .cindex ALPN "set acceptable names for server"
18428 If this option is set,
18429 the TLS library supports ALPN,
18430 and the client offers either more than one
18431 ALPN name or a name which does not match the list,
18432 the TLS connection is declined.
18435 .option tls_certificate main "string list&!!" unset
18436 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
18437 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
18438 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18439 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
18440 Commonly only one file is needed.
18441 The server's private key is also
18442 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
18443 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18445 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
18446 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
18447 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
18448 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
18450 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
18451 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
18453 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
18454 when a list of more than one
18455 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
18456 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
18458 .cindex SNI "selecting server certificate based on"
18459 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
18460 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
18461 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
18462 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
18464 If this option is unset or empty a self-signed certificate will be
18466 Under Linux this is generated at daemon startup; on other platforms it will be
18467 generated fresh for every connection.
18469 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
18470 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
18471 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
18472 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
18473 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
18475 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
18477 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
18478 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
18479 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
18481 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18484 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
18485 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
18486 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
18487 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
18488 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
18489 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
18491 The value must be at least 1024.
18493 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
18494 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
18495 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
18497 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18500 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18501 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18502 larger prime than requested.
18505 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18506 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18507 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18508 to be used by Exim.
18510 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
18511 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18512 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18513 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18515 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18516 then it names a file from which DH
18517 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18518 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18519 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18520 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18521 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18522 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18524 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18527 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18528 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18529 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18530 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18532 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18533 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18535 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
18536 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18537 in IKE is assigned number 23.
18539 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18540 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
18541 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18542 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18543 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18545 The available standard primes are:
18546 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18547 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18548 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18549 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18551 The available additional primes are:
18552 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18554 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18555 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18556 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18557 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
18558 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18560 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18561 they are still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18562 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18563 Two of them in particular (&`ike1`& and &`ike22`&) are called out by RFC 8247
18564 as MUST NOT use for IPSEC, and two more (&`ike23`& and &`ike24`&) as
18566 Because of this, Exim regards them as deprecated; if either of the first pair
18567 are used, warnings will be logged in the paniclog, and if any are used then
18568 warnings will be logged in the mainlog.
18569 All four will be removed in a future Exim release.
18571 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18572 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18573 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18574 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18575 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18578 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18579 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18580 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18581 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18582 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18583 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18584 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18587 .option tls_eccurve main string list&!! &`auto`&
18588 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18589 This option selects EC curves for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18590 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS
18591 (the equivalent can be done using a priority string for the
18592 &%tls_require_ciphers%& option).
18594 After expansion it must contain
18595 one or (only for OpenSSL versiona 1.1.1 onwards) more
18596 EC curve names, such as &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-521`&.
18597 Consult your OpenSSL manual for valid curve names.
18599 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18600 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18601 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18603 If the option expands to an empty string, the effect is undefined.
18606 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18607 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
18608 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18610 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18611 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18612 Certificate Authority.
18614 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18615 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18617 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18618 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18619 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18620 The ordering of the two lists must match.
18621 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18623 The file(s) should be in DER format,
18624 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18626 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18627 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18628 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18629 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18630 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18631 (this only works under TLS1.3)
18632 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18634 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18635 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18636 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18637 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18639 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18642 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18643 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18644 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18645 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18649 .option tls_privatekey main "string list&!!" unset
18650 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18651 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18652 files which contains the server's private keys.
18653 If this option is unset, or if
18654 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18655 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18656 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18658 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18661 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18662 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18663 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18664 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18665 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18666 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18670 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18671 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18672 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18673 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18674 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18675 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18676 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18677 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18678 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18679 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18680 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18683 .option tls_resumption_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18684 .cindex TLS resumption
18685 This option controls which connections to offer the TLS resumption feature.
18686 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
18689 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18690 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18691 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18692 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18695 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18696 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18697 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18698 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18700 or the absolute path to
18701 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18702 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18704 The "system" value for the option will use a
18705 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18706 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18707 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18710 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18711 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18713 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18715 either by file or directory
18716 are added to those given by the system default location.
18718 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18719 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18720 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18721 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18722 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18723 use the explicit directory version. (If your peer is Exim up to 4.85,
18724 using GnuTLS, you may need to send the CAs (thus using the file
18725 variant). Otherwise the peer doesn't send its certificate.)
18727 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18729 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18733 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18734 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18735 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18736 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18737 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18738 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18739 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18740 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18742 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18743 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18744 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18746 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18747 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18748 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18749 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18751 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18752 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18753 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18754 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18755 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18756 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18757 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18760 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18764 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18765 .cindex "trusted groups"
18766 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
18767 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18768 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18769 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18770 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18771 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18772 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18775 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18776 .cindex "trusted users"
18777 .cindex "user" "trusted"
18778 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18779 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18780 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18781 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18782 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18783 Exim user are trusted.
18785 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18786 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18787 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18788 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18789 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18790 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18791 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18792 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18793 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18796 .option unknown_username main string unset
18797 See &%unknown_login%&.
18799 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18800 .cindex "trusted users"
18801 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18802 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18803 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18804 .cindex "envelope from"
18805 .cindex "envelope sender"
18806 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18807 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18808 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18809 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18810 is used) is ignored.
18812 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18813 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18815 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18817 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18818 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18819 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18820 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18821 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18822 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18823 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18824 followed by a hyphen
18825 by a setting like this:
18827 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18829 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18830 restriction, you can use
18832 untrusted_set_sender = *
18834 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18835 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18836 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18837 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18838 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18839 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18840 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18841 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18843 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18844 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18845 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18846 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18850 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18851 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18852 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18853 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18854 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18855 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18856 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18857 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18858 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18859 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18861 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18862 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18864 The pattern can be seen by running
18866 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18868 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18869 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18870 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18871 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18872 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18873 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18876 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18877 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18880 .option warn_message_file main string&!! unset
18881 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18882 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18883 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18884 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18885 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18886 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18887 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
18888 .cindex warn_message_file "tainted data"
18889 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
18890 absolute and untainted.
18891 See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18894 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18895 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18896 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18897 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18898 .ecindex IIDconfima
18899 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18904 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18907 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18908 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18909 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18910 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18911 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
18913 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18914 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18915 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18916 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18917 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18919 The name of a router is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
18920 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
18924 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18925 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18926 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18927 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18928 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18929 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18930 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18932 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18933 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18934 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18935 routers, and the eventual transport.
18937 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18938 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18939 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18940 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18941 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18943 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18944 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18945 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18946 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18947 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18949 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18950 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18951 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18953 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18955 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18957 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18959 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18960 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18962 See also the &%set%& option below.
18964 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18965 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18966 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18967 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18968 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18969 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18970 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18974 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18976 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18977 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18978 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18979 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18980 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18985 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18986 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18987 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18988 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18989 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18990 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18991 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18992 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18993 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18994 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18997 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18999 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
19002 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
19004 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
19005 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
19006 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
19007 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
19010 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
19011 .cindex "case of local parts"
19012 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
19013 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
19014 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
19015 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
19016 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
19017 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
19018 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
19021 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19022 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
19023 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
19024 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
19025 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
19026 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
19027 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
19028 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
19029 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
19031 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
19032 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
19033 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
19034 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
19038 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
19039 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
19040 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
19041 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
19043 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
19044 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
19045 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
19046 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
19047 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
19049 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
19050 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router check_local_user option"
19051 &$local_part_data$& is set to an untainted version of the local part and
19052 &$home$& is set from the password data. The latter can be tested in other
19053 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
19054 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
19055 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
19056 the router is skipped.
19058 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
19059 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
19060 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
19061 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
19062 setting to achieve this. For example:
19064 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
19066 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
19067 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
19068 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
19072 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
19073 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
19074 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
19075 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
19076 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
19077 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
19078 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
19079 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
19081 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
19082 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
19084 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
19085 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
19087 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
19088 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
19089 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
19091 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19093 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
19095 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
19098 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
19100 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19101 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
19105 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
19106 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
19107 be specified using &%condition%&.
19109 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
19110 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
19111 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
19112 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19113 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19114 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
19115 Router rules processing behavior.
19117 This is best illustrated in an example:
19119 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
19120 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
19122 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19125 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19128 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
19129 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
19130 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
19131 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
19132 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
19133 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
19134 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
19135 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
19137 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
19138 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
19139 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
19140 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
19143 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
19144 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
19145 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
19146 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
19147 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
19150 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
19151 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19152 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19153 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
19154 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
19155 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19156 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19157 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19158 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
19159 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
19160 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
19161 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
19162 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
19163 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
19167 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
19168 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
19169 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
19170 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
19171 transport option of the same name.
19173 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
19174 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19175 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19176 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19177 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19178 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
19179 the DNSSEC request bit set.
19180 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19182 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
19183 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19184 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19185 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19186 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19187 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
19188 the DNSSEC request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
19189 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
19190 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19193 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
19194 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
19195 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
19196 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
19198 The data returned by the list check
19199 is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
19200 expansions of the driver's private options and in the transport.
19201 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
19202 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
19204 A complex example, using a file like:
19210 and checking both domain and local_part
19212 domains = ${domain:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19213 local_parts = ${local_part:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19218 .option driver routers string unset
19219 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
19223 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
19224 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19225 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19226 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
19227 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
19228 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
19229 Not effective on redirect routers.
19233 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
19234 .cindex "envelope from"
19235 .cindex "envelope sender"
19236 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
19237 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
19238 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
19239 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
19240 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
19241 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
19242 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
19244 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
19245 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
19246 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
19249 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
19250 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
19251 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
19252 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
19254 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
19255 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
19256 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
19257 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
19263 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
19264 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
19265 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
19266 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
19267 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
19269 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19270 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
19271 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
19272 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
19273 setting &%return_path%&.
19275 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
19276 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
19277 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
19281 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
19282 .cindex "address" "testing"
19283 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
19284 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
19285 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
19286 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
19287 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
19288 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
19289 on for the system alias file.
19290 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19293 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
19294 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
19295 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
19299 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
19300 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
19301 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
19302 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19306 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
19307 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19308 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
19312 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
19313 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19314 verifying a sender, verification fails.
19318 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
19319 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
19320 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
19321 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
19322 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
19323 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
19324 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
19325 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
19326 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
19328 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
19329 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
19330 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
19331 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
19332 transport for further details.
19335 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
19336 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
19337 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19338 .cindex "transport" "local"
19339 .cindex "router" "setting group"
19340 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19341 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
19343 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19344 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19345 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
19346 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
19347 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19351 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
19352 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
19353 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
19354 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19355 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19356 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19357 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
19358 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
19359 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
19360 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
19361 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
19362 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
19363 &"see"& the added header lines.
19365 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
19366 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
19367 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
19368 failures are treated as configuration errors.
19370 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19371 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19373 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19374 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19376 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19377 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
19378 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19379 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
19380 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
19381 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
19382 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
19383 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
19384 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
19385 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19389 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
19390 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19391 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
19392 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19393 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19394 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19395 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
19396 Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
19397 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
19399 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
19400 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
19401 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
19402 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
19403 &"see"& the original header lines.
19405 The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
19406 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
19407 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
19410 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19411 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19413 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19414 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19416 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19417 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
19418 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
19419 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
19421 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
19422 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
19423 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19427 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
19428 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
19429 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
19430 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
19431 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
19432 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
19433 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
19436 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
19440 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
19442 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
19443 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
19444 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
19445 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
19446 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
19447 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
19449 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
19450 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
19452 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
19453 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
19455 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
19456 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
19458 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
19459 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19460 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
19461 domain that is being routed.
19463 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19464 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
19467 .option initgroups routers boolean false
19468 .cindex "additional groups"
19469 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19470 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19471 .cindex "transport" "local"
19472 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
19473 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
19474 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
19475 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
19476 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19480 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
19481 .cindex affix "router precondition"
19482 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
19483 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
19484 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
19485 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
19486 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
19489 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
19490 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
19491 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
19492 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
19493 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
19494 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
19495 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
19496 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
19497 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
19499 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19500 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
19501 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
19502 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
19503 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
19504 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
19505 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
19506 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
19507 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
19508 the relevant transport.
19510 .vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
19511 If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
19512 wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
19514 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
19515 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
19516 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
19519 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
19520 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
19521 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
19522 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
19523 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
19527 local_part_prefix = real-
19529 transport = local_delivery
19531 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19532 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19534 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19535 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19538 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19539 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19540 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19541 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19544 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19545 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19549 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19550 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19551 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19552 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19553 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19554 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19555 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19556 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19557 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19561 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19562 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19566 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19567 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19568 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19569 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19570 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19572 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19573 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19576 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain_data
19578 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19579 the data returned by the list check
19580 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19581 expansions of the router's private options or in the transport.
19582 You might use this option, for
19583 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19584 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19585 each virtual domain:
19589 local_parts = postmaster
19590 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19594 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19595 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
19596 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19597 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19598 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19599 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19600 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19601 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19602 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19603 redirect addresses.
19607 .option more routers boolean&!! true
19608 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19609 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19610 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19611 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19612 delivery to be deferred.
19614 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19615 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19617 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19618 means of the setting
19622 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19623 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19624 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19626 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19627 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19628 controls what happens next.
19631 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19632 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
19633 .cindex "router" "timeout"
19634 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19635 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19636 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19637 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19638 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19640 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19641 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19642 applies to all of them.
19646 .option pass_router routers string unset
19647 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19648 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19649 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19650 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19651 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19652 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19653 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19654 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19655 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19656 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19660 .option redirect_router routers string unset
19661 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19662 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19663 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19664 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19665 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19667 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19668 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19669 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19670 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19674 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19675 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19676 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19677 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19678 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19679 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19680 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19682 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19683 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19684 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19685 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19686 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19688 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19689 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19690 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19691 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19692 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19695 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19696 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19699 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19700 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19701 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19702 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19703 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19704 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19705 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19706 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19708 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19709 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19710 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
19711 operates as follows:
19713 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
19714 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
19715 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
19716 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
19719 require_files = mail:/some/file
19720 require_files = $local_part_data:$home/.procmailrc
19722 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
19723 &%require_files%& condition fails.
19725 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
19726 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
19727 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
19728 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
19730 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
19731 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
19732 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
19733 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
19734 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
19736 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
19737 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
19738 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
19739 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
19740 check again in that process.
19742 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19743 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19744 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19745 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19746 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19747 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19748 as if the file did not exist. For example:
19750 require_files = +/some/file
19752 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19753 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19754 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19758 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19759 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19760 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19761 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19762 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19763 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19764 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19765 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19768 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19769 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19770 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19771 &%check_local_user%&,
19774 &%local_part_prefix%&,
19775 &%local_part_suffix%&,
19778 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19779 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19782 Failing to set this option when it is needed
19783 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19784 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19786 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19787 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19788 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19792 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19793 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
19794 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
19796 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19797 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19798 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19799 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19800 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19801 cause the router to defer.
19803 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19804 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19806 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19808 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19809 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19811 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19812 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19813 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19814 of these values that is set:
19817 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19819 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19821 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19823 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19826 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19827 router, but not for the transport.
19831 .option self routers string freeze
19832 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19833 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19834 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19835 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19836 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19837 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19839 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19840 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19841 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19842 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19843 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19845 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19846 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19847 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19848 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19849 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19854 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19856 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19857 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19858 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19859 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19861 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19862 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19863 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19868 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19869 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19870 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19871 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19872 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19873 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19879 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19880 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19881 be passed to the next router.
19884 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19887 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19888 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19889 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19890 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19891 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19892 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19897 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19898 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19899 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19900 address matches something on the list.
19901 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19904 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19905 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19906 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19907 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19908 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19909 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19910 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19914 .option set routers "string list" unset
19915 .cindex router variables
19916 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19917 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19918 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19921 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19922 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19923 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19924 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19925 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19927 This is done immediately after all the preconditions, before the
19928 evaluation of the &%address_data%& option.
19929 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19930 The variables can be used by the router options
19931 (not including any preconditions)
19932 and by the transport.
19933 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19934 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19936 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19937 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19940 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19941 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19942 .cindex "packet radio"
19943 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19944 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19945 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19946 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19947 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19948 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19949 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19950 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19952 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19953 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19954 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19955 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19956 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19957 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19958 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19959 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19960 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19961 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19963 translate_ip_address = \
19964 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19967 The file would contain lines like
19969 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
19970 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19972 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19977 .option transport routers string&!! unset
19978 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19979 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19980 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19981 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19982 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19983 delivery is deferred.
19985 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19986 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19987 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19991 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19992 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19993 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19994 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19995 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19996 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19997 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19998 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19999 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20000 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20001 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
20007 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
20008 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20009 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
20010 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
20011 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
20012 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
20013 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
20014 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
20015 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20016 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20018 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
20019 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
20020 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
20021 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
20022 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
20024 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
20030 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
20031 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
20032 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
20033 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
20034 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
20035 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
20036 delivery to be deferred.
20038 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
20039 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
20040 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
20041 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
20042 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
20043 sometimes true and sometimes false).
20045 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
20046 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
20047 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
20048 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
20049 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
20050 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
20051 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
20052 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
20054 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
20055 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
20056 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
20057 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
20058 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
20059 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
20060 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
20061 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
20062 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
20063 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
20065 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
20066 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
20067 subsequent routers.
20070 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
20071 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20072 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20073 .cindex "transport" "local"
20074 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
20075 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
20076 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
20077 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
20078 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
20079 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
20080 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
20081 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
20082 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
20083 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
20084 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
20085 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
20089 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
20090 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
20091 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
20094 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
20095 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
20097 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
20098 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
20099 delivering in cutthrough mode or
20100 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
20101 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
20102 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
20103 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
20105 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
20106 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
20107 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
20111 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
20112 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
20114 delivering in cutthrough mode
20115 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
20116 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20118 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20121 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
20122 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
20123 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
20124 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20126 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20127 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
20128 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
20135 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20136 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20138 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
20139 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
20140 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
20141 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
20142 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
20143 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
20144 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
20145 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
20146 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
20150 domains = mydomain.example
20152 transport = local_delivery
20154 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
20155 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
20156 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
20157 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
20164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20167 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
20168 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
20169 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
20170 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
20171 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
20172 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
20174 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
20175 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
20176 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
20177 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
20180 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
20181 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
20182 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
20183 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
20184 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
20185 generic option, the router declines.
20187 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
20188 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
20189 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
20191 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20192 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20193 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
20194 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
20195 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
20196 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
20199 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
20200 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
20201 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
20202 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
20203 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
20204 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
20206 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
20207 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
20208 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
20209 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
20210 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
20211 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
20212 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
20213 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
20214 case routing fails.
20217 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
20218 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
20219 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
20220 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
20221 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
20223 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
20224 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
20226 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
20228 The domain does not exist in DNS
20230 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
20231 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
20232 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
20234 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
20236 MX record points to a non-existent host.
20238 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
20239 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
20241 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
20242 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
20244 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
20245 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
20247 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
20248 not be found in the MX records (see below)
20254 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
20255 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
20256 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
20258 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
20259 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
20260 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
20261 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
20262 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
20263 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
20264 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20267 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
20268 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
20269 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
20270 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
20271 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
20272 required. For example,
20276 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
20277 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
20278 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
20279 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
20280 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
20283 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
20284 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
20285 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
20286 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
20287 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
20288 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
20290 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
20291 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
20292 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
20293 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
20294 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
20295 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
20296 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
20297 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
20299 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
20300 when there is a DNS lookup error.
20305 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20306 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
20307 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
20308 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
20309 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
20310 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
20311 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
20312 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
20316 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
20317 .cindex IPv6 disabling
20318 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
20319 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20320 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20321 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20322 only A records are used.
20324 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
20325 .cindex IPv4 preference
20326 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
20327 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20328 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20329 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20330 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
20332 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20333 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
20334 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
20335 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
20336 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
20337 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
20338 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
20341 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
20343 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
20344 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
20345 the address record.
20348 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20349 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20350 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
20351 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20356 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
20357 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20358 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
20359 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
20360 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
20361 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
20362 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
20363 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
20364 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
20369 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
20370 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
20371 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
20372 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
20373 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
20374 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
20375 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
20376 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
20377 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
20378 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
20379 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
20381 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
20382 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
20385 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
20386 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
20387 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
20388 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
20389 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
20393 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
20394 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20395 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
20396 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
20397 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20398 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20399 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20400 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20402 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20403 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
20404 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20405 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
20406 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
20407 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
20408 without processing them independently,
20409 provided the following conditions are met:
20412 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
20413 &%headers_remove%&.
20415 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
20422 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
20423 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20424 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
20425 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
20426 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
20427 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
20428 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
20429 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
20430 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
20431 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
20433 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
20434 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
20439 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20440 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20441 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
20442 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20447 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
20448 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
20449 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
20450 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
20453 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
20455 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
20456 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
20457 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
20458 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
20459 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
20460 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
20463 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
20464 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
20465 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
20466 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
20467 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
20469 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
20470 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
20471 such as that implied by
20475 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
20476 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
20477 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
20478 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
20488 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20489 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20491 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
20492 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
20493 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
20494 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
20495 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
20496 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
20497 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
20498 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
20499 router handles the address
20503 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
20504 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
20505 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
20507 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
20509 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
20510 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
20512 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
20513 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
20514 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
20515 &%self%& option determines what happens.
20517 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
20518 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
20519 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
20520 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
20524 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20527 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
20528 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
20529 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
20530 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
20531 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
20532 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
20535 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20537 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20539 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20540 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20541 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20542 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20543 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20544 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20545 must not be specified for it.
20547 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20548 .option hosts iplookup string unset
20549 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20550 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20551 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20552 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20553 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20556 .option optional iplookup boolean false
20557 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20558 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20559 delivery to the address is deferred.
20562 .option port iplookup integer 0
20563 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20564 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20568 .option protocol iplookup string udp
20569 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20570 protocols is to be used.
20573 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20574 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20577 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20579 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20580 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20583 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20584 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20585 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20586 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20587 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20588 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20589 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20590 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20593 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20594 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20595 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20596 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20597 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20598 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20599 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20600 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20601 following could be used:
20603 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20604 reroute = $local_part@$1
20607 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
20608 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20609 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20610 call. It does not apply to UDP.
20615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20616 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20618 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20619 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20620 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20621 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20622 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20623 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20624 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20625 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20626 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20627 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20629 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20630 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20631 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20632 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20633 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20634 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20635 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20638 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20639 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20640 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20641 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20642 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20643 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20644 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20647 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20648 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20649 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20650 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20651 below, following the list of private options.
20654 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20656 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20657 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20659 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20660 See &%host_find_failed%&.
20662 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20663 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20664 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20665 of the following values:
20674 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20675 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20676 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20679 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20680 router only if &%more%& is true.
20682 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20683 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20684 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20685 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20687 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20688 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20689 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20692 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20693 .cindex "randomized host list"
20694 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20695 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20696 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20697 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20698 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20699 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20700 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20701 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20703 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20704 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20705 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20706 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
20708 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
20710 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
20711 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
20712 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
20713 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
20714 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
20717 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
20718 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
20719 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
20722 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
20724 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
20725 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
20729 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
20730 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
20731 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
20732 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
20735 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
20736 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20737 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
20738 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
20739 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20740 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20741 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20742 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20744 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20745 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20746 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20747 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20748 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20749 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20750 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20751 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20756 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20757 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20758 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20759 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20760 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20761 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20763 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20765 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20769 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20770 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20772 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20773 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20774 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20775 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20776 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20777 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20778 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20779 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20780 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20781 in a &%route_list%&).
20783 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20784 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20785 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20786 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20790 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20791 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20792 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20793 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20794 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20795 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20796 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20799 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20800 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20802 This data can be accessed by setting
20804 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20806 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20807 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20808 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20809 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20810 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20815 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20816 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20817 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20818 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20819 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20820 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20821 The format of each item
20822 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20823 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20825 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20826 variables are set during its expansion:
20829 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20830 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20831 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20833 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20836 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20838 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20841 .vindex "&$value$&"
20842 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20843 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20845 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20849 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20850 semicolon is the default route list separator.
20854 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20855 Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
20856 optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
20857 (see &%hosts_randomize%&).
20858 When no port is given, an IP address
20859 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20860 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20861 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20864 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20865 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20866 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20868 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20869 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20872 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20873 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20874 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20875 number follows. For example:
20877 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20881 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20882 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20883 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20884 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20885 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20888 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20889 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20890 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20891 records in the DNS. For example:
20893 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20895 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20898 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20900 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20901 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20902 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20903 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20904 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20905 happens is controlled by the
20906 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20907 &%self%& option of the router.
20909 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20910 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20911 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20912 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20913 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20914 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20915 defined by MX preferences.
20917 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20918 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20919 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20921 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20922 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20923 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20924 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20926 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20927 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20930 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20931 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20932 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20934 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20935 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20939 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20940 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20941 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20942 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20943 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20944 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20945 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20948 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20949 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20951 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20952 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20954 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20955 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20956 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20958 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20959 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20960 timeout), delivery is deferred.
20962 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20964 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20969 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20970 domain2 host4:host5
20972 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20973 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20974 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20975 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20978 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20979 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20980 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20981 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20984 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20985 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20990 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20991 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20994 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20995 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20999 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
21000 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
21001 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
21004 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
21005 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
21006 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
21007 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
21009 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
21011 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
21012 your first router something like this:
21015 driver = manualroute
21016 domains = !+local_domains
21017 transport = remote_smtp
21018 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
21020 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
21021 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
21022 they are tried in order
21023 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
21024 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
21027 driver = manualroute
21028 transport = remote_smtp
21029 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
21031 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
21032 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
21033 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
21034 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
21035 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
21036 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
21037 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
21038 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
21041 .cindex "mail hub example"
21042 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
21043 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
21044 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
21045 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
21046 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
21047 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
21048 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
21049 lookup is easier to manage.
21051 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
21052 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
21056 driver = manualroute
21057 transport = remote_smtp
21058 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
21060 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
21061 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
21062 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
21063 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
21064 domain can be used to find the host:
21067 driver = manualroute
21068 transport = remote_smtp
21069 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
21071 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
21072 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
21073 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
21077 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
21078 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
21079 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
21080 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
21081 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
21082 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
21085 driver = manualroute
21086 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
21087 route_list = saved.domain.example
21089 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
21090 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
21091 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
21094 driver = manualroute
21096 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
21097 *.saved.domain2.example \
21098 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
21101 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21103 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
21104 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
21105 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
21106 the address if the lookup fails.
21109 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
21110 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
21111 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
21112 one way it can be done:
21118 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
21119 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
21120 return_fail_output = true
21125 driver = manualroute
21127 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
21129 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
21131 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
21133 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
21134 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
21135 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
21137 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
21138 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
21147 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21148 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21150 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
21151 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
21152 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
21153 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
21154 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
21155 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
21156 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
21157 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
21158 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
21159 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
21161 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
21163 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
21164 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
21165 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
21166 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
21167 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
21170 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
21171 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
21172 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
21173 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
21174 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
21175 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
21178 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
21179 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
21180 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
21181 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
21182 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
21183 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
21184 not set, a value for the gid also.
21186 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
21187 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
21188 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
21189 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
21190 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
21191 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
21195 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
21196 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
21197 before running the command.
21200 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
21201 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
21202 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
21206 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
21207 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
21208 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
21209 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
21210 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
21213 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
21216 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
21217 &%no_more%& is set.
21219 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
21220 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
21221 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
21222 included in the SMTP response.
21224 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
21225 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
21226 included in any SMTP response.
21228 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
21230 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
21231 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
21233 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
21234 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
21235 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
21238 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
21239 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
21242 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
21243 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
21245 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
21246 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
21247 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
21248 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
21250 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
21251 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
21252 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
21253 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
21254 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
21256 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
21257 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
21258 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
21259 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
21260 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
21262 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
21263 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
21264 variable. For example, this return line
21266 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
21268 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
21269 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
21270 .ecindex IIDquerou1
21271 .ecindex IIDquerou2
21276 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21277 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21279 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
21280 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
21281 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
21282 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
21283 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
21284 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
21285 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
21286 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
21287 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
21288 redirected in several different ways:
21291 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
21294 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
21296 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
21298 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
21300 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
21302 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
21304 It can be discarded.
21307 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
21308 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
21309 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
21310 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
21312 If success DSNs have been requested
21313 .cindex "DSN" "success"
21314 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
21315 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
21319 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
21320 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
21321 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
21322 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
21323 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
21324 aliases, in a configuration like this:
21328 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
21330 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
21331 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
21332 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
21333 cause delivery to be deferred.
21335 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
21336 &_.forward_& files, like this:
21341 file = $home/.forward
21344 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
21345 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
21346 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
21347 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
21350 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21351 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21352 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21354 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
21355 directly for redirection,
21356 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
21357 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
21358 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
21359 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
21363 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
21364 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
21365 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
21366 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
21369 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
21370 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
21371 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
21372 practice the router may not be able to operate.
21374 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
21375 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
21376 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
21377 saves some resources.
21385 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
21386 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21387 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21388 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
21389 can be interpreted in two different ways:
21392 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
21393 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
21394 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
21395 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
21396 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
21397 document is intended for use by end users.
21399 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
21400 described in the next section.
21403 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
21404 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
21405 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
21406 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
21407 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
21411 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
21412 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
21413 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
21414 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
21415 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
21416 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
21417 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
21418 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
21419 commas or newlines.
21420 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
21423 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
21424 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
21425 next newline character is ignored.
21427 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
21428 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
21429 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
21430 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
21433 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21434 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
21435 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
21436 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
21437 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
21438 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
21441 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
21445 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
21446 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
21447 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
21448 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
21449 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
21450 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
21451 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
21452 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
21453 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
21454 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
21455 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
21457 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
21458 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
21459 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
21460 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
21461 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
21463 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
21465 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
21466 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
21467 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
21468 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
21469 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
21472 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
21473 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
21474 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
21475 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
21476 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
21478 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
21479 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
21484 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
21485 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
21488 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21490 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
21491 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
21492 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
21493 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
21494 should really contain
21496 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21498 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
21499 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
21500 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
21504 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
21505 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
21506 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
21509 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
21510 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
21511 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
21512 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
21513 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
21514 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21515 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21517 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
21518 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
21519 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
21520 in double quotes, for example:
21522 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
21524 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
21525 quote just the command. An item such as
21527 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
21529 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
21531 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
21532 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21533 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21534 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21535 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21536 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21537 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21538 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21539 an &%accept%& router.
21542 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21543 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21544 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21545 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
21547 /home/world/minbari
21549 is treated as a filename, but
21551 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21553 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21554 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21555 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21556 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21558 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21559 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21561 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21562 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21563 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21564 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21567 .cindex "included address list"
21568 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21569 If an item is of the form
21571 :include:<path name>
21573 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21574 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21575 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21576 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21577 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21578 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21580 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21582 It must be given as
21584 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21586 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21587 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21588 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21590 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21591 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
21592 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21593 .cindex "black hole"
21594 .cindex "abandoning mail"
21595 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21596 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21597 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21601 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21602 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21603 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21605 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21606 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21607 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21608 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21612 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21613 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21614 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21615 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21616 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21617 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21618 redirection items of the form
21623 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21624 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21625 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21626 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21628 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21630 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21632 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21633 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21635 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21636 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21637 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21639 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21640 By default for verify, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21641 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21642 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21643 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21644 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21645 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21646 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21647 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21650 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21651 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21652 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21653 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21655 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21656 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21657 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21658 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21659 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21661 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21662 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21663 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21664 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21665 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21669 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21670 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21671 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21672 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21673 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21674 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21675 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21679 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21680 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
21681 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21682 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21683 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21684 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21685 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21686 aliasing scheme of the type
21688 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21692 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21693 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21694 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21697 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21698 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21700 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21701 the pipes are distinct.
21705 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
21706 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
21707 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
21708 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
21709 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
21710 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
21711 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
21712 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
21713 can be used to avoid this.
21716 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
21717 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
21718 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
21719 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
21720 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
21721 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
21722 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
21726 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
21728 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
21729 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
21732 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
21733 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
21734 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
21737 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
21738 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
21739 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
21740 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
21743 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21744 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21745 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21746 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21747 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21748 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21749 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21751 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21752 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21755 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21756 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21757 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21758 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21759 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21763 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21764 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21765 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21766 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21767 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21768 let ordinary users do.
21772 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21773 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21774 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21775 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21776 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21777 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21779 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21780 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21781 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21782 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21783 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21784 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21786 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21788 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21789 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21790 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21791 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21792 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21793 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21794 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21795 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21798 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21799 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21800 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21801 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21802 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21803 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21804 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21805 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21809 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21810 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21811 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21812 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21813 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21814 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21817 .option data redirect string&!! unset
21818 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21819 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21820 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21821 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21822 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21824 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21825 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21826 terminated with newline characters. For example:
21828 data = #Exim filter\n\
21829 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21831 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21832 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21833 choice into a newline.
21836 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21837 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21838 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21839 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21840 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21843 .option file redirect string&!! unset
21844 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21845 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21846 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21847 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21848 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21849 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21850 entirely of comments), the router declines.
21852 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21853 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21854 runs a check on the containing directory,
21855 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21856 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21857 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21858 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21859 not, the router declines.
21862 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21863 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21864 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21865 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21866 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21867 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21868 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21871 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21872 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21873 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21874 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21875 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21878 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21879 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21880 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21881 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21885 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21886 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21887 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21888 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21889 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21894 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21895 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21896 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21897 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21898 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21899 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21900 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21901 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21902 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21903 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21904 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21907 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21908 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21909 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21910 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21911 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21914 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21915 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21916 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21917 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21918 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21919 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21921 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21922 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21923 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21924 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21925 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21926 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21927 &_.forward_& files).
21930 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21931 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21932 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21933 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21934 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21937 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21938 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21939 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21940 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21941 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21942 of the embedded Perl support.
21945 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21946 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21947 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21948 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21949 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21952 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21953 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21954 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21955 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21956 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21959 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21960 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21961 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21962 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21963 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21964 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21965 &%one_time%& is set.
21968 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21969 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21970 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21971 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21972 to make use of &%run%& items.
21975 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21976 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21977 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21978 If this option is true, items of the form
21980 :include:<path name>
21982 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21985 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21986 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21987 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21988 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21989 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21990 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21991 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21994 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21995 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21996 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21997 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21998 &%allow_filter%& is true.
22001 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
22002 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
22003 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
22004 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
22005 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
22010 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
22011 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
22012 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
22013 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
22014 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
22015 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
22016 bounce may well quote the generated address.
22019 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
22021 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22022 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
22023 file did not exist.
22026 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
22028 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22029 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
22030 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
22032 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
22033 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
22034 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
22035 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
22036 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
22037 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
22038 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
22039 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
22043 .option include_directory redirect string unset
22044 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
22045 redirection list must start with this directory.
22048 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
22049 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
22050 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
22053 .option one_time redirect boolean false
22054 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
22055 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
22056 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
22057 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
22058 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
22059 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
22060 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
22061 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
22062 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
22063 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
22064 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
22065 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
22066 before they subscribed.
22068 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
22069 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
22070 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
22071 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
22074 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
22075 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
22076 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
22077 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
22079 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
22080 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
22081 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
22083 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
22086 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
22087 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
22088 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
22089 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
22090 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
22094 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
22095 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
22096 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
22097 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
22098 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
22099 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
22100 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
22101 See &%check_owner%& above.
22104 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
22105 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
22106 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
22107 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
22110 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
22111 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22112 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
22113 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
22114 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
22115 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
22116 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
22119 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
22120 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
22121 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
22122 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
22123 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
22124 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
22125 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
22126 &$qualify_recipient$&.
22128 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
22129 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
22130 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
22133 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
22134 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
22135 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
22136 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
22137 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
22138 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
22139 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
22140 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
22141 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
22142 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
22145 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
22146 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
22147 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
22148 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
22149 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
22150 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
22153 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
22154 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
22155 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
22156 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
22157 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
22158 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
22161 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
22162 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
22163 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
22164 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
22165 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
22168 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
22169 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22170 :subaddress part of an address.
22172 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
22173 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
22174 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
22175 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
22178 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
22179 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
22180 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
22181 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
22182 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
22183 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
22184 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
22188 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
22189 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
22190 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
22191 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
22192 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
22193 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
22194 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
22195 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
22196 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
22197 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
22198 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
22199 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
22200 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
22201 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
22202 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
22203 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
22205 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
22206 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
22207 the following routers.
22209 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
22210 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
22211 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
22212 so it is passed to the following routers.
22214 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
22215 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
22216 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
22217 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
22219 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
22220 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
22221 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
22222 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
22228 file = $home/.forward
22229 file_transport = address_file
22230 pipe_transport = address_pipe
22231 reply_transport = address_reply
22234 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
22235 syntax_errors_text = \
22236 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
22237 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
22238 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
22239 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
22240 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
22241 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
22242 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
22243 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
22244 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
22245 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
22247 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
22248 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
22249 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
22254 local_part_prefix = real-
22255 transport = local_delivery
22257 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
22258 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
22260 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
22261 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
22265 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
22266 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22269 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
22270 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22271 .ecindex IIDredrou1
22272 .ecindex IIDredrou2
22279 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22280 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22282 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
22283 "Environment for local transports"
22284 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
22285 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
22286 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
22287 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
22288 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
22289 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
22290 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
22292 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
22293 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
22294 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
22295 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
22297 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
22298 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
22299 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
22300 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
22301 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
22305 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
22306 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
22307 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
22308 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
22309 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
22310 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
22311 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
22314 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
22315 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
22319 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
22321 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
22322 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
22323 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
22324 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
22329 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
22330 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
22331 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
22332 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
22333 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
22334 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
22335 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
22336 group (set by the transport). For example:
22339 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
22343 transport = group_delivery
22346 # This transport overrides the group
22348 driver = appendfile
22349 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
22352 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
22353 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
22354 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
22357 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
22358 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
22359 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
22360 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
22361 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
22362 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
22364 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
22365 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
22366 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
22367 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
22368 original gid is also used.
22370 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
22371 following that is set is used:
22374 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
22376 A &%group%& setting of the router;
22378 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
22379 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
22381 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
22383 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
22384 the uid is the creator's uid;
22386 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
22389 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
22390 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
22391 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
22392 The first of the following that is set is used:
22395 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
22397 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
22399 A &%user%& setting of the router;
22401 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
22406 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
22407 &%never_users%& list.
22413 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
22414 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
22415 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
22416 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
22417 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
22418 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
22419 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
22420 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
22421 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
22422 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22425 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
22427 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
22429 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
22431 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
22434 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22437 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
22439 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
22443 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
22444 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
22445 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
22449 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
22450 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22451 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22452 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
22453 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
22454 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
22455 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
22456 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
22457 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
22458 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
22459 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
22460 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
22461 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
22462 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
22470 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22471 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22473 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
22474 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
22475 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
22476 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
22477 The name of a transport is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
22478 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
22481 The following generic options apply to all transports:
22484 .option body_only transports boolean false
22485 .cindex "transport" "body only"
22486 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
22487 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
22488 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
22489 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
22490 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
22491 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
22492 automatically suppress them.
22495 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
22496 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
22497 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
22498 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
22499 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
22500 logged, and delivery is deferred.
22503 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
22504 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
22505 deliveries by the transport or for any
22506 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
22507 what you are doing.
22510 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
22511 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
22512 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
22513 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
22515 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
22516 output, and Exim carries on processing.
22517 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
22518 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
22519 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
22520 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
22522 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
22523 transport and the router that called it.
22525 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
22526 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
22527 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
22528 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
22529 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
22530 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
22531 safely be resent to other recipients.
22534 .option driver transports string unset
22535 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22536 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22539 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22540 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22541 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22542 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22543 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22544 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22545 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22546 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22547 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22548 resent to other recipients.
22550 &*Note:*& If used on a transport handling multiple recipients
22551 (the smtp transport unless &%max_rcpt%& is 1, the appendfile, pipe or lmtp
22552 transport if &%batch_max%& is greater than 1)
22553 then information about Bcc recipients will be leaked.
22554 Doing so is generally not advised.
22557 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
22559 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22560 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22563 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22564 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22565 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22566 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22567 &%user%& (see below).
22570 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22571 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22572 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22573 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22574 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22575 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22576 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22577 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22578 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22579 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22580 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22582 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22583 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22586 .option headers_only transports boolean false
22587 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22588 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22589 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22590 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22591 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22592 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22593 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22596 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22597 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
22598 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22599 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22600 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22601 to be removed from the message.
22602 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22603 Each list item is separately expanded.
22604 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22605 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22606 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22607 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22609 Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22610 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22613 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22614 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22616 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22617 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22618 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22622 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22623 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22624 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22625 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22626 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22627 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22628 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22629 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22632 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22635 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22636 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22637 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22638 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22639 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22640 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22641 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22642 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22643 change envelope recipients at this time.
22646 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22647 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22649 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22650 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22651 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22652 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22653 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22654 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22655 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22659 .option initgroups transports boolean false
22660 .cindex "additional groups"
22661 .cindex "groups" "additional"
22662 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22663 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22664 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22665 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22668 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22669 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22670 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
22671 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22672 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22673 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22674 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22675 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22677 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22678 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22679 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22680 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22681 Obviously there is scope for
22682 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22683 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22685 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22686 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22687 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22688 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22689 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22692 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22693 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
22694 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
22695 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
22696 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
22697 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
22698 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
22699 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
22700 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
22701 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
22702 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
22703 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
22704 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
22709 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
22710 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
22711 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
22712 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
22713 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
22714 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
22715 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
22716 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
22719 local_part_prefix = *-
22721 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
22724 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
22726 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
22727 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
22728 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
22729 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
22730 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
22733 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
22734 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
22735 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
22736 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
22737 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
22738 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
22739 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
22740 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
22741 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
22743 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
22744 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
22745 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
22746 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
22748 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
22749 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
22750 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
22753 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
22754 .cindex "envelope sender"
22755 .cindex "envelope from"
22756 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22757 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22758 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22759 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22760 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22761 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22762 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22763 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22764 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22766 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22767 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22769 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
22770 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22771 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22772 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22773 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22774 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22775 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22777 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22778 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22779 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22780 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22781 &%errors_to%& in a router.
22785 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
22786 .chindex Return-path:
22787 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22788 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22789 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22790 have easy access to it.
22792 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22793 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22794 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22795 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22796 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22800 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22801 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22804 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
22805 .cindex "shadow transport"
22806 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
22807 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22808 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22810 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22811 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22812 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22813 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22814 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22815 cause a log line to be written.
22817 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22818 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22819 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22820 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22821 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22824 ST=<shadow transport name>
22826 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22827 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22828 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22829 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22830 headers that some sites insist on.
22833 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22834 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22835 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22836 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22837 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22838 individual users or via a system filter.
22839 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22841 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22842 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22843 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22844 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock).
22845 The command must be specified as an absolute path.
22847 The process run by the command must use its standard input as the message
22848 data to be transformed, and write the results on its standard output.
22850 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22851 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22852 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22853 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22854 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22855 &(pipe)& transports.
22857 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22858 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22859 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22860 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22861 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22863 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22864 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22865 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22866 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22868 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22869 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22870 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22871 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22872 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22873 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22875 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
22876 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22877 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22878 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22879 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22880 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22881 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22882 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22884 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22885 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22886 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22887 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22888 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22889 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22890 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22891 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22892 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22893 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22896 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22897 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22898 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22899 which the message is being sent. For example:
22900 . used to have $sender_address in this cmdline, but it's tainted
22902 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22903 $host $host_address $pipe_addresses
22906 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22907 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22908 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22910 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22911 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22912 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22915 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22917 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22918 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise.
22920 Option strings in general have any fully-surrounding double quote wrapping
22921 removed early in parsing (see &<<SECTstrings>>&).
22922 Then, for this option, quotes protect against whitespace being
22923 regarded as a separator while splitting into the command argument vector.
22924 Either double or single quotes can be used here;
22925 the former interprets backlash-quoted charachters
22926 and the latter does not.
22928 If double quotes had been used in this example, they would have been
22929 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22930 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22931 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22932 Exim tried to expand the first one.
22934 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22935 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22936 arguments. Consider this example:
22938 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22939 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22941 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22942 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22944 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22945 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22949 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22950 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22951 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22952 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22953 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22954 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22955 bounced from a transport filter.
22957 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22958 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22959 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22962 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22963 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22964 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22965 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22966 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22967 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22968 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22969 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22970 becomes a temporary error.
22973 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22974 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22975 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22976 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22977 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22978 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22979 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22982 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22983 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22984 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22986 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22987 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22988 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22989 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22991 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22992 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22993 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
23000 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23003 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
23005 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
23006 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
23007 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
23008 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
23009 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
23010 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
23011 copy of the message is delivered each time.
23013 .cindex "batched local delivery"
23014 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
23015 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
23016 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
23017 local transport, for example:
23020 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
23021 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
23022 recipients saves space.
23024 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
23025 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
23027 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
23028 to a scanner program or
23029 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
23033 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
23034 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
23035 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
23037 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
23038 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
23039 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
23040 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
23041 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
23042 to certain conditions:
23045 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23046 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
23047 batching is possible.
23049 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23050 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
23051 addresses with the same domain are batched.
23053 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
23054 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
23055 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
23056 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
23057 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
23060 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
23061 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
23062 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
23066 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
23067 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
23068 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
23069 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
23070 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
23071 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
23072 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
23075 escape_string = ".."
23077 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
23078 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
23079 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
23081 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
23082 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
23083 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
23084 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
23085 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
23086 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
23088 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
23089 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23090 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
23091 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
23092 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
23093 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
23094 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
23095 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
23096 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
23101 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23102 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23104 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
23105 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
23106 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
23107 .cindex "directory creation"
23108 .cindex "creating directories"
23109 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
23110 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
23111 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
23112 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
23113 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
23114 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
23115 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
23116 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
23117 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
23118 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
23120 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
23121 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
23122 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
23125 .cindex "quota" "system"
23126 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
23127 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
23128 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
23130 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
23131 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
23132 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
23133 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
23135 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
23136 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
23139 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
23140 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
23141 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
23142 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
23147 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
23148 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
23149 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
23150 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
23151 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
23153 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
23154 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23155 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
23156 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
23157 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
23158 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
23159 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
23160 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
23161 operation. There are two cases:
23164 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
23165 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
23166 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
23167 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
23168 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
23169 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
23170 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
23172 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
23173 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
23174 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
23176 If the &%create_file%& option is set to a path which
23177 matches (see the option definition below for details)
23178 a file or directory name
23179 for the delivery, that name becomes de-tainted.
23181 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
23182 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
23183 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
23184 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
23185 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
23186 which returns a path (or component).
23189 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
23190 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
23191 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
23192 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
23197 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
23199 require "fileinto";
23200 fileinto "folder23";
23202 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
23203 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
23204 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
23205 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
23206 way of handling this requirement:
23208 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
23209 {/var/mail/$local_part_data} \
23210 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
23212 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
23216 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
23217 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
23218 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
23220 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
23221 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
23222 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
23223 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
23224 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
23225 path to the transport.
23227 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
23228 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
23233 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
23234 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
23238 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
23239 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
23240 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
23241 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
23242 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
23243 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
23244 delivery is deferred.
23247 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
23248 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23249 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23250 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
23251 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
23252 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
23253 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
23254 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
23257 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
23258 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23259 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
23260 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
23264 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
23265 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23268 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
23269 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
23270 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
23271 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
23272 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
23275 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
23276 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
23277 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
23278 process is running.
23281 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
23282 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23283 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
23284 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
23285 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
23286 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
23287 contains is significant.
23289 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
23290 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
23291 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
23292 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
23293 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
23295 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
23296 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
23297 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
23298 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
23299 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
23300 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
23302 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23303 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
23304 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23305 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23307 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
23308 .cindex "directory creation"
23309 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
23310 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
23311 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
23313 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
23314 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
23315 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
23316 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
23317 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
23321 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
23322 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
23323 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
23324 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
23325 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
23328 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
23329 &"belowhome"&, or to an absolute path.
23331 In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
23332 set for the transport, and the file or directory being created must
23334 The "belowhome" checking additionally checks for attempts to use "../"
23335 to evade the testing.
23336 This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
23337 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
23338 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
23339 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
23340 &%file_must_exist%&.
23342 In the fourth case,
23343 the value given for this option must be an absolute path for an
23344 existing directory.
23345 The value is used for checking instead of a home directory;
23346 checking is done in "belowhome" mode.
23348 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
23349 .cindex "de-tainting" "using appendfile create_file option"
23350 If "belowhome" checking is used, the file or directory path
23351 becomes de-tainted.
23354 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
23355 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
23356 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
23357 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
23359 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
23360 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
23361 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
23362 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
23363 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
23365 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23369 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
23371 .vindex "&$inode$&"
23372 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
23373 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
23374 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
23376 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
23378 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
23379 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
23383 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
23384 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
23385 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
23388 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
23389 See &%check_string%& above.
23392 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
23393 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
23394 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
23395 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
23396 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
23397 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
23400 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23403 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23404 .cindex "locking files"
23405 .cindex "lock files"
23406 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
23407 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
23409 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
23410 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
23413 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
23414 file = /home/$local_part_data/inbox
23417 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
23418 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
23419 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
23420 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
23421 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
23422 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
23426 .option file_format appendfile string unset
23427 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
23428 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
23429 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
23430 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
23431 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
23432 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
23433 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
23434 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
23437 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
23438 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
23440 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
23441 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
23442 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
23443 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
23444 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
23445 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
23446 delivery is deferred.
23449 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
23450 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
23451 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
23452 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
23455 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
23456 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23457 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
23458 .cindex "locking files"
23459 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
23460 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
23461 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
23462 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
23463 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
23464 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
23465 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
23466 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
23468 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
23469 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
23470 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
23471 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
23473 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
23474 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
23477 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
23479 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
23480 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
23481 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
23483 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
23484 local deliveries because of errors of the form
23486 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
23489 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
23490 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
23491 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
23492 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
23495 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
23496 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
23497 for details of locking.
23500 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
23501 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
23502 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
23505 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23506 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
23507 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
23510 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
23511 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23512 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
23513 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
23514 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
23517 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
23518 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23519 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23520 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23521 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
23522 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
23523 external source that maintains the data.
23526 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
23527 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23528 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23529 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23530 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
23531 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
23532 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
23533 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
23537 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
23538 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
23539 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
23540 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
23541 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
23542 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
23543 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
23544 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
23545 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
23546 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23549 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
23550 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
23551 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
23552 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
23553 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
23554 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
23555 calculation. The default value is:
23557 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
23559 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
23560 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
23562 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
23564 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
23566 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
23567 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
23568 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
23569 directly into that directory.
23572 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
23573 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
23574 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23577 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
23578 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23579 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23582 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23583 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23584 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23585 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23586 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23587 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23588 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23589 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23591 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23592 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23593 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23594 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23595 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23596 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23597 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23598 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23599 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23600 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23603 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23604 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23605 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23606 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23607 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23608 below for further details.
23611 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23612 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23613 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23616 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23617 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23618 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23621 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23622 .cindex "locking files"
23623 .cindex "file" "locking"
23624 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
23625 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23626 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23627 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23628 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23629 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23630 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23632 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23633 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23634 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23641 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23642 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23643 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23644 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23645 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23646 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23647 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23648 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23650 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23651 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23652 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23653 append messages to it.
23656 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23657 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23658 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23659 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23660 in which case it is:
23662 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
23663 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
23665 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23666 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23668 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23669 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23670 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23671 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
23676 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23677 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23679 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23680 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
23681 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
23682 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
23683 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
23684 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
23685 value, and this option is ignored.
23688 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
23689 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
23690 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
23691 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
23692 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
23695 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
23696 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
23697 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
23698 on users about incoming mail.
23701 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
23702 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
23703 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
23704 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
23705 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
23706 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
23707 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
23708 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
23709 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
23711 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
23712 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
23713 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
23715 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
23716 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
23717 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
23718 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
23719 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
23720 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
23722 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
23723 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
23724 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
23725 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
23726 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
23729 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23730 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23732 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
23734 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
23735 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
23736 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
23737 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
23738 system quota failures.
23740 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
23741 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
23742 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
23743 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
23744 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
23745 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
23746 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
23747 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
23748 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
23749 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
23752 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
23753 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
23754 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
23755 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
23756 delivery directory.
23759 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
23760 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
23761 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
23762 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
23763 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
23766 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23767 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23769 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
23770 See &%quota%& above.
23773 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
23774 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
23775 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
23776 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
23777 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
23778 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
23779 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
23781 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
23782 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
23783 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
23784 the file length to the filename. For example:
23786 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
23787 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
23789 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
23790 number of lines in the message.
23792 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
23793 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
23794 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
23796 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23798 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23799 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23800 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23801 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23802 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23803 as is used to adjust the effective size.
23806 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23807 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23808 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
23810 quota_warn_message = "\
23811 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
23812 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
23813 This message is automatically created \
23814 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
23815 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
23816 a warning threshold that is\n\
23817 set by the system administrator.\n"
23821 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
23822 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
23823 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
23824 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23825 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
23826 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
23827 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
23828 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
23829 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
23833 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
23835 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
23836 percent sign is ignored.
23838 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
23839 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
23840 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
23841 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
23842 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23843 &'From:'& line, the default is:
23845 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23847 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23848 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23851 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23852 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23856 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23857 .cindex "envelope from"
23858 .cindex "envelope sender"
23859 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23860 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23861 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23862 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23863 for details of batch SMTP.
23866 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23867 .cindex "carriage return"
23869 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23870 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23871 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23872 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23874 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23875 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23876 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23877 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23878 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23879 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23882 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23883 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23884 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23885 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23886 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23887 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23890 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23891 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23892 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23893 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23894 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23896 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23897 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23898 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23899 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23901 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23902 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23903 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23904 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23905 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23908 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23909 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23912 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23913 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23914 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23915 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23916 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23917 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23918 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23920 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23921 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23922 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23923 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23926 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23927 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23928 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23931 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23932 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23933 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23934 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23935 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23936 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23937 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23938 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23939 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23941 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23942 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23943 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23944 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23949 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23950 .cindex "appending to a file"
23951 .cindex "file" "appending"
23952 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23955 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23959 .cindex "directory creation"
23960 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23961 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23962 &%directory_mode%& option.
23965 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23966 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23970 .cindex "file" "locking"
23971 .cindex "locking files"
23972 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23973 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23974 reliably over NFS, as follows:
23977 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23978 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23979 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23981 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23983 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23984 Unlink the hitching post name.
23986 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23987 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23988 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23989 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23991 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23992 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23993 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23994 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23995 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23996 it before trying again.
24000 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
24001 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
24002 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
24005 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
24006 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
24007 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
24008 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
24009 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
24010 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
24011 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
24012 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
24013 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
24017 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
24018 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
24019 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
24020 delivery is deferred.
24023 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
24024 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
24025 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
24029 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
24030 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
24031 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
24034 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
24035 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
24036 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
24039 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
24040 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
24041 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
24042 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
24043 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
24044 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
24045 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
24046 that prevents link following.
24049 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
24050 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
24051 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
24052 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
24053 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
24056 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
24059 .cindex "file" "locking"
24060 .cindex "locking files"
24061 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
24062 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
24063 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
24064 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
24065 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
24067 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
24069 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
24070 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
24071 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
24073 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
24074 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
24075 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
24077 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
24078 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
24079 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
24080 delivery is deferred.
24082 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
24083 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
24084 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
24085 immediately. It retries up to
24087 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
24089 times (rounded up).
24092 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
24093 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
24096 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
24097 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
24098 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24099 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
24100 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
24101 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
24102 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
24103 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
24104 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
24105 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
24107 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
24108 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
24109 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
24110 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
24111 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
24112 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
24113 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
24115 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
24116 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
24117 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
24118 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
24121 .cindex "maildir format"
24122 .cindex "mailstore format"
24123 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
24124 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
24125 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
24126 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
24127 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
24129 .cindex "directory creation"
24130 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
24131 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
24132 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
24133 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
24134 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
24135 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
24140 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
24141 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
24142 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
24143 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
24144 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
24145 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
24146 &_new_& subdirectory.
24148 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
24149 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
24150 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
24151 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
24152 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
24153 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
24154 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
24156 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
24157 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
24158 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
24159 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
24160 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
24161 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
24162 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
24163 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
24165 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
24166 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
24167 folders. Consider this example:
24169 maildir_format = true
24170 directory = /var/mail/$local_part_data\
24171 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
24172 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
24173 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
24175 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
24176 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
24177 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
24178 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
24179 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
24180 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
24182 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
24183 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
24184 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
24185 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
24186 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
24188 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
24189 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
24190 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
24192 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24193 .cindex "maildir++"
24194 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
24195 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
24196 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
24197 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
24198 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
24199 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
24200 amount of space used.
24202 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
24203 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
24204 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
24205 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
24206 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
24207 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
24212 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
24213 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
24214 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
24215 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
24216 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
24217 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
24220 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24221 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
24222 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
24223 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
24224 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
24225 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
24226 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
24227 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
24228 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
24229 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
24230 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
24231 backwards compatibility).
24233 For one common implementation, you might set:
24235 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
24237 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
24239 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
24240 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
24241 &[stat()]& each message file.
24244 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
24245 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24246 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
24247 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
24248 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
24249 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
24250 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
24251 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
24252 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
24254 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
24255 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
24256 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
24257 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
24258 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
24259 need to know the quota.
24261 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
24262 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
24264 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
24265 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
24266 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
24270 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
24271 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
24272 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
24273 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
24274 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
24275 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
24276 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
24277 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
24279 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
24280 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
24281 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
24282 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
24283 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
24284 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
24286 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
24287 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
24288 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
24289 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
24290 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
24291 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
24293 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
24294 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
24295 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
24296 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
24299 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
24300 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
24301 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
24302 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
24303 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
24305 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
24307 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
24308 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
24309 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
24310 .ecindex IIDapptra1
24311 .ecindex IIDapptra2
24318 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24319 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24321 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
24322 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
24323 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
24324 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
24325 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
24326 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
24327 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
24328 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
24330 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
24331 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
24332 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
24333 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
24334 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
24337 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
24338 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
24339 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
24340 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
24341 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
24343 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
24344 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
24345 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
24346 transport is run as a consequence of a
24348 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
24349 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
24350 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
24351 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
24352 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
24353 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
24355 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
24356 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
24357 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
24358 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
24360 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
24361 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
24362 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
24363 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
24364 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
24365 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
24366 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
24368 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
24369 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
24370 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
24371 the transport defers.
24372 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
24373 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
24375 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
24376 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
24377 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
24378 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
24380 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24381 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
24382 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
24383 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
24384 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
24385 problems. They are just discarded.
24389 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
24390 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
24392 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
24393 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
24394 message when the message is specified by the transport.
24397 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
24398 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
24399 when the message is specified by the transport.
24402 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
24403 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
24404 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
24405 string comes first.
24408 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
24409 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
24410 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
24413 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
24414 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
24415 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
24418 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
24419 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
24420 specified by the transport.
24423 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
24424 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
24425 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
24426 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
24429 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
24430 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
24431 the message is specified by the transport.
24434 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
24435 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
24439 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
24440 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
24441 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
24442 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
24443 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
24447 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
24448 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
24449 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
24450 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
24452 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
24453 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
24454 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
24455 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
24456 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
24457 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
24458 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
24461 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
24462 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
24463 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
24464 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
24465 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
24467 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
24468 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
24469 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
24470 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
24471 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
24472 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
24475 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
24476 See &%once%& above.
24479 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
24480 See &%once%& above.
24481 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
24484 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
24485 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
24486 specified by the transport.
24489 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
24490 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
24491 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
24492 configuration option.
24495 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
24496 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
24497 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
24498 automatic responses. For example:
24500 subject = Re: $h_subject:
24502 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
24503 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
24504 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
24505 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
24510 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
24511 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
24512 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
24513 the text comes first.
24516 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
24517 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
24518 when the message is specified by the transport.
24519 .ecindex IIDauttra1
24520 .ecindex IIDauttra2
24525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24526 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24528 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
24529 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
24530 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
24531 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
24532 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
24533 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
24535 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
24536 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
24537 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
24538 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
24539 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
24540 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
24544 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
24545 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
24546 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
24549 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
24550 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24553 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
24554 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24555 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
24556 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
24557 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24560 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
24561 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
24562 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
24563 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
24564 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
24565 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
24568 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
24569 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24570 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
24571 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
24572 in its response to the LHLO command.
24574 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
24575 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
24576 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
24577 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
24580 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
24581 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24582 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24583 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24588 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24592 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24593 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24600 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24601 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24602 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24603 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24604 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24605 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24606 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24607 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24611 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24612 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24613 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24614 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24615 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24617 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24618 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24619 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24620 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24621 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24622 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24623 that are routed to the transport.
24625 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24626 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24627 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24628 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24629 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24630 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24631 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24635 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24636 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24637 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24639 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24640 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24641 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24642 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24643 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24644 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24645 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24647 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24648 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
24649 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24652 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24653 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24654 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24655 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24656 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24657 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
24658 of "1" to enforce serialization.
24663 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
24664 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
24665 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
24666 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
24667 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
24668 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
24669 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
24670 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
24671 &"local delivery failed"&.
24673 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
24674 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
24675 will be sent as normal.
24677 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
24678 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
24679 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
24680 apply in this case.
24682 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
24683 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
24684 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
24685 a non-existent command may be the problem.
24687 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
24688 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
24689 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
24690 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
24691 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
24692 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
24693 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
24698 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
24699 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
24700 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
24701 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
24702 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
24705 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
24706 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
24707 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
24708 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
24710 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
24711 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
24712 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
24713 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
24714 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
24716 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
24718 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
24719 arguments. You have to write
24721 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
24723 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
24724 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
24725 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
24726 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
24727 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
24728 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
24731 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
24734 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24735 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24736 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24737 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
24738 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
24739 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
24740 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
24741 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
24742 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
24743 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
24744 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
24746 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
24747 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
24748 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
24749 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
24750 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
24751 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
24752 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
24753 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
24755 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
24756 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
24757 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
24758 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
24759 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
24760 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
24761 control what is done with it.
24763 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
24764 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
24765 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
24766 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
24767 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
24768 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
24769 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
24770 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
24771 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
24772 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
24773 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
24777 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
24778 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24779 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24780 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
24781 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
24782 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
24783 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
24784 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
24785 &*Note*&: Using enviroment variables loses track of tainted data.
24786 Writers of &(pipe)& transport commands should be wary of data supplied
24787 by potential attackers.
24789 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
24790 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
24791 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
24792 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
24793 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
24794 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
24795 &`LOGNAME `& see below
24796 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
24797 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24798 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24799 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24800 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24801 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24802 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24803 &`USER `& see below
24805 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
24806 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
24807 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
24808 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
24809 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
24810 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
24811 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
24814 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
24815 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
24816 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
24820 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
24821 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
24822 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
24823 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
24826 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
24827 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
24831 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
24832 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
24833 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24834 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
24835 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
24836 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
24837 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
24838 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
24839 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
24840 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
24841 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
24844 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
24846 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
24847 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
24848 &%use_shell%& is set.
24851 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24852 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24855 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
24856 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24857 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24860 .option check_string pipe string unset
24861 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24862 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24863 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24864 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24865 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24866 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24867 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24871 .option command pipe string&!! unset
24872 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24873 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24874 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24875 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24876 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24877 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24879 .cindex "tainted data"
24880 No part of the resulting command may be tainted.
24883 .option environment pipe "string list&!!" unset
24884 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24885 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24886 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24887 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24888 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24889 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24892 .option escape_string pipe string unset
24893 See &%check_string%& above.
24896 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24897 .cindex "exec failure"
24898 .cindex "failure of exec"
24899 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24900 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24901 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24902 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24903 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24906 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24907 .cindex "signal exit"
24908 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24909 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24910 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24911 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24914 .option force_command pipe boolean false
24915 .cindex "force command"
24916 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24917 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24918 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24919 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24920 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24921 command. For example:
24923 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24927 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24928 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24929 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24932 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24933 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24934 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24935 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24936 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24937 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24939 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24940 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24943 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24944 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24945 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24946 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24947 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24948 written to the main log.
24951 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24952 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24953 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24954 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24955 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24956 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24960 .option log_output pipe boolean false
24961 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24962 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24963 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24964 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24967 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
24968 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24969 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24970 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24971 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24972 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24973 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24974 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24977 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24978 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24979 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24982 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24986 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
24987 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24988 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24989 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24990 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24995 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24996 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24999 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
25000 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
25001 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
25002 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
25006 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25007 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
25010 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
25011 This option is expanded and
25012 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
25013 variable of the subprocess.
25014 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
25015 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
25016 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
25019 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
25020 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
25021 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
25022 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
25023 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
25024 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
25025 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
25026 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
25027 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
25030 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
25031 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
25032 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
25033 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
25034 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
25035 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
25036 accept the message is used.
25039 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
25040 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
25041 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
25042 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
25043 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
25044 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
25047 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
25048 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
25049 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
25050 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
25051 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
25052 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
25053 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25057 .option return_output pipe boolean false
25058 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
25059 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
25060 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
25061 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
25062 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
25063 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
25064 of them may be set.
25068 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
25069 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
25070 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
25071 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
25072 and &%return_output%& is not set,
25073 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
25074 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
25075 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
25076 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
25077 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
25078 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
25079 and 73, respectively.
25082 .option timeout pipe time 1h
25083 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
25084 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
25085 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
25086 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
25087 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
25088 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
25090 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
25091 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
25092 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
25093 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
25094 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
25095 delivery to be deferred.
25097 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
25098 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
25101 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
25102 .cindex "envelope sender"
25103 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
25104 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
25105 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
25106 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
25107 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
25109 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
25110 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
25111 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
25112 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
25113 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
25114 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
25118 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
25119 .cindex "carriage return"
25121 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
25122 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
25123 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
25124 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
25126 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
25127 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
25128 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
25129 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
25130 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
25133 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
25134 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
25135 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
25136 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
25137 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
25138 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
25139 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
25140 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
25141 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
25146 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
25147 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
25148 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
25149 .cindex "external local delivery"
25150 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
25151 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
25152 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
25153 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
25154 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
25155 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
25156 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
25157 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
25158 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
25159 configuration for &%procmail%&:
25164 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part_data
25168 check_string = "From "
25169 escape_string = ">From "
25171 user = $local_part_data
25178 transport = procmail_pipe
25180 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
25181 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
25182 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
25183 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
25184 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
25185 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
25187 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
25191 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
25192 use a shell to run pipe commands.
25195 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
25196 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
25197 . Used to have R: local_part_suffix = .* + T: -m $local_part_suffix_v
25198 . but that suffix is tainted so cannot be used in a command arg
25199 . Really, you'd want to use a lookup for acceptable suffixes to do real detainting
25202 local_delivery_cyrus:
25204 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
25205 -- $local_part_data
25217 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
25219 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
25220 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
25222 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
25223 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
25226 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25229 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
25230 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
25231 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
25232 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
25233 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
25234 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
25235 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
25236 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
25239 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
25240 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
25244 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
25245 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
25246 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
25247 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
25248 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
25249 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
25250 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
25252 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
25253 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
25254 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
25255 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
25256 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
25257 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
25262 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
25263 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
25264 no further messages are sent over that connection.
25268 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
25270 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25271 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
25272 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
25273 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
25274 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
25275 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
25276 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
25277 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
25280 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
25281 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25282 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25283 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25284 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25285 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
25286 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25287 are the values that were set when the message was received.
25288 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
25289 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
25290 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
25291 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
25292 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
25293 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
25295 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
25296 and will be removed in a future release.
25299 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
25300 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
25301 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
25304 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
25305 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
25306 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
25307 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
25308 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
25309 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
25310 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
25311 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
25313 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
25314 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
25315 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25316 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
25317 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
25318 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
25319 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
25320 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
25321 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
25324 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
25326 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
25327 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
25328 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
25329 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
25330 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
25333 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
25334 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
25335 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
25336 particular connection.
25338 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
25339 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
25340 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
25341 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
25343 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
25344 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
25345 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
25347 authenticated_sender = $local_part
25349 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
25350 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
25352 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
25353 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
25357 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
25358 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
25359 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
25360 authenticated as a client.
25363 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
25364 .cindex timeout "smtp transport command"
25365 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
25366 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
25367 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
25370 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
25371 .cindex timeout "smtp transport connect"
25372 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
25373 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
25374 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
25375 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
25376 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
25377 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
25380 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
25381 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
25382 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
25383 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25384 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
25385 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
25386 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
25390 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
25391 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a MAILMAX value,
25392 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
25393 that value also constrains the result of this option.
25397 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25398 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
25399 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25400 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
25401 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
25402 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
25403 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
25404 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
25405 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
25406 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
25407 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
25408 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
25409 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
25410 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
25413 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
25414 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data blocks"
25415 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
25416 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
25417 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
25420 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
25421 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25422 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
25423 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25424 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
25425 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25426 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
25427 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25428 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
25429 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25430 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
25431 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25432 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
25433 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25434 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
25435 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25436 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
25437 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25440 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
25441 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
25442 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
25443 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
25444 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
25447 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
25448 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
25449 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
25450 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
25451 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
25452 unhappy at this prospect, so...
25454 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25455 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
25456 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25457 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
25458 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
25459 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
25460 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
25461 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
25465 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
25466 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
25467 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
25468 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
25469 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
25472 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
25473 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
25474 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
25475 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
25479 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
25480 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25481 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25482 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25483 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25484 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
25485 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
25486 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
25491 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
25492 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25493 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25494 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25495 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25496 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
25497 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
25498 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
25499 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
25503 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
25504 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
25505 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
25506 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
25507 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
25508 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
25509 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
25511 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
25512 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
25513 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
25514 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
25515 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
25518 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
25519 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25520 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
25521 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
25522 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
25523 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25524 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25525 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
25527 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
25528 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
25529 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
25530 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
25531 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
25532 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
25534 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
25535 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
25536 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
25537 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
25538 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
25540 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
25541 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
25542 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
25543 copy of the message is sent.
25545 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
25546 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
25547 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
25548 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
25552 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
25553 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data accept"
25554 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
25555 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
25558 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
25559 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
25560 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
25561 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
25562 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
25563 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
25565 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
25566 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
25567 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
25568 implementations of TLS.
25570 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
25571 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
25572 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
25573 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
25574 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
25575 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
25576 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
25581 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
25582 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
25583 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
25584 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
25585 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
25586 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
25587 interface address, you could use this:
25589 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address} \
25590 {${listextract{1}{<\n $value}}} \
25591 {$primary_hostname}}
25593 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
25596 .option host_name_extract smtp "string list&!!" "see below"
25597 .cindex "load balancer" "hosts behind"
25598 .cindex TLS resumption
25599 Some mail-accepting sites
25600 (notably Microsoft)
25601 operate many servers behind a network load-balancer. When this is done,
25602 with separated TLS session caches, TLS session resuption becomes problematic.
25603 It will only succeed when the same server happens to be selected by the
25604 load-balancer, matching the session stored in the client's cache.
25606 Exim can pull out a server name, if there is one, from the response to the
25607 client's SMTP EHLO command.
25608 For normal STARTTLS use, the default value of this option:
25610 ${if and { {match {$host} {.outlook.com\$}} \
25611 {match {$item} {\N^250-([\w.]+)\s\N}} \
25614 suffices for one known case.
25616 During the expansion of this option the &$item$& variable will have the
25617 server's EHLO response.
25620 For TLS-on-connect connections we do not have an EHLO
25621 response to use. Because of this the default value of this option is
25622 set to a static string for those cases, meaning that resumption will
25623 always be attempted if permitted by the &%tls_resumption_hosts%& option.
25626 The result of the option expansion is included in the key used to store and
25627 retrieve the TLS session, for session resumption.
25629 Operators of high-load sites may wish to evaluate their logs for indications
25630 of other destination sites operating load-balancers, and develop a suitable
25631 expression for this option.
25632 The smtp:ehlo event and the &$tls_out_resumption$& variable
25633 will be useful for such work.
25635 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25636 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25637 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25638 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25639 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25640 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25642 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25643 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25644 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25645 &%hosts_override%& is set.
25647 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25648 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25649 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25650 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25651 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25652 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25653 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25655 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25656 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25657 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25658 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25659 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25660 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
25661 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
25664 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
25665 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
25668 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25669 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
25670 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
25671 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
25672 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25673 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
25674 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
25675 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
25676 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
25677 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
25680 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
25681 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25682 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
25683 Exim will not use the ESMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
25684 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
25686 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
25687 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
25688 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
25689 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
25690 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
25691 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
25693 The retry hints database is used for the record,
25694 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
25695 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
25696 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
25697 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
25699 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
25702 When the facility is used, if the transport &%interface%& option is unset
25703 the &%helo_data%& option
25704 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
25706 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
25707 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
25708 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
25709 You have been warned.
25712 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25713 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25714 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25715 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25717 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25718 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25719 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
25720 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
25721 to any host that matches this list.
25724 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
25725 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25726 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
25727 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
25728 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
25729 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
25730 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
25731 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
25734 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
25735 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
25736 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
25741 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25742 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25743 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25744 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25745 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
25746 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25747 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
25748 explanation of when this might be needed.
25750 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25751 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25752 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25753 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25754 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
25755 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25756 message on the same session.
25758 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
25759 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
25760 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
25761 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
25762 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
25763 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
25768 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
25769 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
25770 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
25771 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
25772 &%fallback_hosts%&.
25775 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
25776 .cindex "randomized host list"
25777 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
25778 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
25779 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
25780 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
25781 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
25782 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
25783 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
25784 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
25786 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
25787 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
25788 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
25789 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
25791 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
25793 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
25794 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
25795 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
25797 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25798 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
25799 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
25800 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
25801 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
25802 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
25803 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
25804 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
25805 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25808 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" "see below"
25809 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25810 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
25811 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25812 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25814 The default is &"**"& if DANE is not in use for the connection,
25815 or if DANE-TA us used.
25816 It is empty if DANE-EE is used.
25818 .option hosts_require_alpn smtp "host list&!!" unset
25819 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in client"
25821 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
25822 If the TLS library supports ALPN
25823 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any host
25824 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
25825 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
25827 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
25828 managed by this option; see &%hosts_require_tls%&.
25830 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
25831 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25832 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
25833 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25834 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25835 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
25836 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25837 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25838 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25840 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25841 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25842 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
25843 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25844 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25846 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25847 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25848 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25849 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25850 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
25851 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
25853 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25854 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
25855 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25856 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
25857 connects. If authentication fails
25858 and &%hosts_require_auth%& permits,
25859 Exim will try to transfer the message unauthenticated.
25860 See also chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25862 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
25863 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
25864 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
25865 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
25866 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25867 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
25868 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
25869 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
25871 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
25872 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25873 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
25874 If built with DANE support, Exim will look up a
25875 TLSA record for any host matching the list,
25876 If one is found and that lookup was DNSSEC-validated,
25877 then Exim requires that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made for that host;
25878 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25879 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25880 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25882 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
25883 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
25884 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
25885 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
25886 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
25887 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
25888 perform a TCP Fast Open.
25889 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
25890 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
25891 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
25893 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
25894 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
25896 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
25897 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
25898 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
25899 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
25900 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
25902 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
25903 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
25904 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
25905 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25906 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
25907 for multi-recipient messages.
25908 The option can usually be left as default.
25910 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
25911 .cindex "bind IP address"
25912 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
25914 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25915 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
25916 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
25917 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
25918 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
25919 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
25920 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
25921 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
25924 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
25925 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
25926 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
25927 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
25928 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
25929 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
25932 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
25934 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
25935 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
25936 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
25937 interface to use if the host has more than one.
25940 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
25941 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25942 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25943 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25944 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25945 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25946 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25947 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25948 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25949 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25953 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25954 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25955 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25956 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25957 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25959 .option max_rcpt smtp integer&!! 100
25960 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25963 limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25964 SMTP message transaction.
25965 A value setting of zero disables the limit.
25967 If a constant is given,
25968 each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25969 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25973 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
25974 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTMAX value,
25975 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
25976 that value also constrains the result of this option
25977 and no parallel connections will be caused on meeting the RCPTMAX limit.
25981 .option message_linelength_limit smtp integer 998
25982 .cindex "line length" limit
25983 This option sets the maximum line length, in bytes, that the transport
25984 will send. Any messages with lines exceeding the given value
25985 (before a transport filter, if any)
25986 will fail and a failure-DSN ("bounce") message will if possible be returned
25988 The default value is that defined by the SMTP standards.
25990 It is generally wise to also check in the data ACL so that messages
25991 received via SMTP can be refused without producing a bounce.
25994 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25995 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25996 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25997 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25998 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25999 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
26000 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
26001 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
26003 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
26004 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
26005 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
26007 If the connection is DANE-enabled then this option is ignored;
26008 only messages having the domain used for the DANE TLSA lookup are
26009 sent on the connection.
26012 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26013 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTDOMAINMAX value,
26014 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26015 this option is regarded as being false.
26019 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
26020 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
26021 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
26022 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
26023 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
26024 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
26025 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
26026 variable that contains an outgoing port.
26028 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
26029 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
26031 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
26032 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
26033 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
26036 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
26037 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
26041 .option protocol smtp string smtp
26042 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
26043 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
26044 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
26046 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
26047 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
26048 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
26049 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
26050 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
26052 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
26053 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
26054 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
26055 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
26056 but as of RFC 8314 it is preferred over STARTTLS for message submission
26057 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
26060 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
26061 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
26062 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
26063 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
26064 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
26065 addresses is not affected.
26067 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
26068 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
26069 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
26070 Exim to use only the host name.
26071 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
26074 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26075 .cindex "serializing connections"
26076 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
26077 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
26078 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
26079 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
26080 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
26081 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
26082 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
26084 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
26085 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
26086 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
26087 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
26088 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
26089 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
26091 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
26092 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
26093 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
26094 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
26095 are used for ETRN serialization.
26097 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
26100 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
26101 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
26102 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
26103 .cindex "size" "of message"
26104 .cindex "transport" "filter"
26105 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
26106 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
26107 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
26108 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
26109 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
26110 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
26111 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
26113 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
26114 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
26117 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
26118 .cindex proxy SOCKS
26119 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
26120 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
26123 .option tls_alpn smtp string&!! unset
26124 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
26126 .cindex ALPN "set name in client"
26127 If this option is set
26128 and the TLS library supports ALPN,
26129 the value given is used.
26131 As of writing no value has been standardised for email use.
26132 The authors suggest using &"smtp"&.
26136 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
26137 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
26138 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
26140 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26141 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26142 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
26143 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
26144 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
26147 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
26148 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
26149 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
26150 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
26154 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
26155 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
26156 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
26157 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
26158 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
26161 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
26162 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
26163 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
26164 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
26165 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
26166 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
26169 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
26172 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
26173 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
26175 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26176 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26177 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
26178 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
26179 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26180 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
26181 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
26182 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26185 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
26186 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
26187 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
26189 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26190 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
26191 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
26192 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
26193 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26194 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
26195 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
26196 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
26197 ciphers is a preference order.
26200 .option tls_resumption_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26201 .cindex TLS resumption
26202 This option controls which connections to use the TLS resumption feature.
26203 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
26207 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
26208 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26210 .cindex SNI "setting in client"
26211 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
26212 If this option is set
26213 and the connection is not DANE-validated
26214 then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
26215 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
26216 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
26217 certificate and private key for the session.
26219 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
26221 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
26227 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
26228 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
26229 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
26230 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
26231 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
26232 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
26233 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
26234 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
26235 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26236 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26240 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
26241 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26242 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26243 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26244 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
26245 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26246 Note that unless the host is in this list
26247 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
26248 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
26249 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
26250 certificate verification succeeds.
26253 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
26254 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
26255 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26256 This option give a list of hosts for which,
26257 while verifying the server certificate,
26258 checks will be included on the host name
26259 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
26260 versus the Subject-Alternate-Name (or, if none, Subject-Name) fields.
26261 Wildcard names are permitted,
26262 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
26264 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
26267 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
26268 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26269 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26271 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26272 The value of this option must be either the
26274 or the absolute path to
26275 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
26276 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
26278 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
26279 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
26280 is taken as empty and an explicit location
26283 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
26284 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
26286 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
26288 either by file or directory
26289 are added to those given by the system default location.
26291 The values of &$host$& and
26292 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26293 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26295 For back-compatibility,
26296 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
26297 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
26298 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
26301 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26302 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26303 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26304 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26305 certificate verification must succeed.
26306 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26307 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
26308 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
26309 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
26310 that connections use TLS.
26311 Fallback to in-clear communication will be done unless restricted by
26312 the &%hosts_require_tls%& option.
26314 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer&!! -1
26315 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
26316 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
26317 If built with internationalization support,
26318 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
26320 If, after expansion, the value is 1, 0, or -1 then this value overrides
26321 any value previously set for the message. Otherwise, any previously
26322 set value is used. To permit use of a previous value,
26323 set this option to an empty string.
26324 For details on the values see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
26329 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
26331 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26332 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
26333 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
26334 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
26335 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
26338 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
26339 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
26340 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
26341 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
26344 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
26345 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
26346 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
26348 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
26349 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
26350 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
26351 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
26352 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
26354 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
26355 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
26356 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
26357 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
26358 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
26359 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
26360 see below for an exception).
26362 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
26363 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
26364 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
26365 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
26366 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
26368 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
26369 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
26370 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
26371 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
26372 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
26373 reached their retry times.
26375 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
26376 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
26377 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
26378 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
26379 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
26380 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
26381 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
26382 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
26383 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
26384 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
26387 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
26388 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
26389 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
26390 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
26391 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
26392 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
26394 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
26395 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
26396 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
26397 possible IP addresses have been tried.
26398 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
26399 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
26405 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26406 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26408 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
26409 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
26410 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
26411 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
26412 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
26413 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
26415 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
26416 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
26417 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26418 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
26419 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
26420 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
26421 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
26423 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
26424 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
26425 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
26426 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
26429 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
26430 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
26431 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
26432 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
26434 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
26435 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
26436 facility; you do not have to use it.
26438 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
26439 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
26440 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
26441 address to which it applies.
26443 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
26444 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
26445 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
26446 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
26447 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
26448 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
26451 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
26452 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
26453 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
26454 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
26457 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
26458 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
26459 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
26460 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
26461 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
26464 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
26465 illustrated by these examples:
26468 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
26469 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
26470 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
26471 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
26473 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
26474 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
26479 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
26480 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
26481 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
26482 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
26483 message's processing.
26485 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26486 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
26487 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&), but no
26488 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
26489 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
26490 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
26491 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
26492 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
26493 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
26495 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26496 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26497 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
26498 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
26499 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
26500 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
26501 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
26502 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
26503 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
26504 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
26506 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
26507 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
26508 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
26509 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
26510 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
26511 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
26513 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
26514 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
26515 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
26517 .cindex "envelope from"
26518 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
26519 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
26520 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
26521 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
26522 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
26523 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
26524 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
26525 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
26526 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
26528 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
26529 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
26535 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
26536 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
26537 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
26538 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
26539 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
26540 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
26541 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
26542 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
26543 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
26544 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
26546 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
26548 might produce the output
26550 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26551 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26552 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26553 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26554 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26555 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26556 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26557 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26559 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
26560 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
26561 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
26562 set for a particular transport.
26565 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
26566 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
26567 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
26570 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
26572 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
26573 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
26574 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
26575 any colons must be doubled, of course).
26577 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
26578 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
26579 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
26580 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
26583 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
26584 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
26585 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
26587 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
26588 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
26589 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
26590 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
26591 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
26592 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
26593 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
26595 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26596 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26597 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
26598 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
26599 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
26603 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
26604 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26607 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
26608 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
26609 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
26610 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
26611 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
26612 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
26613 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
26614 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
26615 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
26617 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
26618 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
26619 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
26621 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
26622 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
26623 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
26624 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
26625 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
26626 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
26627 of pattern they are set as follows:
26630 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
26631 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
26632 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
26635 *queen@*.fict.example
26637 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
26639 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
26643 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
26644 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
26647 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
26648 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
26649 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
26650 rewriting rule of the form
26652 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
26654 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
26660 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
26661 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
26662 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
26663 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
26664 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
26668 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
26669 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
26670 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
26671 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
26672 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
26674 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
26676 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
26679 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26680 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26681 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
26682 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
26683 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26684 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
26685 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
26686 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
26687 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
26688 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
26689 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
26690 entry written to the panic log.
26694 .subsection "Rewriting flags" "SSECID153"
26695 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
26698 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
26701 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
26703 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
26706 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
26707 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
26711 .subsection "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
26713 .cindex rewriting flags
26714 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
26715 &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
26716 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
26717 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
26718 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
26720 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
26721 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
26722 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
26723 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
26724 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
26725 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
26726 &`h`& rewrite all headers
26727 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
26728 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
26729 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
26731 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
26732 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
26733 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
26735 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
26736 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
26739 .subsection "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" SSECTrewriteS
26740 .cindex SMTP "rewriting malformed addresses"
26741 .cindex RCPT "rewriting argument of"
26742 .cindex MAIL "rewriting argument of"
26743 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
26744 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
26745 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
26746 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
26747 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
26749 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26750 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26751 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
26752 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
26753 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
26754 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
26755 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
26756 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
26759 .subsection "Flags controlling the rewriting process" SSECID155
26760 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
26761 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
26762 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
26765 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
26766 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
26767 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
26769 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
26770 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
26771 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
26772 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
26774 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
26775 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
26776 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
26778 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
26779 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
26780 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
26781 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
26783 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
26787 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
26790 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
26791 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
26792 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
26793 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
26794 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
26795 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
26796 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
26797 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
26799 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
26800 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
26804 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
26805 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
26807 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
26808 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
26809 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
26811 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
26812 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
26813 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
26814 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
26815 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
26816 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
26817 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
26818 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
26820 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
26821 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
26823 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
26825 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
26826 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
26828 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
26829 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
26830 messages that originate outside the local host:
26832 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
26833 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
26835 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
26838 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
26839 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
26840 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
26841 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
26842 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
26843 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
26844 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
26845 components. For example, the rule
26847 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
26849 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
26850 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
26851 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
26852 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
26853 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
26854 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
26855 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
26862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26863 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26865 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
26866 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
26867 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
26868 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
26869 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
26870 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
26871 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
26872 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
26873 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
26874 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
26875 address, domain and error.
26877 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
26878 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
26879 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
26880 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
26881 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
26882 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
26883 log selector is set, the message
26884 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
26885 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
26886 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
26887 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
26889 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
26890 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
26891 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
26892 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
26893 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
26894 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
26895 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
26896 domain are maintained independently.
26898 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
26899 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
26900 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
26901 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
26902 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
26903 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
26904 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
26905 the local address is reached.
26907 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
26908 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
26909 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
26910 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
26911 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
26913 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
26914 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
26915 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
26916 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
26917 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
26918 messages that it should now be retaining.
26922 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
26923 .cindex "retry" "rules"
26924 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
26925 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
26926 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
26927 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
26928 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
26929 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
26930 message's sender, respectively.
26933 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
26934 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
26935 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
26936 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
26937 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
26938 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
26941 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26943 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
26946 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26948 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
26949 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
26952 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
26953 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
26954 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
26955 expressions work in address lists.
26957 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
26958 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
26962 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
26963 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
26964 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
26965 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
26966 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
26967 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
26968 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
26969 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
26970 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
26972 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
26973 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
26974 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
26975 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
26978 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
26979 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
26980 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
26981 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
26982 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
26983 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
26984 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
26985 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
26986 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
26987 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
26992 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
26994 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
26995 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
26996 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
26997 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
26998 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
26999 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
27001 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
27005 and the retry rules are
27007 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
27008 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
27010 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
27011 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
27012 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
27013 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
27014 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
27015 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
27017 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
27018 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
27019 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
27020 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
27022 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
27023 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
27024 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
27026 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
27028 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
27029 textual form of the IP address.
27031 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
27032 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
27033 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
27034 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
27037 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
27038 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
27039 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
27041 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
27042 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
27043 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
27045 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
27046 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
27048 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
27049 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
27052 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
27053 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
27054 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
27055 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
27056 retry rule of this form:
27058 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
27060 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
27061 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
27064 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
27065 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
27066 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
27067 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
27070 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
27071 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
27072 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
27073 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
27074 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
27076 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
27077 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
27079 .vitem &%refused_A%&
27080 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
27083 A connection was refused.
27085 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
27086 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
27088 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
27089 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
27091 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
27092 A connection attempt timed out.
27094 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
27095 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
27096 obtained from an MX record.
27098 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
27099 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
27100 obtained from an MX record.
27103 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
27105 .vitem &%tls_required%&
27106 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
27107 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
27108 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
27111 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27114 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
27115 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
27116 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
27117 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27118 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
27119 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
27123 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
27124 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
27125 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
27126 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
27127 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
27131 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
27132 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
27133 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
27135 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
27136 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
27137 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
27138 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
27139 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
27140 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
27141 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
27143 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
27144 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
27147 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
27148 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
27149 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
27154 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
27155 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
27156 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
27157 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
27158 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
27161 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
27163 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
27165 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
27167 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
27168 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
27171 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
27173 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
27174 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
27175 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
27176 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
27177 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
27179 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
27180 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
27182 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
27184 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
27185 list is never matched.
27191 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
27192 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
27193 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
27194 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
27196 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
27198 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
27199 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
27200 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
27201 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
27202 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
27204 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
27205 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
27206 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
27207 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
27208 The available algorithms are:
27211 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
27214 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
27215 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
27216 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
27218 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
27219 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
27220 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
27221 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
27222 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
27223 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
27224 queue processing times.
27227 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
27228 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
27229 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
27230 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
27231 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
27232 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
27233 interval is found. The main configuration variable
27234 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
27235 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
27236 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
27237 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
27238 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
27240 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
27241 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
27242 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
27243 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
27244 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
27245 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
27248 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
27249 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
27250 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
27251 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
27252 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
27253 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
27254 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
27255 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
27256 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
27257 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
27258 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
27259 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
27261 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
27262 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
27263 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
27264 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
27265 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
27266 deliveries that have been deferred.
27269 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
27270 Here are some example retry rules:
27272 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
27273 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
27274 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
27275 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27276 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
27277 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
27279 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
27280 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
27281 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
27282 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
27283 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
27284 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
27285 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
27288 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
27289 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
27290 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
27291 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
27292 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
27294 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
27295 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
27296 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
27297 were not obtained from an MX record.
27299 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
27300 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
27301 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
27302 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
27303 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
27307 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
27308 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
27309 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
27310 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
27311 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
27312 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
27313 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
27314 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
27315 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
27316 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
27317 failing for the first time.
27319 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
27320 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
27321 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
27322 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
27324 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
27325 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
27326 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
27331 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
27332 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
27333 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
27334 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
27335 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
27336 default retry rule:
27338 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
27340 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
27341 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
27342 failure for the recipient address that counts.
27344 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
27345 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
27346 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
27347 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
27348 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
27350 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
27351 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
27352 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
27354 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
27355 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
27356 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
27357 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
27358 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
27359 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
27360 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
27361 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
27362 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
27363 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
27364 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
27366 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
27367 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
27368 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
27369 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
27370 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
27373 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
27374 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
27375 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
27376 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
27377 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
27378 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
27379 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
27380 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
27381 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
27384 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
27385 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
27386 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
27387 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
27388 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
27389 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
27390 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
27391 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
27394 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
27395 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
27396 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
27397 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
27398 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
27399 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
27400 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
27401 time out the address.
27403 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
27404 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
27405 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
27406 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
27407 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
27408 considered immediately.
27409 .ecindex IIDretconf1
27410 .ecindex IIDregconf2
27417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27420 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
27421 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
27422 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
27423 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
27424 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
27425 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
27426 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
27427 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
27428 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
27431 The name of an authenticator is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
27432 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
27435 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
27436 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
27437 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
27440 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
27441 the client's EHLO command.
27443 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
27444 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
27446 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
27447 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
27448 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
27449 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
27450 with the AUTH command.
27452 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
27454 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
27455 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
27456 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27459 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
27460 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
27461 unauthenticated connection.
27464 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
27465 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
27466 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
27467 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
27469 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
27470 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
27471 &`Connected to server.example.`&
27472 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
27473 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
27474 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
27475 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
27476 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
27481 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
27482 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
27483 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
27484 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
27485 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
27486 included by setting
27489 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
27493 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
27498 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
27499 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
27500 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
27501 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
27502 work via a socket interface.
27503 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
27504 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
27505 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
27506 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
27507 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
27508 supporting setting a server keytab.
27509 The seventh can be configured to support
27510 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
27511 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
27512 The eighth authenticator
27513 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
27514 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
27515 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
27517 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
27518 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
27519 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
27520 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
27521 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
27522 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
27523 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
27525 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
27526 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
27527 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
27528 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
27529 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
27530 both sets of options, is required. For example:
27534 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27535 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
27537 client_secret = secret2
27539 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
27540 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
27542 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
27543 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
27544 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
27547 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
27548 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
27549 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
27550 authenticating data.
27552 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
27553 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
27554 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
27555 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
27556 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
27557 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
27558 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
27559 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
27560 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
27561 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
27564 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
27565 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
27566 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
27567 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
27571 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
27572 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
27573 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
27575 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27576 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
27577 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
27578 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
27579 encrypted by a setting such as:
27581 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27585 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27586 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
27587 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
27588 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
27591 .option driver authenticators string unset
27592 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
27593 authenticators is to be used.
27596 .option public_name authenticators string unset
27597 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
27598 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
27599 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
27600 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
27601 defaults to the driver's instance name.
27604 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27605 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
27606 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
27607 mechanism is not advertised.
27608 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
27609 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
27610 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
27613 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27614 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
27615 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
27618 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
27619 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
27621 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
27622 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
27623 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
27624 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
27625 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
27626 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
27627 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27628 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
27629 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
27633 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
27634 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
27635 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
27636 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
27637 out the values of variables.
27638 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
27639 output, and Exim carries on processing.
27642 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27643 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27644 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
27645 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
27646 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
27647 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
27648 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
27649 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
27650 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
27651 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
27652 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
27653 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
27656 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27657 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
27658 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
27659 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
27660 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
27661 remembered for later use.
27662 How it is used is described in the following section.
27668 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
27669 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
27670 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27671 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
27672 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
27676 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
27677 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
27679 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
27681 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
27682 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
27683 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
27684 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
27685 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
27686 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
27687 given for the MAIL command.
27689 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
27690 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
27693 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
27694 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
27695 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
27696 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
27697 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
27698 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
27699 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
27704 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
27705 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
27706 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
27707 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
27709 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
27710 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
27711 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
27712 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
27713 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
27718 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
27719 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
27720 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
27721 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
27725 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
27727 If the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
27728 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
27731 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
27732 the mechanisms are advertised.
27734 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
27735 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
27736 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
27737 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
27738 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
27739 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
27740 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
27742 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
27744 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
27746 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
27747 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
27748 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
27751 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
27753 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27754 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
27755 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
27757 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
27758 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
27759 command. This is the case if
27762 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
27764 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
27766 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
27767 server authenticators.
27771 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
27772 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
27773 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
27775 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
27776 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
27777 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
27778 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
27779 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
27780 rejected with a 504 error.
27782 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
27783 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
27784 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
27785 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
27786 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
27787 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
27788 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
27789 no successful authentication.
27791 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
27792 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
27793 &%authresults%& expansion item.
27795 .cindex authentication "failure event, server"
27796 If an authenticator is run and does not succeed,
27797 an event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "auth:fail" is raised.
27798 While the event is being processed the variables
27799 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
27800 and &$authenticated_fail_id$& (as set by the authenticator &%server_set_id%& option)
27802 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged
27803 instead of the default log line.
27804 See <<CHAPevents>> for details on events.
27807 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
27808 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
27809 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
27810 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
27811 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
27812 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
27813 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
27817 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
27819 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
27820 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
27821 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
27822 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
27823 command line to run this script on such data might be
27825 encode '\0user\0password'
27827 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
27828 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
27829 whose code value is zero.
27831 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
27832 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
27833 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
27834 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
27836 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
27837 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
27838 example, a command such as
27840 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
27842 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
27844 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to produce
27845 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
27847 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
27849 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
27850 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
27851 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
27852 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
27856 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
27857 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
27858 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
27859 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
27860 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
27861 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
27864 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
27865 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
27866 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
27867 of the authenticator.
27870 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27871 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
27872 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
27873 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
27874 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
27875 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
27876 delivery to be deferred.
27878 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
27879 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
27880 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
27884 .cindex authentication "failure event, client"
27885 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code),
27886 an event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "auth:fail" is raised.
27887 While the event is being processed the variable
27888 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
27890 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged.
27891 See <<CHAPevents>> for details on events.
27894 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
27895 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
27896 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
27897 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
27898 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
27899 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
27900 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
27901 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
27902 deliver the message unauthenticated.
27905 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
27906 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
27907 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
27908 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
27909 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
27910 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
27911 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
27912 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
27914 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
27916 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27917 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
27918 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
27919 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
27920 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
27921 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
27922 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
27923 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
27924 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
27925 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
27926 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
27927 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
27928 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
27935 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27936 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27938 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
27939 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
27940 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
27941 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
27942 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
27943 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
27944 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
27945 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
27946 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
27947 connections as you do for login accounts.
27949 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
27950 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
27951 TLS is not being used:
27953 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
27954 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
27957 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
27958 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
27959 (including their names) have been properly verified.
27961 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
27962 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
27963 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
27965 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27966 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
27967 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
27969 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
27970 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
27971 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
27974 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
27975 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27976 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27977 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27978 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27979 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27980 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27982 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
27983 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27984 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27985 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
27986 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
27987 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
27988 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
27990 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
27991 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
27992 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27993 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27995 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
27996 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
27997 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
27999 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28000 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
28001 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28002 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28003 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28004 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28005 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28006 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28007 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28008 string as the error text.
28010 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
28011 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
28012 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
28016 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
28017 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
28018 .cindex authentication PLAIN
28019 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28020 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
28021 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
28022 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
28023 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
28025 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
28026 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
28027 configured as follows:
28031 public_name = PLAIN
28033 server_condition = \
28034 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
28035 server_set_id = $auth2
28037 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
28038 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
28039 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
28040 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
28042 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
28043 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
28044 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
28045 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
28049 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
28051 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
28053 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
28054 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
28058 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
28059 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
28061 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
28062 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
28063 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
28064 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
28065 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
28067 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
28068 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
28069 authenticating clients it could make sense.
28071 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
28072 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
28073 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
28074 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
28075 This is an incorrect example:
28077 server_condition = \
28078 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
28080 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
28081 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
28082 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
28083 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
28084 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
28085 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
28086 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
28088 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
28089 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
28091 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
28092 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
28093 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
28094 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
28095 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
28098 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
28099 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
28100 .cindex authentication LOGIN
28101 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
28102 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
28103 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
28104 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
28108 public_name = LOGIN
28109 server_prompts = User Name : Password
28110 server_condition = \
28111 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
28112 server_set_id = $auth1
28114 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
28115 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
28116 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
28117 strings are used to obtain two data items.
28119 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
28120 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
28121 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
28122 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
28123 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
28127 public_name = LOGIN
28128 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
28129 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
28132 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
28133 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
28134 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
28135 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
28137 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
28138 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
28139 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
28140 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
28141 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
28142 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
28143 uninterpreted string.
28146 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
28147 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
28148 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
28149 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
28150 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
28156 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
28157 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
28158 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
28160 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
28161 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
28162 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
28163 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
28166 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
28167 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
28168 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
28169 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
28170 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
28171 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
28172 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
28173 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
28174 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
28175 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
28176 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
28177 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
28179 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
28180 splitting takes priority and happens first.
28182 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
28183 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
28184 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
28185 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
28188 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
28189 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
28193 public_name = PLAIN
28194 client_send = ^username^mysecret
28196 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
28197 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs.
28198 Note that due to the ambiguity of parsing three consectutive circumflex characters
28199 there is no way to provide a password having a leading circumflex.
28203 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
28207 public_name = LOGIN
28208 client_send = : username : mysecret
28210 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
28211 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
28213 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
28214 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
28219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28220 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28222 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
28223 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28224 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
28225 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
28226 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
28227 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
28228 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
28229 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
28230 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
28231 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
28232 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
28233 available in plain text at either end.
28236 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
28237 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
28238 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
28239 authenticator as a server:
28241 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28242 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28243 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
28244 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
28245 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
28246 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
28247 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
28248 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
28249 returned to the client.
28251 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
28252 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
28253 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
28254 numeric variables for other things.
28256 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
28257 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
28258 user name, authentication fails.
28262 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28263 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
28264 server_set_id = $auth1
28266 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28267 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
28268 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
28269 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
28273 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28274 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
28276 server_set_id = $auth1
28278 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
28279 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
28281 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
28282 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
28283 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
28288 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28289 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
28290 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28291 server_set_id = $auth1
28294 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
28295 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
28296 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
28300 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
28301 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
28302 computing the response to the server's challenge.
28305 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28306 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
28307 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
28311 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28312 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
28313 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
28314 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
28315 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
28316 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
28317 send the message to the current server.
28319 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
28324 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28326 client_secret = secret
28328 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
28329 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
28333 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28334 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28336 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
28337 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
28338 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
28339 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
28341 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
28342 at A L Digital Ltd.
28344 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
28345 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
28346 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
28347 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
28348 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
28350 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
28351 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
28352 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
28353 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
28355 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
28356 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
28357 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
28358 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
28359 depending on the driver you are using.
28361 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
28362 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
28363 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
28364 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
28365 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
28368 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
28369 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
28370 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
28371 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
28372 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
28373 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
28374 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
28375 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
28378 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
28379 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
28380 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
28381 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
28382 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
28383 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
28387 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
28388 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28389 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
28390 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
28393 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
28394 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28395 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28396 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28400 driver = cyrus_sasl
28401 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28402 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28403 server_set_id = $auth1
28406 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
28407 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28410 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
28411 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28414 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
28415 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
28416 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
28417 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
28420 driver = cyrus_sasl
28421 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28422 server_set_id = $auth1
28425 driver = cyrus_sasl
28426 public_name = PLAIN
28427 server_set_id = $auth2
28429 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
28430 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
28431 but it is present in many binary distributions.
28432 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
28433 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
28438 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28440 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
28441 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
28442 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
28443 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
28444 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
28445 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
28446 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
28447 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
28448 authenticator only. There is only one non-generic option:
28450 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
28452 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
28453 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
28454 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
28455 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
28459 public_name = PLAIN
28460 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher}
28461 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28462 server_set_id = $auth1
28467 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28468 server_set_id = $auth1
28471 &*Note*&: plaintext authentication methods such as PLAIN and LOGIN
28472 should not be advertised on cleartext SMTP connections.
28473 See the discussion in section &<<SECTplain_TLS>>&.
28475 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
28476 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
28477 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
28478 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
28479 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
28480 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
28482 The Dovecot configuration to match the above will look
28485 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
28490 unix_listener auth-client {
28497 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
28499 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
28502 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
28503 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
28506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28507 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28508 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
28509 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
28510 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
28511 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
28512 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
28513 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28514 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28515 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
28516 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
28517 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
28518 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
28519 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
28520 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
28521 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
28522 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
28523 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
28524 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
28525 without code changes in Exim.
28527 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
28528 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
28529 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
28532 To see the list of mechanisms supported by the library run Exim with "auth" debug
28533 enabled and look for a line containing "GNU SASL supports".
28534 Note however that some may not have been tested from Exim.
28537 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
28538 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
28539 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
28540 by &%client_username%& option.
28541 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
28542 which is the common case.
28544 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28545 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
28547 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
28548 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28549 the password to be used, in clear.
28551 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
28552 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28553 the account name to be used.
28556 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
28557 This option is only supported for library versions 1.9.1 and greater.
28558 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY will be defined when this is so.
28560 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
28561 and correctly sized
28562 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
28563 The value after expansion should be
28564 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
28565 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
28567 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
28568 supplied by the server.
28569 The option is expanded before use.
28570 During the expansion &$auth1$& is set with the client username,
28571 &$auth2$& with the iteration count, and
28572 &$auth3$& with the salt.
28574 The intent of this option
28575 is to support clients that can cache thes salted password
28576 to save on recalculation costs.
28577 The cache lookup should return an unusable value
28578 (eg. an empty string)
28579 if the salt or iteration count has changed
28581 If the authentication succeeds then the above variables are set,
28582 .vindex "&$auth4$&"
28583 plus the calculated salted password value value in &$auth4$&,
28584 during the expansion of the &%client_set_id%& option.
28585 A side-effect of this expansion can be used to prime the cache.
28588 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28589 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
28590 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
28591 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
28592 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
28595 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
28596 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
28597 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
28600 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
28601 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
28602 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
28604 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
28605 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
28606 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
28608 . However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
28609 . Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
28610 . with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
28612 This option was deprecated in previous releases due to doubts over
28613 the "Triple Handshake" vulnerability.
28614 Exim takes suitable precausions (requiring Extended Master Secret if TLS
28615 Session Resumption was used) for safety.
28618 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
28619 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28620 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28621 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28624 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
28625 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28626 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28627 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28632 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28633 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28634 server_set_id = $auth1
28638 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
28639 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
28640 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
28641 the password itself.
28643 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
28644 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
28645 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
28646 if available, else the empty string.
28647 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
28648 else the empty string.
28650 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
28652 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
28653 option to be simply "true".
28656 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
28657 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28658 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28661 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
28662 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28663 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28664 when this option is expanded.
28666 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
28667 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
28668 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
28669 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
28670 either the iteration count or the salt).
28671 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
28672 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
28674 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
28675 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28676 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28677 when this option is expanded.
28678 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
28679 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
28680 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
28681 protocol conversation.
28684 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
28685 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
28686 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
28687 to provide stored information related to a password,
28688 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
28690 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
28691 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
28693 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
28694 When this is so, the macros
28695 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
28696 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
28699 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
28701 If set, the results of expansion should for each
28702 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
28703 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
28704 &%server_password%& option.
28705 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
28707 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
28708 to generate these values.
28711 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
28712 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28713 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28716 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
28717 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28718 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
28719 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
28721 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
28722 meanings for these variables:
28725 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28726 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
28728 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28729 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
28731 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
28732 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
28735 On a per-mechanism basis:
28738 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28739 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
28740 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28742 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28743 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
28744 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28746 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28747 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
28748 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
28749 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28752 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
28753 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
28754 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
28757 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
28758 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
28760 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
28762 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28763 server_realm = imap.example.org
28764 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
28765 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28766 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
28767 server_condition = yes
28771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28774 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
28775 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
28776 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
28777 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28778 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
28779 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
28780 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
28783 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
28784 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
28785 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
28786 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28788 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
28789 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
28790 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
28791 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
28793 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
28794 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
28795 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
28799 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
28800 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
28801 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
28802 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
28804 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
28805 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
28806 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
28807 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
28809 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28811 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28812 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
28814 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28815 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
28816 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
28821 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28822 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28824 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
28825 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
28826 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
28827 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
28828 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
28829 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
28830 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
28831 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
28832 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
28833 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
28834 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
28835 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
28836 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
28840 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
28841 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
28843 The server sends back a challenge.
28845 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
28846 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
28849 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
28853 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
28854 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
28855 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
28857 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
28858 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
28859 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
28860 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
28861 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
28862 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
28863 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
28864 for other things. For example:
28869 server_password = \
28870 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
28872 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28873 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28879 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
28880 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
28881 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
28885 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
28886 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
28889 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
28890 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
28893 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
28894 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
28895 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
28901 client_username = msn/msn_username
28902 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
28903 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
28905 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
28906 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
28912 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28913 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28915 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
28916 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
28917 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
28918 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28919 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
28920 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28921 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
28922 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
28923 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
28924 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
28925 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
28926 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
28927 by the server configuration.
28929 The client presents an identity in-clear.
28930 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
28931 and for clients to only attempt,
28932 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
28934 One possible use, compatible with the
28935 K-9 Mail Android client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
28936 is for using X509 client certificates.
28938 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
28939 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
28940 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
28941 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
28942 client certificates only.
28944 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
28945 client-certificate authentication is being done.
28947 The client must present a certificate,
28948 for which it must have been requested via the
28949 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28950 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28951 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
28952 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
28954 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
28955 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
28956 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
28958 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
28959 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
28960 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28961 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
28962 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
28963 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28964 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28966 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
28968 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
28969 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28970 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28971 "in &(external)& authenticator"
28972 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28973 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28975 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
28976 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28977 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28978 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
28979 an identity for authentication and
28980 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
28982 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
28983 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
28984 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28985 string expansions that also use them for other things.
28987 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28988 Once an identity has been received,
28989 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28990 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28991 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28992 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28993 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28994 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28995 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28996 string as the error text.
29000 ext_ccert_san_mail:
29002 public_name = EXTERNAL
29004 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
29005 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29006 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29007 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
29008 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
29009 server_set_id = $auth1
29011 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29012 of your configured trust-anchors
29013 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29014 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
29016 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
29017 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29018 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29022 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
29023 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
29024 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
29026 .option client_send external string&!! unset
29027 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
29028 identity being asserted.
29034 public_name = EXTERNAL
29036 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
29037 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
29041 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
29042 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
29048 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29049 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29051 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
29052 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
29053 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
29054 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29055 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29056 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29057 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
29058 authentication based on client certificates.
29060 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
29061 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
29062 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
29063 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
29064 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
29065 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
29067 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
29068 for which it must have been requested via the
29069 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29070 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29072 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
29073 run immediately after a TLS connection being negotiated
29074 (due to either STARTTLS or TLS-on-connect)
29075 and can authenticate the connection.
29076 If it does, SMTP authentication is not subsequently offered.
29078 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
29081 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
29082 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
29084 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
29085 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
29086 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
29087 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
29088 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29089 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29091 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
29092 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
29093 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
29095 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
29102 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29103 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29104 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
29107 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
29108 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
29109 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
29111 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
29113 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29114 of your configured trust-anchors
29115 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29116 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
29118 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
29119 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29120 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29122 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
29124 . An alternative might use
29126 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
29128 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
29129 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
29130 . This would help for per-device use.
29132 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
29133 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
29135 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
29136 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
29139 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
29140 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
29141 a connect- or helo-ACL.
29145 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29146 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29148 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
29149 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
29150 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
29151 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
29152 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
29155 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
29156 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
29157 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
29158 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
29159 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
29160 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
29161 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
29162 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
29163 certificates are used.
29165 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
29166 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
29167 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
29168 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
29169 between them is encrypted.
29171 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
29172 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
29173 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
29174 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
29177 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
29178 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
29179 in order to get TLS to work.
29183 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
29185 .cindex "submissions protocol"
29186 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
29187 .cindex "smtps protocol"
29188 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
29189 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
29190 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
29191 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
29192 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
29193 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
29194 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
29195 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
29197 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
29198 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
29199 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
29201 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
29202 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
29203 reassigned for other use.
29204 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
29206 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
29207 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
29208 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
29210 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
29211 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
29212 the most common use is expected to be:
29214 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
29216 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
29217 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
29218 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
29219 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
29220 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
29223 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
29224 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
29231 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
29232 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
29233 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
29234 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
29240 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
29246 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
29247 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
29249 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
29252 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
29253 cannot be the path of a directory
29254 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
29255 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
29257 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
29259 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29260 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
29261 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
29262 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
29263 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
29265 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
29266 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
29267 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
29268 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
29269 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
29270 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
29271 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
29274 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
29275 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
29277 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
29278 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
29279 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
29280 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
29282 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option,
29283 it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
29285 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
29286 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
29287 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
29288 implementation, then patches are welcome.
29290 The output from "exim -bV" will show which (if any) support was included
29292 Also, the macro "_HAVE_OPENSSL" or "_HAVE_GNUTLS" will be defined.
29296 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
29297 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
29298 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
29299 but not the chosen filename.
29300 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
29301 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
29303 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
29304 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
29305 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
29306 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
29308 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
29309 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
29310 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
29311 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
29312 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
29313 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
29314 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
29316 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
29317 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
29318 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
29319 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
29320 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
29322 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
29323 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
29324 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
29325 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
29326 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
29327 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
29329 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
29330 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
29331 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
29333 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
29334 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
29335 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
29336 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
29339 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
29342 # chown exim:exim new-params
29343 # chmod 0600 new-params
29344 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
29345 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
29346 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
29347 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
29348 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
29349 # chmod 0400 new-params
29350 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
29352 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
29353 stalling is removed.
29355 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
29356 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
29357 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
29358 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
29359 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
29360 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
29361 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
29362 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
29363 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
29364 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
29365 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
29367 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
29368 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
29369 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
29370 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
29372 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
29373 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
29374 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
29375 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
29376 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
29379 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
29380 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
29381 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
29382 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
29383 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
29384 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
29385 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
29386 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
29387 directly to this function call.
29388 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
29389 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
29390 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
29391 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
29394 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
29396 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
29397 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
29398 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
29401 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
29402 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
29403 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
29407 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
29410 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
29411 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
29414 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
29415 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
29417 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
29418 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
29421 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
29422 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
29423 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
29424 not be moved to the end of the list.
29427 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
29430 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
29431 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
29434 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29435 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
29436 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
29437 choice of clients used:
29439 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
29440 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29445 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
29447 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
29450 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
29451 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
29452 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
29453 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
29455 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
29457 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
29461 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
29463 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
29464 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
29465 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
29466 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
29467 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
29468 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
29469 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
29470 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
29471 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
29472 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
29474 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
29475 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
29477 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
29478 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
29479 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
29480 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
29481 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
29482 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
29484 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
29485 "Priority strings". This is online as
29486 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
29487 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
29488 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
29489 then the example code
29490 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
29491 on that site can be used to test a given string.
29495 # Disable older versions of protocols
29496 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
29499 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
29500 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
29501 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
29503 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29504 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
29505 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
29506 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
29510 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29516 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
29517 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
29518 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29519 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
29520 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
29521 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
29522 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
29523 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
29525 If STARTTLS is to be used you
29526 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
29528 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
29529 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
29530 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
29533 554 Security failure
29535 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
29536 rejected with a 554 error code.
29538 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
29539 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
29541 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
29542 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
29543 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
29544 from someone able to intercept the communication.
29546 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
29548 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
29550 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
29551 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
29553 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
29554 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
29555 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
29556 that goes with it. These files need to be
29557 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
29558 always be given as full path names.
29559 The key must not be password-protected.
29560 They can be the same file if both the
29561 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
29562 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
29563 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
29564 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
29565 the server's certificate.
29567 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
29568 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
29569 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
29570 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
29571 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
29572 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
29574 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
29575 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
29576 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
29578 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
29579 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
29580 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
29583 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
29584 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
29585 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
29587 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
29589 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
29590 with the parameters contained in the file.
29591 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
29596 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
29597 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
29598 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
29599 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
29605 for a way of generating file data.
29607 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
29608 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
29609 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
29610 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
29611 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
29613 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29614 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29615 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
29616 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
29617 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
29618 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
29619 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
29620 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
29621 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
29623 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
29624 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
29625 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
29626 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
29627 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
29628 documentation for more details.
29630 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
29631 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
29634 .subsection "Requesting and verifying client certificates"
29635 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29636 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29637 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
29638 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
29639 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
29640 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
29641 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
29642 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
29643 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
29644 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
29645 an explicit file or,
29646 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
29647 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
29649 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
29652 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
29653 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
29654 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
29656 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
29658 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
29660 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
29661 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
29663 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
29664 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
29665 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
29666 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
29667 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
29668 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
29669 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
29670 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
29671 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
29672 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
29674 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29675 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
29676 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
29677 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
29679 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29680 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
29681 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
29682 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
29683 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
29684 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
29687 .subsection "Caching of static server configuration items" "SSECTserverTLScache"
29688 .cindex certificate caching
29689 .cindex privatekey caching
29690 .cindex crl caching
29691 .cindex ocsp caching
29692 .cindex ciphers caching
29693 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29694 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29695 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29696 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29697 .cindex tls_crl caching
29698 .cindex tls_ocsp_file caching
29699 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29700 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29701 .cindex caching certificate
29702 .cindex caching privatekey
29703 .cindex caching crl
29704 .cindex caching ocsp
29705 .cindex caching ciphers
29706 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29707 If any of the main configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&,
29708 &%tls_crl%& and &%tls_ocsp_file%& have values with no
29709 expandable elements,
29710 then the associated information is loaded at daemon startup.
29711 It is made available
29712 to child processes forked for handling received SMTP connections.
29714 This caching is currently only supported under Linux and FreeBSD.
29716 If caching is not possible, for example if an item has to be dependent
29717 on the peer host so contains a &$sender_host_name$& expansion, the load
29718 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29720 The cache is invalidated and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29721 containing files specified by these options.
29723 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29724 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29725 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29726 The latter case is not automatically invalidated;
29727 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29728 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29729 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29730 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29732 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29733 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
29735 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29736 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
29742 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
29743 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29744 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29745 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29746 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
29747 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
29748 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
29749 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
29750 within the &(smtp)& transport.
29752 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29753 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
29754 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
29755 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
29756 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
29757 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
29759 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
29760 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
29761 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
29762 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
29763 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
29766 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
29767 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
29768 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
29769 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
29770 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
29771 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
29772 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
29773 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
29774 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
29775 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
29778 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
29779 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
29781 This is an optional thing for TLS connections, although either end
29783 If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
29784 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
29786 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
29787 for client use (they are usable for server use).
29788 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
29789 in failed connections.
29791 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
29792 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
29794 the system default set (depending on library version),
29796 or (depending on library version) a directory.
29797 The client verifies the server's certificate
29798 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
29799 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
29800 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
29801 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
29803 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
29804 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
29805 or need not succeed respectively.
29807 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
29808 name checks are made on the server certificate.
29809 The match against this list is, as per other Exim usage, the
29810 IP for the host. That is most closely associated with the
29811 name on the DNS A (or AAAA) record for the host.
29812 However, the name that needs to be in the certificate
29813 is the one at the head of any CNAME chain leading to the A record.
29814 The option defaults to always checking.
29816 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
29817 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
29818 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
29820 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
29821 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
29822 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
29825 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
29826 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
29827 for OCSP to be relevant.
29830 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
29831 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
29832 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
29833 alternative hosts, if any.
29836 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
29837 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
29838 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
29842 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
29843 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
29844 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
29845 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
29846 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
29848 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
29849 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
29850 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
29851 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
29852 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
29853 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
29854 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
29855 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
29856 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
29857 outgoing connection.
29861 .subsection "Caching of static client configuration items" SECTclientTLScache
29862 .cindex certificate caching
29863 .cindex privatekey caching
29864 .cindex crl caching
29865 .cindex ciphers caching
29866 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29867 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29868 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29869 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29870 .cindex tls_crl caching
29871 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29872 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29873 .cindex caching certificate
29874 .cindex caching privatekey
29875 .cindex caching crl
29876 .cindex caching ciphers
29877 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29878 If any of the transport configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&
29879 and &%tls_crl%& have values with no
29880 expandable elements,
29881 then the associated information is loaded per smtp transport
29882 at daemon startup, at the start of a queue run, or on a
29883 command-line specified message delivery.
29884 It is made available
29885 to child processes forked for handling making SMTP connections.
29887 This caching is currently only supported under Linux.
29889 If caching is not possible, the load
29890 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29892 The cache is invalidated in the daemon
29893 and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29894 containing files specified by these options.
29896 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29897 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29898 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29899 The latter case is not automatically invaludated;
29900 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29901 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29902 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29903 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29905 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29906 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
29908 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29909 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
29915 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
29916 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
29919 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
29920 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
29921 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
29922 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
29923 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
29924 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
29925 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
29926 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
29929 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
29930 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
29933 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
29934 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
29935 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
29936 be of limited use in that environment.
29938 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
29939 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
29940 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
29941 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
29942 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
29944 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
29945 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
29946 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
29947 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
29948 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
29950 If DANE validated the connection attempt then the value of the &%tls_sni%& option
29951 is forced to the name of the destination host, after any MX- or CNAME-following.
29953 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
29954 received from a client.
29955 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
29957 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
29958 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
29959 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
29962 &%tls_certificate%&
29968 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29973 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
29974 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
29975 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
29976 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
29977 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
29978 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
29979 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
29981 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
29984 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
29985 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
29986 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
29987 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
29989 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
29990 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
29991 built, then you have SNI support).
29995 .cindex ALPN "general information"
29996 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
29997 There is a TLS feature related to SNI
29998 called Application Layer Protocol Name (ALPN).
29999 This is intended to declare, or select, what protocol layer will be using a TLS
30001 The client for the connection proposes a set of protocol names, and
30002 the server responds with a selected one.
30003 It is not, as of 2021, commonly used for SMTP connections.
30004 However, to guard against misdirected or malicious use of web clients
30005 (which often do use ALPN) against MTA ports, Exim by default check that
30006 there is no incompatible ALPN specified by a client for a TLS connection.
30007 If there is, the connection is rejected.
30009 As a client Exim does not supply ALPN by default.
30010 The behaviour of both client and server can be configured using the options
30011 &%tls_alpn%& and &%hosts_require_alpn%&.
30012 There are no variables providing observability.
30013 Some feature-specific logging may appear on denied connections, but this
30014 depends on the behaviour of the peer
30015 (not all peers can send a feature-specific TLS Alert).
30017 This feature is available when Exim is built with
30018 OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later or GnuTLS 3.2.0 or later;
30019 the macro _HAVE_TLS_ALPN will be defined when this is so.
30023 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
30025 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
30026 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
30027 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
30028 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
30029 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
30030 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
30031 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
30032 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
30033 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
30034 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
30036 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
30037 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
30038 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
30039 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
30040 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
30041 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
30042 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
30044 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
30045 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
30046 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
30047 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
30048 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
30049 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
30050 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
30051 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
30052 and delay other deliveries to that host.
30054 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
30055 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
30056 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
30057 information is recorded.
30059 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
30060 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
30061 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
30066 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
30067 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
30068 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
30069 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
30070 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
30071 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
30073 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
30074 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
30075 document is currently at
30077 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
30079 and their FAQ is at
30081 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
30084 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
30085 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
30087 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
30088 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
30089 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
30090 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
30093 .subsection "Certificate chains" SECID186
30094 A file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
30095 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
30096 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
30097 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
30098 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
30099 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
30100 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
30101 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
30102 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
30103 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
30104 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
30105 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
30107 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
30108 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
30109 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
30110 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
30114 .subsection "Self-signed certificates" SECID187
30115 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
30116 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
30117 with OpenSSL, like this:
30118 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
30119 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
30121 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
30124 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
30125 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
30126 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
30127 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
30128 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
30129 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
30130 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
30132 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
30133 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
30134 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
30135 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
30136 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
30137 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
30139 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
30140 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
30141 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
30142 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
30143 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
30144 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
30145 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
30146 be a sensible resolution).
30148 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
30149 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
30150 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
30152 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
30153 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
30154 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
30155 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
30156 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
30157 signed with that self-signed certificate.
30159 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
30160 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
30161 Open-source PKI book, available online at
30162 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
30165 .subsection "Revoked certificates"
30166 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
30167 .cindex "revocation list"
30168 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
30169 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
30170 There are three ways for a certificate to be made unusable
30174 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
30175 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
30176 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
30177 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
30178 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
30180 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
30181 file from every certificate authority they know of.
30184 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
30185 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
30186 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
30187 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
30188 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
30189 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
30191 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
30192 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
30193 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
30194 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
30197 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
30198 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
30199 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
30200 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
30201 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
30202 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
30203 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
30204 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
30206 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
30207 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
30208 support for OCSP stapling is included.
30210 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30211 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
30212 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
30213 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
30214 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
30216 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
30217 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
30218 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
30219 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
30220 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
30223 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
30224 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
30227 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
30228 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
30229 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
30230 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
30231 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
30232 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30234 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
30235 not any of the chain from CA to it.
30237 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
30240 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
30241 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
30242 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
30244 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
30245 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
30246 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
30251 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
30252 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
30255 .section "TLS Resumption" "SECTresumption"
30256 .cindex TLS resumption
30257 TLS Session Resumption for TLS 1.2 and TLS 1.3 connections can be used (defined
30258 in RFC 5077 for 1.2). The support for this requires GnuTLS 3.6.3 or OpenSSL 1.1.1
30261 Session resumption (this is the "stateless" variant) involves the server sending
30262 a "session ticket" to the client on one connection, which can be stored by the
30263 client and used for a later session. The ticket contains sufficient state for
30264 the server to reconstruct the TLS session, avoiding some expensive crypto
30265 calculation and (on TLS1.2) one full packet roundtrip time.
30268 Operational cost/benefit:
30270 The extra data being transmitted costs a minor amount, and the client has
30271 extra costs in storing and retrieving the data.
30273 In the Exim/Gnutls implementation the extra cost on an initial connection
30274 which is TLS1.2 over a loopback path is about 6ms on 2017-laptop class hardware.
30275 The saved cost on a subsequent connection is about 4ms; three or more
30276 connections become a net win. On longer network paths, two or more
30277 connections will have an average lower startup time thanks to the one
30278 saved packet roundtrip. TLS1.3 will save the crypto cpu costs but not any
30281 .cindex "hints database" tls
30282 Since a new hints DB is used on the TLS client,
30283 the hints DB maintenance should be updated to additionally handle "tls".
30288 The session ticket is encrypted, but is obviously an additional security
30289 vulnarability surface. An attacker able to decrypt it would have access
30290 all connections using the resumed session.
30291 The session ticket encryption key is not committed to storage by the server
30292 and is rotated regularly (OpenSSL: 1hr, and one previous key is used for
30293 overlap; GnuTLS 6hr but does not specify any overlap).
30294 Tickets have limited lifetime (2hr, and new ones issued after 1hr under
30295 OpenSSL. GnuTLS 2hr, appears to not do overlap).
30297 There is a question-mark over the security of the Diffie-Helman parameters
30298 used for session negotiation.
30303 The &%log_selector%& "tls_resumption" appends an asterisk to the tls_cipher "X="
30306 The variables &$tls_in_resumption$& and &$tls_out_resumption$&
30307 have bits 0-4 indicating respectively
30308 support built, client requested ticket, client offered session,
30309 server issued ticket, resume used. A suitable decode list is provided
30310 in the builtin macro _RESUME_DECODE for in &%listextract%& expansions.
30315 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& main option specifies a hostlist for which
30316 exim, operating as a server, will offer resumption to clients.
30317 Current best practice is to not offer the feature to MUA connection.
30318 Commonly this can be done like this:
30320 tls_resumption_hosts = ${if inlist {$received_port}{587:465} {:}{*}}
30322 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30323 is offered and/or accepted.
30325 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& smtp transport option performs the
30326 equivalent function for operation as a client.
30327 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30328 is attempted (if a stored session is available) or the information
30329 stored (if supplied by the peer).
30335 In a resumed session:
30337 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_cipher$& will have values different
30338 to the original (under GnuTLS).
30340 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_ocsp$& will be "not requested" or "no response",
30341 and the &%hosts_require_ocsp%& smtp trasnport option will fail.
30342 . XXX need to do something with that hosts_require_ocsp
30348 .section DANE "SECDANE"
30350 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
30351 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
30352 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
30353 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
30354 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
30355 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
30357 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
30358 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
30359 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
30361 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
30362 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
30364 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and communicate via side-channel) copies of server certificates
30365 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
30366 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
30368 DANE requires a server operator to do three things:
30370 Run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
30371 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
30372 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
30375 Add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
30377 Offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
30380 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
30381 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
30382 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
30383 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
30385 .subsection "DNS records"
30386 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
30387 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
30388 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
30389 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
30391 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
30392 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
30393 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
30394 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
30395 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
30396 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
30398 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
30399 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
30400 does require careful arrangement.
30401 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
30402 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
30403 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
30404 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
30405 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
30407 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
30408 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
30410 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
30411 "MTA-STS", described below.
30413 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
30414 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
30415 connections to you.
30416 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
30417 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
30418 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
30419 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
30420 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
30421 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
30423 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
30424 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
30425 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
30426 random serial numbers.
30427 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
30428 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
30429 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
30430 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
30432 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
30433 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
30435 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
30438 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
30439 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
30444 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
30446 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
30449 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
30452 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
30453 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
30456 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
30458 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
30459 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
30460 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
30461 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
30463 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
30464 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
30466 .subsection "Interaction with OCSP"
30467 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
30468 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
30469 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
30472 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
30473 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
30477 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
30478 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
30479 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
30480 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
30481 control the OCSP request.
30483 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
30484 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
30487 .subsection "Client configuration"
30488 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
30489 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
30490 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
30491 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
30492 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
30494 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
30496 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using DNSSEC.
30497 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
30498 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
30499 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
30501 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
30502 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
30503 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
30504 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
30505 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
30506 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
30507 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
30509 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
30513 tls_try_verify_hosts
30514 tls_verify_certificates
30516 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
30520 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
30521 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
30523 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
30524 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
30526 .subsection Observability
30527 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
30529 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
30530 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
30531 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
30532 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
30534 .cindex DANE reporting
30535 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
30536 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
30537 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
30538 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
30539 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
30540 Section 4.3 of that document.
30542 .subsection General
30543 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
30545 DANE is specified in RFC 6698. It decouples certificate authority trust
30546 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
30548 It does retain the need to trust the assurances provided by the DNSSEC tree.
30550 There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS (RFC 8461), which
30551 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website.
30552 The discovery of the address for that website does not (per standard)
30553 require DNSSEC, and could be regarded as being less secure than DANE
30556 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
30557 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
30558 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
30561 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
30562 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
30563 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
30565 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
30566 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
30567 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
30568 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
30569 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
30570 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
30571 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
30575 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30576 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30578 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
30579 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
30580 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
30581 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
30582 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
30583 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
30584 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
30585 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
30586 one very small ACL:
30590 accept hosts = one.host.only
30592 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
30593 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
30595 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
30596 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
30597 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
30598 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
30599 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
30600 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
30601 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
30602 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30605 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
30606 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
30607 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30610 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
30611 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
30612 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
30613 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
30614 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
30615 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30616 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
30617 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
30618 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30619 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30620 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
30621 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
30622 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30623 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
30624 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
30625 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
30626 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30627 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30628 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
30629 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30632 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
30633 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
30634 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
30635 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
30636 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
30637 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
30638 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
30639 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
30640 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
30641 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
30642 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
30643 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
30644 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
30645 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
30646 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
30647 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
30648 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
30649 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
30650 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
30651 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
30654 For example, if you set
30656 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
30658 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
30659 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
30660 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
30661 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
30662 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
30663 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
30664 testing as possible at RCPT time.
30667 .subsection "The non-SMTP ACLs" SECID190
30668 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30669 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
30670 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
30671 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
30672 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
30673 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
30674 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
30675 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
30676 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
30677 in any of these ACLs.
30679 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
30680 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
30681 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
30682 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
30683 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
30684 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
30685 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
30686 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
30688 control = suppress_local_fixups
30690 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
30691 run, it is too late.
30693 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30694 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30696 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
30697 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
30698 temporary error for these kinds of message.
30701 .subsection "The SMTP connect ACL" SECID191
30702 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30703 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
30704 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
30705 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
30706 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
30707 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
30708 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
30709 &%smtp_banner%& option.
30711 For tls-on-connect connections, the ACL is run before the TLS connection
30712 is accepted; if the ACL does not accept then the TCP connection is dropped without
30713 any TLS startup attempt and without any SMTP response being transmitted.
30716 .subsection "The EHLO/HELO ACL" SECID192
30717 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30718 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30719 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
30720 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
30721 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
30722 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
30723 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
30724 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
30726 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
30727 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
30728 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
30730 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
30731 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
30732 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
30733 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
30737 .subsection "The DATA ACLs" SECID193
30738 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30739 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
30740 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
30741 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
30742 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
30743 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
30744 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
30745 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
30746 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
30748 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
30749 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
30750 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
30751 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
30752 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
30753 associated with the DATA command.
30755 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
30756 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
30757 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
30758 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
30759 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
30760 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
30761 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
30762 the data specified is received.
30764 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
30765 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
30766 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
30767 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
30768 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
30771 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
30772 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
30773 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
30774 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
30776 .subsection "The SMTP DKIM ACL" SECTDKIMACL
30777 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
30778 enabled (which is the default).
30780 If, for a specific message, an ACL control
30781 &*dkim_disable_verify*&
30782 has been set, this &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is not called.
30784 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
30785 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
30786 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
30788 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30790 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30793 .subsection "The SMTP MIME ACL" SECID194
30794 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30795 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30797 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30800 .subsection "The SMTP PRDR ACL" SECTPRDRACL
30801 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30802 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
30803 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
30804 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
30805 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
30806 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
30809 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
30810 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
30811 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
30812 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
30813 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
30814 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
30815 for some or all recipients.
30817 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
30818 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
30819 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
30820 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
30821 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
30823 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
30824 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
30825 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
30827 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
30828 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
30830 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30831 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
30832 the feature was not requested by the client.
30834 .subsection "The QUIT ACL" SECTQUITACL
30835 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30836 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
30837 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
30838 does not in fact control any access.
30839 For this reason, it may only accept
30840 or warn as its final result.
30842 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
30843 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
30844 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
30845 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
30847 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
30848 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
30850 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
30851 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
30854 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
30855 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
30856 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
30857 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
30858 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
30861 .subsection "The not-QUIT ACL" SECTNOTQUITACL
30862 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
30863 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
30864 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
30865 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
30866 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
30867 situation even worse.
30869 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
30870 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
30871 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
30874 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
30875 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
30876 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
30877 connection. The possible values are:
30879 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
30880 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
30881 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
30882 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
30883 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
30884 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
30885 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
30886 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
30887 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
30888 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
30890 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
30891 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
30892 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
30893 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
30894 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
30898 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
30899 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
30900 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
30901 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
30903 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
30904 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
30906 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
30907 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
30908 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
30909 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
30910 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
30912 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
30913 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
30914 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
30917 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
30918 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
30919 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
30920 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
30921 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
30922 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
30924 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
30925 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
30926 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
30928 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
30929 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
30930 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
30931 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
30933 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
30934 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
30935 matches the string.
30937 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
30938 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
30939 want to have something like
30941 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
30943 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
30944 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
30950 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
30951 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
30952 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
30953 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
30954 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
30955 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
30956 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
30957 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
30958 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
30960 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
30961 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
30962 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
30965 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
30966 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
30967 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
30968 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
30970 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
30971 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
30972 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
30973 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
30974 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
30975 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
30976 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
30978 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
30979 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
30982 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
30983 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
30984 recipients; it may create new recipients.
30988 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
30989 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
30990 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
30991 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
30992 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
30993 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
30995 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
30996 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
30997 used to accept or reject anything.
30999 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
31000 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
31001 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
31002 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
31004 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
31005 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
31006 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
31007 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
31008 configuration file.
31013 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
31014 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
31016 .vindex &$local_part$&
31017 .vindex &$sender_address$&
31018 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
31019 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31020 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
31021 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
31022 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
31023 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
31024 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
31025 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31027 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
31028 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
31029 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
31032 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
31033 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
31034 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
31035 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
31036 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
31039 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
31040 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
31041 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
31042 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
31043 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
31044 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
31045 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
31046 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
31052 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
31053 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
31054 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
31055 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31056 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
31057 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
31058 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31059 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
31060 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
31061 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
31062 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
31063 unencrypted connections.
31066 accept encrypted = *
31067 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
31069 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
31071 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
31072 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
31073 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
31074 option to do this.)
31078 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
31079 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
31080 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
31081 An individual ACL definition consists of a number of statements.
31082 Each statement starts
31083 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
31084 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
31085 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
31087 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
31088 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
31089 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
31092 deny dnslists = list1.example
31093 dnslists = list2.example
31095 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
31096 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
31097 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
31098 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
31099 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
31101 The definition of an ACL ends where another starts,
31102 or a different configuration section starts.
31105 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
31106 The ACL verbs are as follows:
31109 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
31110 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
31111 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
31112 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
31113 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
31114 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
31115 check a RCPT command:
31117 accept domains = +local_domains
31121 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
31122 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
31123 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
31124 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
31127 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
31128 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
31129 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
31132 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
31133 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
31134 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
31135 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
31136 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
31137 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
31139 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
31140 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
31142 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
31143 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
31144 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
31146 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
31147 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
31148 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
31153 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
31154 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
31155 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
31156 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
31157 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
31158 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
31159 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
31163 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
31164 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
31165 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
31168 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31170 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
31174 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
31175 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
31176 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
31177 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
31178 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
31179 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
31180 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
31181 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
31182 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
31184 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
31185 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
31186 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
31190 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
31191 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
31192 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
31194 drop condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
31195 message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
31197 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
31198 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
31201 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
31202 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
31203 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
31204 example, when checking a RCPT command,
31206 require message = Sender did not verify
31209 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
31210 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
31211 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
31212 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
31215 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31216 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
31217 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
31218 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
31219 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
31220 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
31221 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
31223 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
31224 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
31225 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
31226 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
31227 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31229 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
31230 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
31231 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
31232 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
31233 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
31234 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
31238 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31239 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
31240 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
31241 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
31243 warn !verify = sender
31244 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
31248 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
31250 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
31251 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
31252 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
31253 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
31254 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
31258 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
31259 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
31260 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
31261 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
31262 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
31263 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
31264 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
31265 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
31266 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
31267 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
31269 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
31270 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
31271 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
31272 on the same SMTP connection.
31274 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
31275 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
31276 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
31279 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
31280 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
31281 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
31283 accept hosts = whatever
31284 set acl_m4 = some value
31285 accept authenticated = *
31286 set acl_c_auth = yes
31288 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
31289 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
31290 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
31292 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
31293 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
31294 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
31295 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
31296 error is generated.
31298 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
31299 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
31302 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
31303 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
31304 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
31305 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
31307 deny domains = *.dom.example
31308 !verify = recipient
31310 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
31311 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
31312 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
31313 two statements are equivalent:
31315 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
31316 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
31318 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
31319 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
31321 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
31322 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
31323 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
31325 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31326 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
31327 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31328 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
31330 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
31331 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
31332 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
31333 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
31334 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
31335 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
31336 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
31338 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
31339 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
31340 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
31341 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
31342 message is handled.
31344 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
31345 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
31346 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
31347 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
31349 require message = Can't verify sender
31351 message = Can't verify recipient
31353 message = This message cannot be used
31355 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
31356 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
31357 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
31358 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
31359 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
31360 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
31362 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
31363 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
31364 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
31365 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
31368 !senders = *@my.domain.example
31369 message = Invalid sender from client host
31371 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
31372 by which time Exim has set up the message.
31376 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
31377 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
31378 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
31381 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31382 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
31383 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
31384 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31386 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31387 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
31388 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
31389 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
31390 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
31391 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
31392 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
31393 write rather ugly lines like this:
31395 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
31397 Instead, all you need is
31399 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
31402 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31403 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31404 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
31405 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
31406 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
31407 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
31408 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
31409 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
31411 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
31412 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
31413 in several different ways. For example:
31415 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
31416 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
31417 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
31421 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
31423 accept ...some conditions
31426 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
31427 other words, when the conditions are all true.
31430 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
31432 accept ...some conditions...
31434 ...some more conditions...
31436 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
31437 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
31438 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
31442 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
31443 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
31446 warn ...some conditions...
31450 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
31451 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
31455 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
31456 &%require%& verb. For example:
31458 require control = no_multiline_responses
31462 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
31463 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
31465 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
31466 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
31467 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
31468 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
31469 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
31470 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
31472 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
31475 deny ...some conditions...
31478 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
31479 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
31482 ...some conditions...
31484 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
31485 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
31487 warn ...some conditions...
31493 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
31494 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
31495 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
31496 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
31497 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
31498 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
31499 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
31503 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
31504 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
31505 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
31506 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
31507 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
31508 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
31509 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
31512 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31513 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
31514 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
31515 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
31517 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
31518 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
31520 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
31523 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
31524 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
31526 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
31527 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
31528 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
31531 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
31532 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
31533 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
31534 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
31535 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
31536 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
31539 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31540 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
31541 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
31544 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
31545 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
31546 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
31547 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
31548 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
31549 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
31551 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
31552 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
31553 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
31554 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
31555 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
31556 logging rejections.
31559 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
31560 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
31561 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
31562 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
31563 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
31564 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
31565 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
31566 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
31568 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
31569 &` log_reject_target =`&
31571 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
31572 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
31576 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31577 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
31578 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
31579 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
31580 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
31581 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
31582 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
31585 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
31586 &` control = freeze`&
31587 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
31589 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
31590 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
31591 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
31594 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
31595 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
31599 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31600 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
31601 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
31602 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
31603 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
31604 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
31605 &%accept%& for details.)
31607 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
31608 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
31609 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
31610 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
31611 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
31613 require message = Host not recognized
31616 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
31619 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
31620 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
31621 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
31622 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
31623 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
31624 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
31625 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
31626 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
31627 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
31630 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
31631 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
31632 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
31634 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
31635 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
31637 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
31638 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
31639 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
31642 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
31643 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
31645 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
31646 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
31648 If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
31650 A long message line will also be split into multi-line SMTP responses,
31651 on word boundaries if possible.
31653 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31654 While the text is being expanded, the &$acl_verify_message$& variable
31655 contains any message previously set.
31656 Afterwards, &$acl_verify_message$& is cleared.
31658 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
31659 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
31660 However, the original message is available in the variable
31661 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
31662 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
31663 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
31664 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
31666 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
31667 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
31668 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
31669 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
31670 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
31671 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
31675 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31676 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
31677 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
31678 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
31680 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
31682 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
31683 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
31684 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
31685 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
31688 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31689 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
31690 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
31691 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
31694 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
31695 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
31696 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
31697 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
31700 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
31701 .cindex "UDP communications"
31702 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
31703 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
31704 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
31705 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
31706 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
31707 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
31708 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
31711 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
31712 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
31719 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
31720 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31721 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
31724 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
31725 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
31726 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
31727 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
31728 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
31729 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
31730 not work without it. For example:
31732 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
31733 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
31735 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
31736 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
31737 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
31738 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
31739 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
31742 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
31743 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
31744 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
31745 .cindex "case of local parts"
31746 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31747 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
31748 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
31749 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
31750 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
31751 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
31754 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
31755 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
31756 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
31757 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
31758 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
31760 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
31761 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
31764 warn control = caseful_local_part
31765 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
31767 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
31769 control = caselower_local_part
31771 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
31772 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
31775 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
31776 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
31777 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
31778 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
31780 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
31781 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
31782 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
31783 is used for all recipients of the message,
31784 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
31785 and data is copied from one to the other.
31787 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
31788 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
31789 If a recipient-verify callout
31791 connection is subsequently
31792 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
31793 any subsequent recipients and the data,
31794 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
31796 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
31797 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
31798 Note also that headers cannot be
31799 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
31800 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
31801 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
31802 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
31803 this will affect the timestamp.
31805 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
31806 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
31807 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
31808 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
31811 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
31812 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
31813 before the entire message has been received from the source.
31814 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
31818 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
31819 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
31820 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
31821 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
31822 before the acceptance "<=" line.
31824 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
31826 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
31827 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
31828 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
31829 and does not queue the message.
31830 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
31832 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
31834 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
31837 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
31838 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
31839 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
31840 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
31841 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
31842 by default called &'debuglog'&.
31844 Logging set up by the control will be maintained across spool residency.
31846 Options are a slash-separated list.
31847 If an option takes an argument, the option name and argument are separated by
31848 an equals character.
31849 Several options are supported:
31851 tag=<&'suffix'&> The filename can be adjusted with thise option.
31852 The argument, which may access any variables already defined,
31853 is appended to the default name.
31855 opts=<&'debug&~options'&> The argument specififes what is to be logged,
31856 using the same values as the &`-d`& command-line option.
31858 stop Logging started with this control may be
31859 stopped by using this option.
31861 kill Logging started with this control may be
31862 stopped by using this option.
31863 Additionally the debug file will be removed,
31864 providing one means for speculative debug tracing.
31866 pretrigger=<&'size'&> This option specifies a memory buffuer to be used
31867 for pre-trigger debug capture.
31868 Debug lines are recorded in the buffer until
31869 and if) a trigger occurs; at which time they are
31870 dumped to the debug file. Newer lines displace the
31871 oldest if the buffer is full. After a trigger,
31872 immediate writes to file are done as normal.
31874 trigger=<&'reason'&> This option selects cause for the pretrigger buffer
31875 see above) to be copied to file. A reason of &*now*&
31876 take effect immediately; one of &*paniclog*& triggers
31877 on a write to the panic log.
31880 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
31884 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
31885 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
31886 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
31887 control = debug/kill
31888 control = debug/opts=+all/pretrigger=1024/trigger=paniclog
31889 control = debug/trigger=now
31893 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
31894 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
31895 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
31896 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
31897 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
31900 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
31901 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
31902 .cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
31903 This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
31904 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
31907 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
31908 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
31909 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
31910 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
31911 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
31912 strings or to numeric value.
31913 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
31914 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
31915 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
31917 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
31918 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
31919 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
31920 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
31921 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
31924 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
31925 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
31926 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
31927 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
31928 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
31929 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
31930 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
31931 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
31933 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
31934 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
31935 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
31936 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
31937 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
31938 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
31942 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
31943 .cindex "fake defer"
31944 .cindex "defer, fake"
31946 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
31947 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
31948 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
31949 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
31950 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
31952 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
31953 .cindex "fake rejection"
31954 .cindex "rejection, fake"
31956 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
31957 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
31958 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
31959 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
31960 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
31961 the same SMTP connection.
31963 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
31964 message is supplied, the following is used:
31966 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
31967 550-kept for evaluation.
31968 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
31969 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
31971 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
31973 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
31974 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
31975 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
31976 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
31977 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
31978 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
31981 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
31982 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
31983 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
31984 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
31986 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
31987 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
31988 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
31989 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
31990 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
31991 disables such output flushing.
31993 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
31994 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31995 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
31996 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
31997 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
31998 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
32000 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
32001 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
32002 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
32003 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
32004 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
32005 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
32006 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32007 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
32008 to be useful in production.
32010 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
32011 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
32012 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
32013 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
32014 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
32016 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
32017 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
32018 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
32019 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
32020 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
32021 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
32024 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
32025 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
32026 verification failed"&) is sent.
32028 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
32032 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
32033 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
32035 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
32036 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
32037 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
32038 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
32039 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
32040 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
32041 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
32042 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
32044 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
32045 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
32046 .oindex "&%queue%&"
32047 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
32048 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
32049 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
32050 .cindex "first pass routing"
32051 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32052 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32053 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
32055 If used with no options set,
32056 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
32057 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
32059 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
32060 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
32061 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
32062 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
32063 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
32064 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
32066 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
32067 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32069 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
32070 .cindex "message" "submission"
32071 .cindex "submission mode"
32072 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
32073 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
32074 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
32075 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
32076 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
32077 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
32078 late (the message has already been created).
32080 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
32081 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
32082 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
32083 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
32084 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32086 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
32087 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
32088 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
32089 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
32090 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
32093 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
32094 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
32096 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
32098 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
32101 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
32102 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
32103 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32104 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
32107 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
32108 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
32110 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
32111 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
32113 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
32117 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
32118 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
32121 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
32123 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
32124 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
32126 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
32128 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
32133 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
32134 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
32135 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
32136 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
32137 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
32138 to an incoming message, as in this example:
32140 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32141 dialup.mail-abuse.org
32142 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
32144 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32145 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32146 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32147 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
32148 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
32151 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
32152 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32154 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
32155 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
32156 contains one or more newlines that
32157 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
32158 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
32159 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
32161 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32162 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32163 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
32164 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
32165 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
32166 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
32167 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
32168 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
32169 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
32170 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
32171 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
32173 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
32174 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
32176 until they are added to the
32177 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
32178 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
32179 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
32180 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
32181 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
32182 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
32183 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32185 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
32187 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32188 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32190 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32191 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32193 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32194 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32196 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
32197 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
32198 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
32199 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
32202 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
32203 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
32204 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
32205 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
32206 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
32207 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
32208 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
32211 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
32212 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
32213 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
32214 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
32215 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
32217 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
32218 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
32219 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
32220 to be a header name first.) For example:
32222 warn add_header = \
32223 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
32225 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
32226 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
32227 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
32228 up in reverse order.
32230 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32231 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
32232 system filter or in a router or transport.
32236 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
32237 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
32238 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
32239 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
32240 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
32241 from an incoming message, as in this example:
32243 warn message = Remove internal headers
32244 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32246 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32247 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32248 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32249 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
32250 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
32251 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
32253 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
32254 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32256 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
32257 list of header specifiers.
32258 If a specifier does not start with a circumflex (^)
32259 then it is treated as a header name.
32260 The header name matching is case insensitive.
32261 If it does, then it is treated as a (front-anchored)
32262 regular expression applied to the whole header.
32264 &*Note*&: The colon terminating a header name will need to be doubled
32265 if used in an RE, and there can legitimately be whitepace before it.
32269 remove_header = \N^(?i)Authentication-Results\s*::\s*example.org;\N
32272 List expansion is not performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
32273 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
32274 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
32276 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
32277 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32278 warn message = Remove internal headers
32279 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
32281 Header specifiers for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32282 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32283 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
32284 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
32285 a non-existent header. Further header specifiers for removal may be accumulated
32286 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which matching headers are removed
32287 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, remove specifiers are
32288 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are acted on after
32289 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
32290 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
32291 would have been removed.
32293 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
32294 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
32295 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
32296 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
32297 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
32298 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
32299 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
32300 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
32301 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32303 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32304 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32306 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
32307 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32309 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32310 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
32312 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
32313 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
32314 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
32315 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
32318 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32319 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
32320 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
32325 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
32326 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
32327 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
32328 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
32329 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
32330 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32332 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
32333 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
32334 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
32335 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
32336 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
32337 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
32338 The conditions are as follows:
32342 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
32343 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
32344 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
32345 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
32346 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
32347 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
32348 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
32349 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
32350 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
32351 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
32352 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
32353 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
32355 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
32356 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
32357 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
32358 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
32359 The name and values are expanded separately.
32360 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
32361 will act as argument separators.
32363 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
32364 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
32365 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
32366 conditions are tested.
32368 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
32369 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
32370 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
32371 for different local users or different local domains.
32373 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32374 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
32375 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
32376 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
32377 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
32378 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
32379 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
32384 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
32385 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
32386 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
32387 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
32388 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
32389 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
32390 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
32391 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
32392 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
32393 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
32394 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
32395 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
32398 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
32399 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
32400 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32401 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32402 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
32403 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
32404 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
32405 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32407 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
32408 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
32409 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32410 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32411 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32412 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
32413 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
32414 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
32415 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
32416 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
32418 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32419 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
32420 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
32421 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
32422 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
32423 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the domain
32424 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
32425 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
32426 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
32429 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
32430 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
32433 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32434 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
32435 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
32436 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
32437 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
32438 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
32439 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
32445 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
32446 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
32447 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
32448 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
32449 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
32450 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
32451 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
32453 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32455 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
32456 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
32457 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
32459 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
32460 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
32461 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
32462 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
32463 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
32464 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
32466 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
32467 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
32469 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32470 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
32472 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
32473 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
32474 statement can then check the IP address.
32476 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
32477 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
32478 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
32479 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
32481 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
32482 message = $host_data
32484 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
32486 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
32487 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
32488 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
32489 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
32490 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
32491 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the local
32492 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
32493 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
32494 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
32495 the next &%local_parts%& test.
32497 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
32498 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
32499 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
32500 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
32501 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32502 content-scanning extension
32503 and only after a DATA command.
32504 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
32505 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32507 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32508 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
32509 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32510 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32511 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32512 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
32513 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
32516 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32517 .cindex "rate limiting"
32518 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
32519 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
32521 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32522 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
32523 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
32524 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
32525 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks the entire
32526 recipient address against a list of recipients.
32528 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32529 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
32530 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32531 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32532 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
32533 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
32534 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32536 .vitem &*seen&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32537 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
32538 This condition can be used to test if a situation has been previously met,
32539 for example for greylisting.
32540 Details are given in section &<<SECTseen>>&.
32542 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32543 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
32544 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32545 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
32546 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32547 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
32548 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
32549 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
32550 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
32551 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
32552 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
32553 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
32554 influence the sender checking.
32556 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32557 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32559 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32560 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
32561 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32562 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
32563 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
32564 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
32568 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32569 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32571 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
32572 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
32573 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
32574 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32575 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
32576 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32578 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
32579 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32580 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
32581 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
32582 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
32583 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
32584 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
32585 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
32586 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
32587 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
32589 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
32590 .cindex "CSA verification"
32591 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
32592 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
32593 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
32595 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
32596 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32597 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32598 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32599 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
32600 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32602 This usually means an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32603 It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
32604 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
32605 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
32607 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
32608 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
32609 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
32611 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
32612 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32613 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
32614 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
32615 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
32616 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
32617 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32618 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32619 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
32620 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
32621 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
32622 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
32623 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
32624 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
32625 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
32627 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
32628 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
32629 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
32630 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
32633 !verify = header_sender
32634 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
32637 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
32638 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32639 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
32640 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
32641 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
32642 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32643 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32644 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
32645 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
32646 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
32647 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
32648 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
32649 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
32652 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
32653 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
32657 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
32658 common as they used to be.
32660 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
32661 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32662 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
32663 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
32664 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
32665 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
32666 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
32667 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
32668 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
32669 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
32670 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
32671 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
32672 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
32674 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
32675 option), this condition is always true.
32678 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
32679 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
32680 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
32681 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
32682 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
32683 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
32684 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
32685 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
32686 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
32688 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
32689 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
32691 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
32692 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
32695 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
32696 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32697 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
32698 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
32699 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
32700 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32701 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
32702 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
32703 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
32704 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
32705 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
32706 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
32707 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
32708 value for the child address.
32710 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
32711 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32712 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
32713 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
32714 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
32715 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
32716 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
32717 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
32718 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
32719 original IP address.
32721 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
32722 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
32724 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
32725 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
32727 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
32728 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32729 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
32730 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
32731 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
32732 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
32733 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
32734 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
32735 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
32737 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32738 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
32739 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
32740 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
32741 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
32742 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
32743 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
32745 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
32746 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
32747 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
32749 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
32750 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32751 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
32752 verified as a sender.
32754 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
32755 (eg. is generated from the received message)
32756 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
32758 verify = sender=${listquote{/}{${address:$h_sender:}}}
32764 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
32765 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32766 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32767 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32768 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
32769 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
32770 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
32771 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
32772 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
32773 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
32775 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
32776 dialups.mail-abuse.org
32778 the following records are looked up:
32780 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32781 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
32783 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
32784 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
32785 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
32786 use two separate conditions:
32788 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32789 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
32791 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
32792 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
32793 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
32796 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
32797 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
32798 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
32799 following special items in the list:
32800 .itable none 0 0 2 25* left 75* left
32801 .irow "+include_unknown" "behave as if the item is on the list"
32802 .irow "+exclude_unknown" "behave as if the item is not on the list (default)"
32803 .irow "+defer_unknown " "give a temporary error"
32805 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
32806 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
32807 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
32808 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
32810 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
32812 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
32813 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
32815 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32816 warn dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
32817 message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
32819 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
32821 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
32822 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
32823 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
32824 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
32825 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
32826 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
32828 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
32829 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
32830 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
32834 .subsection "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" SECID201
32835 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
32836 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
32837 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
32838 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
32840 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
32842 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
32843 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
32844 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
32845 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
32850 .subsection "DNS lists keyed on domain names" SECID202
32851 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
32852 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
32853 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
32854 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
32855 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
32856 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
32858 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
32859 message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
32861 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
32862 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
32863 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
32864 up by this example is
32866 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
32868 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
32869 addresses. For example:
32871 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32872 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
32874 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
32875 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
32880 .subsection "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" SECTmulkeyfor
32881 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
32882 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
32883 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
32884 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
32885 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
32886 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
32887 either to double the separators like this:
32889 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
32891 or to change the separator character, like this:
32893 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
32895 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
32896 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
32897 occurs. Consider this condition:
32899 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
32901 The DNS lookups that occur are:
32903 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
32904 a.domain.black.list.tld
32906 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
32907 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
32908 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
32909 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
32910 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
32911 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
32912 error for a previous item.
32914 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
32915 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
32917 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
32918 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
32920 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
32921 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
32923 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
32924 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
32925 $sender_address_domain} }} }
32926 message = The mail servers for the domain \
32927 $sender_address_domain \
32928 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
32931 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
32932 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
32933 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
32934 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
32936 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
32938 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
32939 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
32941 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
32942 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
32947 .subsection "Data returned by DNS lists" SECID203
32948 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
32949 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
32950 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
32951 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
32952 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
32953 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
32954 .irow 127.1.0.1 "RBL"
32955 .irow 127.1.0.2 "DUL"
32956 .irow 127.1.0.3 "DUL and RBL"
32957 .irow 127.1.0.4 "RSS"
32958 .irow 127.1.0.5 "RSS and RBL"
32959 .irow 127.1.0.6 "RSS and DUL"
32960 .irow 127.1.0.7 "RSS and DUL and RBL"
32962 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
32963 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
32964 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
32966 Values returned by a properly running DBSBL should be in the 127.0.0.0/8
32967 range. If a DNSBL operator loses control of the domain, lookups on it
32968 may start returning other addresses. Because of this, Exim now ignores
32969 returned values outside the 127/8 region.
32972 .subsection "Variables set from DNS lists" SECID204
32973 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
32974 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
32975 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
32976 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
32977 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
32978 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
32979 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
32980 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
32981 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
32982 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
32983 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
32984 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
32985 cases, for example:
32987 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
32989 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
32990 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
32991 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
32992 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
32994 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
32996 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
32997 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
32999 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
33000 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
33001 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
33002 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
33003 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
33006 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
33007 &-- even if these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
33008 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
33010 deny hosts = !+local_networks
33011 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
33013 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
33018 .subsection "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" SECTaddmatcon
33019 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
33020 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
33021 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
33024 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
33026 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
33027 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
33028 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
33029 describes how multiple records are handled.
33031 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
33032 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
33033 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
33035 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33037 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
33038 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
33039 first. For example:
33041 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
33042 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
33045 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
33046 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
33047 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
33048 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
33049 tested. For example:
33051 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
33053 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
33054 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
33055 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
33057 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33059 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
33064 .subsection "Negated DNS matching conditions" SECID205
33065 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
33068 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33070 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33071 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
33073 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33075 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33076 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
33077 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
33078 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
33080 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
33081 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
33083 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
33084 previous example is precisely equivalent to
33086 deny dnslists = a.b.c
33087 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33089 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
33090 Consider this example:
33092 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33094 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
33097 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
33099 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33101 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
33102 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
33103 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
33105 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
33107 Negation can also be used with a bitwise-and restriction.
33108 The dnslists condition with only be trus if a result is returned
33109 by the lookup which, anded with the restriction, is all zeroes.
33112 deny dnslists = zen.spamhaus.org!&0.255.255.0
33118 .subsection "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" SECThanmuldnsrec
33119 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
33120 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
33121 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
33122 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
33123 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
33125 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
33127 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
33128 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
33129 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
33130 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
33131 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
33132 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
33135 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
33136 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
33137 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33139 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
33140 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
33143 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
33145 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33146 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
33148 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
33150 for the condition to be true.
33153 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
33154 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
33156 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
33157 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
33159 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
33161 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33162 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33164 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
33165 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
33167 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
33169 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33170 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
33172 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33174 for the condition to be false.
33176 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
33177 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
33182 .subsection "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" SECTmordetinf
33183 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
33184 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
33185 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
33186 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
33187 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
33188 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
33189 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
33190 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
33193 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
33194 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
33195 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
33196 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
33197 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
33198 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
33199 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
33202 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
33203 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33205 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
33206 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
33208 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
33209 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
33210 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
33211 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
33212 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
33213 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
33215 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
33216 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
33217 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
33220 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
33221 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
33222 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
33223 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33225 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
33226 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
33227 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
33231 .subsection "DNS lists and IPv6" SECTmorednslistslast
33232 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
33233 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
33234 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
33235 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
33236 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
33238 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
33239 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33241 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
33242 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
33243 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
33245 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
33247 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
33248 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
33250 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
33251 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
33253 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
33254 dnslists = some.list.example
33257 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
33258 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
33259 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
33261 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
33265 .section "Previously seen user and hosts" "SECTseen"
33266 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
33267 .cindex greylisting
33268 The &%seen%& ACL condition can be used to test whether a
33269 situation has been previously met.
33270 It uses a hints database to record a timestamp against a key.
33271 The syntax of the condition is:
33273 &`seen =`& <&'optional flag'&><&'time interval'&> &`/`& <&'options'&>
33278 defer seen = -5m / key=${sender_host_address}_$local_part@$domain
33280 in a RCPT ACL will implement simple greylisting.
33282 The parameters for the condition are
33283 a possible minus sign,
33285 then, slash-separated, a list of options.
33286 The interval is taken as an offset before the current time,
33287 and used for the test.
33288 If the interval is preceded by a minus sign then the condition returns
33289 whether a record is found which is before the test time.
33290 Otherwise, the condition returns whether one is found which is since the
33293 Options are read in order with later ones overriding earlier ones.
33295 The default key is &$sender_host_address$&.
33296 An explicit key can be set using a &%key=value%& option.
33298 If a &%readonly%& option is given then
33299 no record create or update is done.
33300 If a &%write%& option is given then
33301 a record create or update is always done.
33302 An update is done if the test is for &"since"&.
33303 If none of those hold and there was no existing record,
33304 a record is created.
33306 Creates and updates are marked with the current time.
33308 Finally, a &"before"& test which succeeds, and for which the record
33309 is old enough, will be refreshed with a timestamp of the test time.
33310 This can prevent tidying of the database from removing the entry.
33311 The interval for this is, by default, 10 days.
33312 An explicit interval can be set using a
33313 &%refresh=value%& option.
33315 Note that &"seen"& should be added to the list of hints databases
33316 for maintenance if this ACL condition is used.
33319 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
33320 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
33321 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
33322 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
33323 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
33324 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
33325 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
33326 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
33327 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
33328 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
33330 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
33332 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
33333 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
33335 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
33336 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
33337 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
33340 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
33341 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
33342 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
33343 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
33344 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
33345 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
33346 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
33347 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
33348 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
33350 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
33351 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
33352 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
33353 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
33355 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
33356 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
33357 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
33358 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
33359 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
33360 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
33361 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
33362 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
33363 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
33364 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
33366 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
33367 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
33368 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
33371 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
33372 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
33373 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
33374 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
33375 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
33376 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
33378 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
33379 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
33380 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
33381 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
33382 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
33383 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
33384 the &%count=%& option.
33387 .subsection "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" ratoptmea
33388 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
33391 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33392 This option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
33393 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
33394 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
33397 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33398 This option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
33399 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
33400 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
33401 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
33404 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33405 This option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
33406 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
33407 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
33408 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
33409 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
33410 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
33411 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
33414 .cindex "rate limiting" per_rcpt
33415 This option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
33416 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
33417 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, or &%acl_smtp_data%& ACLs. In
33418 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
33419 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
33420 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
33421 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
33424 .cindex "rate limiting" per_addr
33425 This option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
33426 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
33427 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
33428 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
33432 .cindex "rate limiting" per_cmd
33433 This option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
33434 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
33435 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
33436 multiple different commands.
33439 .cindex "rate limiting" count
33440 This option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
33442 A value is required, after an equals sign.
33443 For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
33444 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&.
33445 If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
33446 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
33447 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&).
33448 The count does not have to be an integer.
33451 .cindex "rate limiting" unique
33452 This option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
33456 .subsection "Ratelimit update modes" ratoptupd
33457 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
33458 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
33459 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
33460 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
33462 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
33463 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
33465 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
33466 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
33467 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
33468 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
33472 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
33473 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33474 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33477 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
33478 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33479 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33482 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
33483 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
33484 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
33485 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
33486 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
33487 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
33490 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
33491 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
33492 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
33493 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
33494 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
33497 .subsection "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" ratoptfast
33498 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
33499 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
33500 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
33501 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
33502 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
33505 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
33506 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
33507 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
33508 up to the given limit.
33509 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
33510 consists of refusing the message, and
33511 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
33512 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
33513 likely not what is wanted.
33515 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
33516 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
33517 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
33518 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
33519 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
33520 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
33521 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
33522 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
33524 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
33528 .subsection "Limiting the rate of different events" ratoptuniq
33529 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
33530 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
33531 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
33532 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
33533 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
33534 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
33535 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
33536 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
33538 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
33539 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
33540 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
33541 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
33542 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
33543 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
33545 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
33546 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
33549 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
33550 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
33551 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
33552 required increases with larger limits.
33554 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
33555 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
33556 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
33557 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
33558 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
33559 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
33560 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
33561 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
33562 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
33566 .subsection "Using rate limiting" useratlim
33567 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
33568 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
33569 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
33570 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
33571 message. For example:
33573 # Log all senders' rates
33574 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
33575 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
33577 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
33578 # at the decimal point.
33579 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
33580 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
33581 $sender_rate_limit }s
33583 # Keep authenticated users under control
33584 deny authenticated = *
33585 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
33587 # System-wide rate limit
33588 defer ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
33589 message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
33591 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
33592 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
33593 defer ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
33594 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
33595 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
33596 message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
33597 messages per $sender_rate_period
33599 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
33600 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
33601 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
33602 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
33603 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
33604 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
33605 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
33609 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
33610 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
33611 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
33612 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
33613 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
33614 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
33615 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
33616 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
33617 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
33619 verify = sender/callout
33620 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
33622 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
33623 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
33624 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
33625 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
33626 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
33627 The available options are as follows:
33630 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
33631 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
33632 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
33634 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
33635 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
33636 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
33637 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
33639 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
33640 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
33642 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
33643 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
33644 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
33645 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
33647 If the &%quota%& option is specified for recipient verify,
33648 successful routing to an appendfile transport is followed by a call into
33649 the transport to evaluate the quota status for the recipient.
33650 No actual delivery is done, but verification will succeed if the quota
33651 is sufficient for the message (if the sender gave a message size) or
33652 not already exceeded (otherwise).
33655 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
33656 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
33657 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
33658 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
33659 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
33660 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
33663 warn !verify = sender
33664 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
33666 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
33667 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
33668 verification failure.
33669 This variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
33671 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
33672 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
33675 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
33676 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
33678 &%route%&: Routing failed.
33680 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
33681 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
33682 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
33684 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
33686 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
33688 &%quota%&: The quota check for a local recipient did non pass.
33691 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
33692 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
33694 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
33695 address verification to:
33698 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
33704 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
33705 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
33706 .cindex "callout" "verification"
33707 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
33708 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
33709 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
33710 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
33711 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
33712 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
33713 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
33714 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
33715 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
33718 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
33719 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
33720 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
33721 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
33722 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
33723 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
33725 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
33726 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
33727 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
33728 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
33729 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
33731 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
33732 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
33733 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
33734 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
33735 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
33736 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
33737 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
33738 supplies a host list.
33739 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
33741 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
33742 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
33743 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
33744 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
33745 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
33746 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
33747 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
33749 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
33750 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
33751 following SMTP commands are sent:
33753 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
33755 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
33758 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
33761 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
33764 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
33765 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
33766 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
33767 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
33768 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
33769 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
33771 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
33772 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
33773 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
33774 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
33775 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
33777 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
33778 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
33779 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
33780 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
33781 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
33783 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
33784 .cindex "de-tainting" "using recipient verify"
33785 A recipient callout which gets a 2&'xx'& code
33786 will assign untainted values to the
33787 &$domain_data$& and &$local_part_data$& variables,
33788 corresponding to the domain and local parts of the recipient address.
33793 .subsection "Additional parameters for callouts" CALLaddparcall
33794 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
33795 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
33796 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
33798 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
33800 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
33801 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
33802 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
33806 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
33807 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
33808 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
33811 verify = sender/callout=5s
33813 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
33814 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
33815 the &%connect%& parameter.
33818 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33819 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
33820 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
33821 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
33823 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
33825 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
33827 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
33828 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
33829 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
33830 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
33831 updated in this circumstance.
33833 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
33834 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
33835 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
33836 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
33837 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
33838 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
33841 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
33842 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
33843 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
33844 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
33845 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
33846 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
33847 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
33848 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
33849 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
33850 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
33852 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
33854 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
33857 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33858 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
33859 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
33862 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
33864 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
33865 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
33866 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
33867 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
33868 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
33871 .vitem &*no_cache*&
33872 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
33873 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
33874 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
33876 .vitem &*postmaster*&
33877 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
33878 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
33879 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
33880 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
33881 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
33882 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
33883 made, until the cache record expires.
33885 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
33886 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
33887 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
33890 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
33892 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
33893 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
33895 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
33897 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
33898 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
33899 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
33900 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
33904 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
33905 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
33906 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
33907 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
33908 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
33910 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
33912 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
33913 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
33914 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
33915 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
33916 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
33918 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
33919 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
33920 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
33922 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
33924 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33925 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
33926 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
33927 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
33928 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
33930 .vitem &*use_sender*&
33931 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
33933 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
33935 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
33936 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
33937 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
33938 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
33939 usefulness of callout caching.
33942 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
33944 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
33946 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
33947 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
33948 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
33949 when that is used for the connections.
33950 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
33951 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
33952 if the use_sender option is used,
33953 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
33954 and if no other callouts intervene.
33957 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
33958 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
33959 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
33960 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
33961 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
33962 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
33963 these circumstances.
33965 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
33966 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
33967 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
33968 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
33969 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
33970 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
33971 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
33973 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
33974 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
33975 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
33976 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
33981 .subsection "Callout caching" SECTcallvercache
33982 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
33983 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
33984 .cindex "caching" "callout"
33985 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
33986 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
33987 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
33988 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
33989 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
33990 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
33992 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
33993 the failure. However, for subsequent failures that use the cache data, this message
33996 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
33997 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
33998 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
34000 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
34001 commands up to and including
34005 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
34006 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
34007 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
34008 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
34009 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
34010 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
34011 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
34013 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
34014 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
34015 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
34016 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
34017 will eventually be noticed.
34019 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
34020 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
34021 behaviour will be the same.
34025 .section "Quota caching" "SECTquotacache"
34026 .cindex "hints database" "quota cache"
34027 .cindex "quota" "cache, description of"
34028 .cindex "caching" "quota"
34029 Exim caches the results of quota verification
34030 in order to reduce the amount of resources used.
34031 The &"callout"& hints database is used.
34033 The default cache periods are five minutes for a positive (good) result
34034 and one hour for a negative result.
34035 To change the periods the &%quota%& option can be followed by an equals sign
34036 and a number of optional paramemters, separated by commas.
34039 verify = recipient/quota=cachepos=1h,cacheneg=1d
34041 Possible parameters are:
34043 .vitem &*cachepos&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34044 .cindex "quota cache" "positive entry expiry, specifying"
34045 Set the lifetime for a positive cache entry.
34046 A value of zero seconds is legitimate.
34048 .vitem &*cacheneg&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34049 .cindex "quota cache" "negative entry expiry, specifying"
34050 As above, for a negative entry.
34052 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34053 Set both positive and negative lifetimes to zero.
34055 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
34056 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
34057 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
34058 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
34059 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
34060 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
34063 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
34065 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
34066 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
34067 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
34068 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
34069 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
34070 550 Sender verification failed
34072 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
34073 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
34074 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
34075 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
34078 verify = sender/no_details
34081 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
34082 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
34083 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
34084 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
34085 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
34086 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
34087 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
34090 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
34091 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
34092 verification also fails.
34094 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
34095 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
34098 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
34099 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
34100 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
34103 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
34105 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
34106 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
34107 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
34108 verification to succeed.
34110 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
34111 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
34112 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
34113 option. For example:
34115 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
34117 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
34118 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
34120 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
34121 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
34122 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
34123 address and a report is output for each of them.
34127 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
34128 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
34129 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
34130 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
34131 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
34132 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
34133 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
34137 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
34138 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
34139 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
34140 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
34141 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
34142 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
34144 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
34145 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
34146 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
34147 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
34150 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
34152 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
34154 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
34155 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
34157 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
34158 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
34161 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
34162 use for the DNS query. The default is:
34164 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
34166 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
34167 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
34168 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
34169 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
34172 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
34174 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
34175 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
34176 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
34178 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
34179 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
34180 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
34181 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
34182 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
34183 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
34184 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
34185 of legitimate HELO domains.
34187 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
34188 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
34189 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
34190 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
34193 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
34195 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
34196 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
34197 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
34202 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
34203 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
34204 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
34205 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
34206 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
34207 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
34208 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
34209 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
34211 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
34212 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
34213 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
34214 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
34215 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
34216 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
34217 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
34218 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
34220 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
34221 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
34224 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
34225 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
34228 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
34229 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
34232 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
34234 recipients = +batv_senders
34235 message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
34237 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
34239 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
34240 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
34241 !condition = $prvscheck_result
34242 message = Invalid reverse path signature.
34244 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
34245 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
34246 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
34247 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
34248 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
34250 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
34251 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
34252 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
34253 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
34254 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
34255 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
34256 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
34258 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
34259 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
34260 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
34261 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
34265 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
34267 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
34268 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
34269 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
34272 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
34275 external_smtp_batv:
34277 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
34278 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
34279 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
34280 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
34283 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
34287 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
34288 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
34289 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
34290 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
34291 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
34292 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
34293 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
34294 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
34295 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
34296 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
34298 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
34299 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
34300 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
34301 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
34302 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
34303 same host is fulfilling both functions,
34305 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
34307 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
34308 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
34309 system to arbitrary domains.
34312 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
34313 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
34314 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
34315 example, suppose you want to do the following:
34318 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
34319 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
34320 &'my.dom2.example'&.
34322 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
34323 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
34325 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
34326 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
34330 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
34332 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
34333 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
34334 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
34336 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
34340 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
34341 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
34343 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
34344 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
34345 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
34346 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
34347 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
34348 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
34349 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
34353 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
34354 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
34355 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
34356 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
34357 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
34362 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34363 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34365 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
34366 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
34367 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
34368 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
34369 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
34370 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
34373 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
34374 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
34375 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
34376 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
34377 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
34379 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
34380 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
34381 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
34384 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
34385 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
34387 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
34388 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
34389 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
34391 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
34392 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
34394 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
34397 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
34400 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
34401 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
34402 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
34403 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
34404 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
34405 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
34407 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
34408 temporarily created in a file called:
34410 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
34412 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
34413 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
34414 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
34415 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
34416 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
34418 control = no_mbox_unspool
34420 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
34421 same directory by default.
34425 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
34426 .cindex "virus scanning"
34427 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
34428 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
34429 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
34430 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
34431 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
34432 in memory and thus are much faster.
34434 Since message data needs to have arrived,
34435 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
34437 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
34438 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
34441 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
34442 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
34444 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
34445 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
34446 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
34447 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
34449 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
34451 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
34453 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
34455 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
34457 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
34458 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
34459 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
34463 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
34464 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
34465 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
34466 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
34467 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
34468 This scanner type takes one option,
34469 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34470 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34471 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34472 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34473 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
34474 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
34475 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
34477 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
34478 If &`pass_unscanned`&
34479 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
34480 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
34485 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34486 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34487 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
34489 If you omit the argument, the default path
34490 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
34492 If you use a remote host,
34493 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
34494 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
34495 For information about available commands and their options you may use
34497 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
34503 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
34504 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
34505 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
34507 .vitem &%aveserver%&
34508 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34509 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
34510 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
34511 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
34514 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
34519 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
34520 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
34521 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
34522 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
34523 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
34525 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
34526 a UNIX socket specification,
34527 a TCP socket specification,
34528 or a (global) option.
34530 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
34531 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
34532 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
34533 and the second a port number,
34534 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
34535 These per-server options are supported:
34537 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34540 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
34541 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
34543 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
34547 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
34548 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
34549 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
34550 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
34551 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
34553 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
34555 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
34556 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
34557 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
34558 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
34560 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
34561 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
34562 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
34563 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
34564 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
34565 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
34566 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
34567 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
34568 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
34570 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
34571 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
34572 (Connection refused)
34575 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
34576 contributing the code for this scanner.
34579 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
34580 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
34581 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
34582 type takes 3 mandatory options:
34585 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
34586 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
34589 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
34590 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
34591 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
34592 the &"trigger"& expression.
34595 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
34596 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
34597 &"name"& expression.
34600 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
34602 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
34604 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
34605 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
34606 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
34607 configuration setting:
34609 av_scanner = cmdline:\
34610 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
34611 found in file:'(.+)'
34614 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
34615 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
34617 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34618 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34619 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34620 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34623 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
34624 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
34626 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
34627 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
34630 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
34631 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
34632 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
34636 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
34638 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
34640 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
34641 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
34642 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
34643 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
34646 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
34648 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
34651 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
34652 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
34653 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
34655 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
34657 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
34658 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
34660 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
34661 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34662 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
34663 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
34664 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
34667 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
34669 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
34672 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
34673 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
34674 though some documentation was available in English.
34675 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
34676 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
34677 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
34679 The only option for this scanner type is
34680 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
34681 provided that mksd has
34682 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
34684 av_scanner = mksd:2
34686 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
34689 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
34690 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
34691 running on the local machine.
34692 There are four options:
34693 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
34694 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
34695 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
34696 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
34697 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
34700 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
34702 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
34703 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
34704 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
34705 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
34706 specify an empty element to get this.
34709 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
34710 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
34711 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
34712 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
34713 client communication. For example:
34715 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
34717 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
34721 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
34722 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
34725 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
34726 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
34727 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
34728 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
34729 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
34730 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
34733 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
34734 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
34735 The first element can then be one of
34738 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
34739 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
34742 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
34743 the condition fails immediately.
34745 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
34746 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
34747 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
34748 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
34749 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
34752 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
34753 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
34754 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
34756 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
34757 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
34760 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
34762 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
34764 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
34765 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
34766 is set to record the actual address used.
34768 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
34769 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
34770 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
34771 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
34774 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
34775 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
34777 Here is a very simple scanning example:
34780 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34782 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
34784 deny malware = */defer_ok
34785 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34787 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
34788 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
34790 av_scanner = $acl_m0
34792 in the main Exim configuration.
34794 deny set acl_m0 = sophie
34796 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34798 deny set acl_m0 = aveserver
34800 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34804 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
34805 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
34806 .cindex "spam scanning"
34807 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
34809 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
34810 score and a report for the message.
34811 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
34813 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
34814 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
34815 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
34817 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
34819 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
34821 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
34822 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
34825 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
34826 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
34827 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
34828 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
34829 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
34830 configuration as follows (example):
34832 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
34834 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
34835 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
34836 iptables firewall, consider setting
34837 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
34838 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
34839 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
34840 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
34844 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
34846 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
34848 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
34851 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
34852 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
34853 filename instead of an address/port pair:
34855 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
34857 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
34858 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
34859 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
34860 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
34862 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
34863 192.168.2.11 783 : \
34866 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
34867 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
34868 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
34871 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
34872 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
34873 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
34874 take care to not double the separator.
34876 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
34877 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
34878 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
34879 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
34881 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
34883 The supported options are:
34885 pri=<priority> Selection priority
34886 weight=<value> Selection bias
34887 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
34888 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34889 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
34890 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
34893 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
34894 higher values being tried first.
34895 The default priority is 1.
34897 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
34898 Within a priority set
34899 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
34900 The default value for selection bias is 1.
34902 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
34903 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
34904 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
34905 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
34907 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
34908 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
34910 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
34911 The default value is two minutes.
34913 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
34914 a failed connect is made.
34915 The default is to not retry.
34917 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
34918 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
34919 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
34922 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
34923 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
34924 is set to record the actual address used.
34926 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
34927 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
34930 message = This message was classified as SPAM
34932 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
34933 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
34934 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
34935 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
34936 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
34939 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
34940 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
34941 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
34942 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
34943 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
34945 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
34946 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
34948 or the use of PRDR,
34949 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
34950 are needed to use this feature.
34952 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
34953 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
34954 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
34957 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
34958 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
34959 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
34962 deny condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
34964 message = This message was classified as SPAM
34967 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
34968 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
34969 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
34970 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
34972 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
34973 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
34975 Except for &$spam_report$&,
34976 these variables are saved with the received message so are
34977 available for use at delivery time.
34980 .vitem &$spam_score$&
34981 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
34982 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
34984 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
34985 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
34986 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
34987 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
34988 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
34990 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
34991 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
34992 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
34993 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
34994 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
34995 spam bar is 50 characters.
34997 .vitem &$spam_report$&
34998 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
34999 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
35000 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
35001 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
35002 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
35003 unencoded in headers.
35005 .vitem &$spam_action$&
35006 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
35007 spam score versus threshold.
35008 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
35012 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
35013 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
35014 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
35016 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
35017 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
35018 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
35019 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
35020 spam condition, like this:
35022 deny spam = joe/defer_ok
35023 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35025 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
35027 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
35030 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
35031 warn spam = nobody:true
35032 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
35033 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
35035 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
35036 # is over threshold
35038 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
35040 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
35041 deny spam = nobody:true
35042 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
35043 message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
35048 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
35049 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
35050 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
35051 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
35052 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
35053 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
35054 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
35055 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
35056 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
35057 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
35060 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
35061 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
35062 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
35063 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
35064 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
35065 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
35066 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
35068 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
35069 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
35070 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
35071 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
35072 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
35074 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
35075 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
35076 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
35077 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
35078 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
35081 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
35083 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
35087 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
35089 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
35090 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
35091 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
35092 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
35094 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
35095 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
35096 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
35097 the full path and filename.
35099 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
35100 filename, and the default path is then used.
35102 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
35103 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
35104 a file with its original, proposed filename using
35106 decode = $mime_filename
35108 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
35109 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
35110 automatically unlinked.
35112 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
35113 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
35114 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
35115 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
35116 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
35118 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
35119 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
35120 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
35122 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
35123 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
35124 available in the MIME ACL:
35127 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
35128 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35129 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
35130 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35131 If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
35132 the detected issue.
35134 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
35135 .vindex &$mime_boundary$&
35136 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
35137 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
35138 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
35139 contains the empty string.
35141 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
35142 .vindex &$mime_charset$&
35143 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
35144 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
35150 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
35151 case-insensitively.
35153 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
35154 .vindex &$mime_content_description$&
35155 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
35156 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
35157 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
35158 only used for display purposes.
35160 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
35161 .vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
35162 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
35163 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
35165 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
35166 .vindex &$mime_content_id$&
35167 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
35168 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
35170 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
35171 .vindex &$mime_content_size$&
35172 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35173 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
35174 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
35175 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
35177 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35178 .vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35179 This variable contains the normalized content of the
35180 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
35181 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
35183 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
35184 .vindex &$mime_content_type$&
35185 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
35186 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
35187 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
35191 application/octet-stream
35195 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
35198 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35199 .vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35200 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35201 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
35202 containing the decoded data.
35207 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
35208 .vindex &$mime_filename$&
35209 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
35210 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
35211 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
35214 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
35216 found, this variable contains the empty string.
35218 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35219 .vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35220 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
35221 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
35222 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
35224 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
35225 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
35229 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
35232 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
35233 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
35236 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
35237 and the rest are attachments.
35240 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
35243 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
35244 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
35245 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
35247 deny !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
35248 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
35249 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
35250 message = HTML mail is not accepted here
35253 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
35254 .vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
35255 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
35256 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
35257 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
35258 want to carry out specific actions on them.
35260 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35261 .vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35262 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
35263 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
35264 decoding is fully recursive.
35266 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
35267 .vindex &$mime_part_count$&
35268 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
35269 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
35270 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
35271 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
35272 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
35273 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
35278 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
35279 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
35280 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
35281 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
35282 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
35284 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
35285 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
35286 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
35287 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
35288 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
35290 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
35291 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
35292 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
35293 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
35294 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
35295 32K characters are checked.
35297 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
35298 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
35299 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
35300 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
35301 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
35303 deny regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
35304 message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
35306 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
35307 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
35308 matching regular expression.
35309 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
35310 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
35312 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
35320 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35321 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35323 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
35324 "Local scan function"
35325 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
35326 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
35327 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
35328 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
35329 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
35331 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
35332 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
35333 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
35334 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
35335 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
35337 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
35338 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
35339 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
35340 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
35342 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
35343 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
35344 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
35345 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
35347 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
35348 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
35349 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
35350 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
35351 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
35352 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
35353 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
35354 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
35355 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
35359 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
35360 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
35361 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
35362 function is before building Exim, by setting
35363 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
35364 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
35365 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
35366 directory, so you might set
35368 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
35369 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
35371 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
35372 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
35373 and then #include "local_scan.h".
35375 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
35376 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
35377 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
35378 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
35379 _src/local_scan.c_.
35381 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
35382 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
35384 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35386 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
35391 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
35392 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
35393 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
35394 You must include this line near the start of your code:
35397 #include "local_scan.h"
35399 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
35400 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
35401 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
35402 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
35403 It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
35404 strings and pointers to character strings:
35406 #define CS (char *)
35407 #define CCS (const char *)
35408 #define CSS (char **)
35409 #define US (unsigned char *)
35410 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
35411 #define USS (unsigned char **)
35413 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
35415 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
35417 The arguments are as follows:
35420 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
35421 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
35422 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
35424 The descriptor is positioned at character 26 of the file, which is the first
35425 character of the body itself, because the first 26 characters (19 characters
35426 before Exim 4.97) are the message id followed by &`-D`& and a newline.
35427 If you rewind the file, you should use the
35428 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
35429 case this changes in some future version.
35431 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
35432 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
35435 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
35438 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
35439 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
35440 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
35441 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
35442 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
35443 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
35445 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
35446 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35447 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
35449 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
35450 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35451 queued without immediate delivery.
35453 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
35454 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
35455 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
35456 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
35457 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
35460 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
35461 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
35462 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
35465 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35466 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
35467 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
35468 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
35469 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
35470 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
35471 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35473 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35474 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
35475 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35478 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
35479 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
35480 &%-oe%& command line options.
35484 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
35485 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
35486 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
35487 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
35488 want to do this, you must have the line
35490 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35492 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
35493 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
35494 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
35497 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
35498 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
35499 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
35500 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
35501 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
35502 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
35504 static int my_integer_option = 42;
35505 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
35507 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
35508 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
35509 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
35512 int local_scan_options_count =
35513 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
35515 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
35516 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
35520 my_string = some string of text...
35522 The available types of option data are as follows:
35525 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
35526 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
35527 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
35528 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
35529 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
35530 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
35533 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
35534 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
35535 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
35536 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
35539 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
35540 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
35543 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
35544 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
35545 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
35546 printed with the suffix K or M.
35548 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
35549 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
35550 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
35551 always output in octal.
35553 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
35554 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
35555 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
35557 .vitem &*opt_time*&
35558 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
35559 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
35562 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
35563 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
35567 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
35568 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
35569 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
35570 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
35571 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
35572 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
35573 C variables are as follows:
35576 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
35577 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
35578 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
35580 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
35581 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
35582 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
35584 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
35585 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
35586 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
35587 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
35590 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
35591 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
35592 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
35595 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
35596 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
35600 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
35601 selected, you should use code like this:
35603 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35604 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35606 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
35607 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
35608 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
35610 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
35611 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
35614 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
35615 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
35617 .vitem &*const&~uschar&~*headers_charset*&
35618 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
35620 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
35621 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
35622 &%-bh%& command line option.
35624 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
35625 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
35626 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
35628 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
35629 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
35630 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
35631 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
35633 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
35634 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
35635 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
35637 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
35638 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35640 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
35641 The number of accepted recipients.
35643 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
35644 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
35645 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
35646 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
35647 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
35648 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
35649 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
35650 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
35651 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
35652 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
35653 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
35654 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
35656 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
35657 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
35659 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
35660 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
35661 locally-submitted messages.
35663 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
35664 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
35665 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
35667 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
35668 The name of the sending host, if known.
35670 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
35671 The port on the sending host.
35673 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
35674 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
35676 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
35677 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
35679 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
35680 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
35681 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
35685 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
35686 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
35687 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
35688 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
35693 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
35694 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
35696 .vitem &*int&~type*&
35697 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
35698 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
35699 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
35700 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
35701 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
35702 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
35704 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
35705 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
35708 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
35709 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
35710 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
35715 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
35716 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
35719 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
35720 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
35722 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
35723 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
35724 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
35725 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
35727 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
35728 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
35729 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
35730 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
35731 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
35732 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
35733 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
35734 is NULL for all recipients.
35739 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
35740 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
35741 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
35742 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
35746 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
35747 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
35749 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
35750 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
35751 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
35752 for the process in &%newumask%&.
35754 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
35755 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
35756 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
35757 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
35758 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
35760 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
35762 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
35763 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
35764 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
35765 return value is as follows:
35770 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
35776 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
35782 The process timed out.
35786 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
35789 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
35790 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
35791 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
35792 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
35793 forks a subprocess that is running
35795 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
35797 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
35798 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
35799 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
35800 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
35802 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
35803 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
35804 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
35805 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
35808 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
35809 *sender_authentication)*&
35810 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
35813 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
35815 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
35818 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
35819 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
35820 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
35821 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
35822 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
35824 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35825 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35828 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
35829 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
35830 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
35831 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
35832 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
35833 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
35834 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
35835 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
35837 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
35838 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
35839 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
35840 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
35841 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
35842 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
35844 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
35845 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
35846 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
35847 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
35849 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
35850 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
35851 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
35852 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
35853 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
35854 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
35855 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
35856 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
35857 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
35858 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
35860 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
35861 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
35863 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
35864 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
35867 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
35868 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
35869 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
35870 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
35871 match the specification, the function does nothing.
35874 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
35875 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
35876 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
35877 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
35878 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
35879 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
35881 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
35883 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
35884 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
35885 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
35886 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
35887 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
35890 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
35891 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
35892 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
35893 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
35894 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
35895 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
35896 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
35897 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
35899 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
35900 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
35901 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
35902 .itable none 0 0 2 15* left 85* left
35903 .irow &`OK`& "match succeeded"
35904 .irow &`FAIL`& "match failed"
35905 .irow &`DEFER`& "match deferred"
35907 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
35908 inability to contact a database.
35910 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
35912 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
35913 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
35914 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
35916 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
35918 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
35919 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
35920 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
35922 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
35924 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
35927 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
35929 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
35930 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
35931 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
35932 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
35933 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
35934 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
35937 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
35939 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
35940 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
35941 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
35942 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
35943 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
35944 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
35947 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
35948 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
35949 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
35950 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
35952 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
35953 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
35954 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
35955 value afterwards. For example:
35957 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
35958 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
35959 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
35962 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
35963 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
35964 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
35965 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
35972 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
35973 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
35974 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
35975 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
35976 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
35977 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
35978 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
35979 binary string is returned with an error message.
35981 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
35982 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
35983 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
35985 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
35986 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
35987 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
35988 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
35989 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
35991 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
35992 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
35993 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
35995 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
35996 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
35997 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
35998 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
36002 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
36003 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
36006 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
36007 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
36008 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
36009 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
36010 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
36011 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
36012 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
36013 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
36016 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
36017 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
36019 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
36020 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
36021 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
36022 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
36024 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
36025 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
36026 ABI version number was incremented.
36028 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
36029 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
36030 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
36031 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
36032 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
36033 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
36034 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
36036 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
36037 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
36039 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
36040 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
36041 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
36042 multiple output lines.
36044 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
36046 guarantee a flush of
36047 pending output, and therefore does not test
36048 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
36049 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
36050 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
36051 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
36052 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
36055 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
36056 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
36057 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
36058 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
36059 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
36060 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
36061 Exim bombs out if it ever
36062 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36064 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
36065 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
36066 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36068 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
36071 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
36074 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
36075 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
36076 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
36077 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
36078 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
36079 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
36085 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
36086 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
36087 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
36088 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
36089 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
36090 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
36091 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
36094 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
36095 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
36096 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
36097 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
36099 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
36100 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
36102 store_pool = POOL_PERM
36104 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
36105 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
36106 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
36107 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
36109 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
36110 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
36111 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
36112 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
36119 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36120 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36122 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
36123 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
36124 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
36125 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
36126 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
36127 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
36128 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
36129 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
36131 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
36132 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
36133 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
36134 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
36135 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
36137 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
36138 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
36139 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
36140 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
36141 .cindex retry condition
36142 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
36143 prevent it happening on retries.
36145 .vindex "&$domain$&"
36146 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36147 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
36148 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
36149 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
36150 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
36151 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
36152 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
36155 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
36156 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
36157 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
36158 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
36159 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
36160 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
36161 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
36163 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
36164 system_filter_user = exim
36166 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
36167 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
36168 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
36169 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
36170 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
36171 by the &%reply%& command.
36174 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
36175 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
36176 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
36177 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
36179 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
36180 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
36184 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
36185 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
36186 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
36187 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
36188 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
36189 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
36192 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
36193 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
36194 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
36195 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
36196 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
36197 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
36198 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
36200 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
36201 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
36202 succeed, it will not be tried again.
36203 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
36204 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
36206 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
36207 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
36208 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
36209 to which users' filter files can refer.
36213 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
36214 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
36215 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
36216 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
36217 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
36221 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
36222 .cindex "freezing messages"
36223 .cindex "message" "freezing"
36224 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
36225 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
36226 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
36227 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
36228 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
36229 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
36230 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
36231 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
36232 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
36234 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
36236 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
36238 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
36239 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
36240 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
36241 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
36242 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
36245 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
36246 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
36247 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
36248 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
36250 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
36251 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
36252 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
36253 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
36254 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
36255 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
36256 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
36257 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
36258 message. For example:
36260 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
36261 because it contains attachments that we are \
36262 not prepared to receive."
36265 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
36266 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
36267 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
36268 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
36269 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
36270 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
36273 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
36274 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
36276 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
36277 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
36278 generated by the filter.
36280 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
36282 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
36283 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
36289 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
36290 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
36295 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
36296 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
36297 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
36298 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
36299 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
36301 headers add <string>
36302 headers remove <string>
36304 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
36305 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
36306 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
36307 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
36308 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
36310 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
36311 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
36312 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
36315 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
36316 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
36319 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
36320 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
36321 space after input continuations is ignored.
36323 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
36324 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
36325 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
36326 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
36327 header with the same name, they are all removed.
36329 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
36330 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
36331 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
36332 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
36333 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
36334 used for all recipients of the message.
36336 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
36337 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
36338 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
36339 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
36340 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
36341 until the message is actually being written (see section
36342 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
36344 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
36345 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
36346 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
36347 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
36348 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
36349 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
36350 modified more than once.
36352 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
36353 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
36356 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
36357 headers remove "Subject"
36358 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
36359 headers remove "Old-Subject"
36364 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
36365 .cindex "envelope from"
36366 .cindex "envelope sender"
36367 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
36369 errors_to <some address>
36371 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
36372 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
36373 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
36376 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
36378 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
36379 address if its delivery failed.
36383 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
36384 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
36385 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
36386 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
36387 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
36388 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
36389 such as &$local_part_data$& and &$domain_data$& can be used,
36390 and indeed, the choice of filter file could be made dependent on them.
36391 This is an example of a router which implements such a filter:
36396 domains = +local_domains
36397 file = /central/filters/$local_part_data
36402 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
36403 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
36404 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
36405 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
36407 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
36408 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
36409 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
36410 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
36412 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
36413 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
36414 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
36421 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36422 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36424 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
36425 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
36426 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
36427 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
36428 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
36429 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
36430 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
36431 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
36433 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
36434 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
36435 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
36436 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
36437 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
36439 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
36440 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
36441 loopback interface specially in any way.
36443 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
36444 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
36449 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
36450 .cindex "message" "submission"
36451 .cindex "submission mode"
36452 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
36453 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
36454 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
36455 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
36457 control = submission
36459 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
36460 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
36461 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
36462 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
36463 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
36464 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
36466 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
36467 control = submission
36469 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
36470 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
36471 is used to separate options. For example:
36473 control = submission/sender_retain
36475 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
36476 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
36477 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
36478 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
36479 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
36480 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
36481 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
36483 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
36484 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
36487 control = submission/domain=some.domain
36489 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
36490 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
36491 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
36492 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
36494 accept authenticated = *
36495 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
36496 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
36497 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
36499 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
36500 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
36501 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
36503 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
36505 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
36508 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
36510 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
36511 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
36512 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
36513 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
36515 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
36516 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
36517 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
36518 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
36519 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
36520 spoof another's address.
36522 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
36523 .cindex "line endings"
36524 .cindex "carriage return"
36526 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
36527 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
36528 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
36529 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
36530 use CRLF or just CR.
36532 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
36533 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
36534 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
36535 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
36536 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
36537 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
36538 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
36539 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
36543 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
36546 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
36547 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
36550 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
36551 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
36552 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
36553 people trying to play silly games.
36555 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
36556 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
36557 line and a bare LF in a body line is replaced with a space.
36559 If the first header line received in a message does not end with CRLF, a subsequent
36560 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
36567 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
36568 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
36569 .cindex "address" "qualification"
36570 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
36571 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
36572 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
36573 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
36574 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
36576 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
36577 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
36578 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
36579 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
36580 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
36582 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
36583 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
36584 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
36585 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
36586 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
36587 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
36588 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
36589 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
36594 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
36595 .cindex "&""From""& line"
36596 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
36597 .cindex "sender" "address"
36598 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
36599 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
36600 .cindex "envelope from"
36601 .cindex "envelope sender"
36602 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36603 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
36604 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
36605 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
36607 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
36608 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
36610 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
36611 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
36612 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
36613 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
36614 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
36615 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
36616 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
36617 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
36618 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
36620 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
36621 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
36622 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
36623 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
36624 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
36625 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
36626 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
36628 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
36629 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
36630 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
36632 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
36633 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
36634 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
36635 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
36639 .section "Header lines"
36640 .subsection "Resent- header lines" SECID220
36642 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
36643 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
36644 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
36645 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
36646 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
36649 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
36650 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
36653 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
36654 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
36658 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
36659 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
36661 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
36662 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
36663 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
36665 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
36668 For a locally-submitted message,
36669 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
36670 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
36671 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
36672 included in log lines in this case.
36674 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
36675 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
36681 .subsection Auto-Submitted: SECID221
36682 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
36683 includes the header line:
36685 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
36688 .subsection Bcc: SECID222
36689 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
36690 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
36691 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
36692 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
36693 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
36696 .subsection Date: SECID223
36698 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
36699 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
36700 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
36702 .subsection Delivery-date: SECID224
36703 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
36704 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
36705 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
36706 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
36707 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
36708 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
36709 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
36713 .subsection Envelope-to: SECID225
36714 .chindex Envelope-to:
36715 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
36716 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
36717 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
36718 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
36719 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
36720 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
36724 .subsection From: SECTthefrohea
36726 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36727 .cindex "message" "submission"
36728 .cindex "submission mode"
36729 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
36730 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
36733 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
36734 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
36736 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
36737 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
36739 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
36740 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
36741 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
36743 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
36744 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
36746 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
36747 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
36751 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
36753 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
36754 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
36755 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
36756 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
36757 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
36758 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
36759 &%qualify_domain%&.
36761 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
36762 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
36763 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
36764 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
36767 .subsection Message-ID: SECID226
36768 .chindex Message-ID:
36769 .cindex "message" "submission"
36770 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
36771 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
36772 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
36773 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
36774 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
36775 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
36776 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
36777 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
36778 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
36779 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
36782 .subsection Received: SECID227
36784 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
36785 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
36786 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
36788 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
36789 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
36790 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
36791 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
36793 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
36794 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
36795 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
36798 .subsection References: SECID228
36799 .chindex References:
36800 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
36801 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
36802 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
36803 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
36804 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
36805 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
36806 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
36807 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
36808 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
36812 .subsection Return-path: SECID229
36813 .chindex Return-path:
36814 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
36815 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
36816 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
36817 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
36818 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
36819 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
36823 .subsection Sender: SECTthesenhea
36824 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
36825 .cindex "message" "submission"
36827 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
36828 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
36829 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
36830 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
36833 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
36834 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
36835 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
36836 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
36837 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
36838 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
36839 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
36840 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
36841 line is added to the message.
36843 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
36844 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
36845 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
36846 options true at the same time.
36848 .cindex "submission mode"
36849 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
36850 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
36851 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
36852 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
36854 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
36855 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
36856 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
36857 created as follows:
36860 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
36861 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
36862 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
36864 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
36865 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
36867 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
36868 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
36871 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
36872 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
36873 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
36874 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
36876 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
36877 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
36878 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
36879 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
36883 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
36884 "SECTheadersaddrem"
36885 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
36886 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
36887 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
36888 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
36889 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
36890 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
36891 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
36893 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
36894 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
36895 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
36896 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
36897 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
36898 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
36900 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
36901 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
36902 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
36904 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
36905 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
36906 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
36908 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
36909 X-added-second: another added header line
36911 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
36913 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
36914 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
36915 Each header-line is separately expanded.
36917 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
36918 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
36919 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
36920 not part of the names. For example:
36922 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
36925 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
36926 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
36927 Each item is separately expanded.
36928 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
36929 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
36930 will act as list separators.
36932 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
36933 items are expanded at routing time,
36934 and then associated with all addresses that are
36935 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
36936 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
36937 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
36939 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
36940 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
36941 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
36942 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
36944 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
36945 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
36946 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
36949 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
36950 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
36951 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
36952 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
36953 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
36954 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
36955 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
36957 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
36958 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
36959 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
36960 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
36962 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
36963 the following consequences:
36966 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
36967 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
36968 to it, at all times.
36970 Header lines that are added by a router's
36971 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
36972 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
36974 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
36975 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
36977 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
36978 a later router or by a transport.
36980 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
36981 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
36983 headers_remove = subject
36984 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
36988 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
36989 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
36995 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
36996 .cindex "address" "constructed"
36997 .cindex "constructed address"
36998 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
37001 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
37005 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
37007 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
37008 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
37009 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
37010 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
37011 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
37012 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
37013 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
37014 there is no password file entry.
37017 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
37018 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
37019 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
37020 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
37021 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
37022 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
37023 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
37024 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
37028 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
37029 .cindex "case of local parts"
37030 .cindex "local part" "case of"
37031 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
37032 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
37033 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
37034 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
37035 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
37036 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
37039 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
37040 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
37041 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
37042 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
37043 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
37047 domains = +local_domains
37048 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
37049 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
37052 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
37053 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
37054 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
37055 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
37056 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
37060 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
37061 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
37062 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
37063 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
37064 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
37065 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
37066 empty components for compatibility.
37070 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
37071 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
37072 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
37073 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
37074 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
37075 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
37077 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
37078 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
37079 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
37080 example, a header such as
37084 might get rewritten as
37086 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
37088 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
37089 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
37092 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
37093 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
37094 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
37095 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
37096 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
37097 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
37098 .ecindex IIDmesproc
37102 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37103 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37105 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
37106 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
37107 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
37108 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
37109 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
37110 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
37111 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
37114 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
37116 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
37118 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
37121 For mail delivery, the following are available:
37124 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
37126 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
37129 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
37132 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
37133 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
37136 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
37137 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
37138 used to contain the envelope information.
37142 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
37143 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
37144 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
37145 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
37146 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
37149 .cindex "SIZE" "option on MAIL command"
37150 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
37151 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
37152 processing is the same in both cases.
37154 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
37155 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
37156 extension is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
37157 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
37158 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
37159 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
37160 .cindex "transport" "filter"
37161 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
37162 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
37165 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
37166 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
37167 required for the transaction.
37169 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
37170 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
37171 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
37172 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
37173 is called for verification.
37175 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
37176 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
37177 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
37179 .cindex "carriage return"
37181 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37182 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
37183 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37186 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
37187 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
37188 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
37189 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
37190 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
37191 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
37192 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
37193 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
37194 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
37196 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
37197 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
37198 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
37199 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
37201 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
37202 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
37203 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
37204 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
37206 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37207 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
37208 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
37209 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
37210 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
37211 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
37212 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
37213 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
37214 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
37215 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
37217 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
37218 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
37220 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37221 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
37222 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
37223 square bracket of the IP address.
37228 .subsection "Errors in outgoing SMTP" SECToutSMTPerr
37229 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
37230 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
37231 .cindex "host" "error"
37232 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
37233 message errors, and recipient errors.
37236 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
37237 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
37238 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
37241 Connection refused or timed out,
37243 Any error response code on connection,
37245 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
37247 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
37249 I/O errors at any time,
37251 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
37252 the &"."& at the end of the data.
37255 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
37256 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
37257 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
37258 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
37259 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
37260 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
37261 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
37262 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
37264 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
37265 .cindex "message" "error"
37266 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
37267 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
37268 message errors are:
37271 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
37274 Timeout after MAIL,
37276 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
37277 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
37278 connection at any other time.
37281 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
37282 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
37283 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
37284 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
37285 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
37286 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
37287 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
37288 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
37289 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
37290 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
37292 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
37293 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
37294 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
37297 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
37298 .cindex "recipient" "error"
37299 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
37300 recipient errors are:
37303 Any error response to RCPT,
37305 Timeout after RCPT.
37308 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
37309 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
37310 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
37311 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
37312 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
37313 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
37314 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
37315 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
37316 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
37317 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
37318 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
37319 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
37320 the retry clock is reset.
37322 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
37323 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
37324 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
37325 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
37326 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
37327 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
37328 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
37329 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
37330 recipient's retry time.
37333 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
37334 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
37335 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
37336 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
37337 until the next delivery attempt.
37339 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
37340 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
37341 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
37342 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
37343 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
37346 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
37347 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
37348 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
37349 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
37350 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
37351 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
37352 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
37354 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
37355 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
37356 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
37357 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
37358 then to be treated as a host error.
37360 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
37361 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
37362 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
37363 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
37364 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
37369 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
37370 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
37371 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
37374 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
37375 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
37376 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
37378 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
37380 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
37381 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
37382 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
37383 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
37384 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
37385 stream and exits with an error code.
37387 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
37388 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
37389 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
37390 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
37392 .cindex "carriage return"
37394 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37395 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
37396 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37398 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
37399 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
37400 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
37402 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
37403 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
37404 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
37405 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
37406 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
37407 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
37408 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
37409 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
37411 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
37412 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
37413 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
37414 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
37415 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
37416 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
37417 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
37418 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
37419 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
37421 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
37422 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
37423 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
37425 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
37426 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
37427 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
37428 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
37429 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
37431 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
37432 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
37433 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
37434 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
37435 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
37436 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
37437 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
37439 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
37440 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
37441 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
37442 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
37443 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
37445 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
37446 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
37447 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
37448 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
37449 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
37450 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
37451 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
37452 a delivery process.
37454 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
37455 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
37456 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
37457 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
37458 however, available with &'inetd'&.
37460 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
37461 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
37462 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
37463 section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&.
37465 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
37466 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
37467 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
37471 .subsection "Unrecognized SMTP commands" SECID234
37472 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
37473 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
37474 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
37475 the error response to the last command. The default value for
37476 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
37477 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
37478 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
37481 .subsection "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" SECID235
37482 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
37483 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
37484 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
37485 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
37486 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
37487 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
37488 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
37489 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
37490 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
37491 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
37495 .subsection "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" SECID236
37496 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
37497 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
37498 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
37499 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
37500 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
37501 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
37502 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
37504 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
37505 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
37506 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
37507 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
37508 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
37511 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
37512 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
37513 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
37515 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
37516 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
37517 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
37518 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
37519 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
37524 .subsection "The VRFY and EXPN commands" SECID237
37525 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
37526 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
37527 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
37529 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
37530 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
37531 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
37532 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
37533 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
37534 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
37535 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
37536 SMTP response codes.
37538 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
37539 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
37540 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
37541 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
37542 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
37543 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
37544 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
37545 VRFY verification failures are logged in the main log for consistency with
37550 .subsection "The ETRN command" SECTETRN
37551 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
37552 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
37553 RFC 1985 describes an ESMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
37554 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
37555 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
37556 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
37557 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
37559 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
37560 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
37561 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
37562 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
37563 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
37564 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
37565 argument. For example,
37573 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
37574 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
37575 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
37576 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
37577 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
37579 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
37580 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
37581 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
37582 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
37583 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
37584 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
37585 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
37586 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
37588 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
37589 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
37590 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
37591 whatever the form of its argument. For
37594 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
37595 $sender_host_address
37597 .vindex "&$domain$&"
37598 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
37599 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
37600 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
37601 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
37602 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
37603 for it to change them before running the command.
37607 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
37608 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
37609 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
37610 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
37611 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
37612 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
37613 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
37614 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
37615 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
37616 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
37617 runs for RCPT commands:
37621 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
37625 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
37626 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
37627 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
37628 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
37629 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
37630 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
37631 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
37632 envelope along with the message.
37634 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
37635 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
37636 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
37637 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
37638 can be used to specify it.
37640 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
37641 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
37642 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
37643 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
37644 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
37647 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
37648 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
37649 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
37654 driver = manualroute
37655 transport = smtp_appendfile
37656 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
37660 driver = appendfile
37661 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
37666 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
37667 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
37668 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
37672 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
37673 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
37674 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
37675 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
37676 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
37677 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
37678 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
37679 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
37680 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
37681 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
37683 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
37684 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
37686 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
37687 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
37688 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
37689 make some use of automatically, for example:
37691 554 Unexpected end of file
37692 Transaction started in line 10
37693 Error detected in line 14
37695 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
37698 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
37699 The error message was:
37701 501 '>' missing at end of address
37703 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
37704 The error was detected in line 12.
37705 The SMTP command at fault was:
37707 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
37709 1 previous message was successfully processed.
37710 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
37712 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
37713 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
37715 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
37716 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
37720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37721 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37723 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
37724 "Customizing messages"
37725 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
37726 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
37727 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
37728 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
37729 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
37731 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
37732 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
37733 option. Exim also adds the line
37735 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
37737 to all warning and bounce messages,
37740 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
37741 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
37742 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
37743 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
37744 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
37745 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
37746 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
37748 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
37749 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
37750 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
37751 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
37752 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
37755 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
37756 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
37757 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
37758 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
37759 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
37760 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
37761 option, rounded to a whole number.
37763 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
37766 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
37767 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
37769 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
37770 failing addresses with their error messages.
37772 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
37773 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
37775 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
37776 The fields exist for back-compatibility
37779 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
37780 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
37781 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
37783 Subject: Mail delivery failed
37784 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
37785 {: returning message to sender}}
37787 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
37789 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
37790 {that you sent }{sent by
37794 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
37795 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
37797 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
37799 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
37802 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
37804 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
37807 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
37808 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
37809 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
37810 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
37811 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
37815 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
37816 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
37818 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
37819 the delayed addresses.
37821 The third item then ends the message.
37824 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
37825 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
37827 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
37828 $warn_message_delay
37830 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
37832 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
37833 {that you sent }{sent by
37837 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
37838 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
37840 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
37841 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
37842 The date of the message is: $h_date
37844 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
37846 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
37847 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
37848 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
37849 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
37850 the message will be returned to you.
37852 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
37853 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
37854 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
37855 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
37856 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
37857 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
37858 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
37859 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
37865 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37868 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
37869 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
37870 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
37874 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
37875 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
37876 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
37877 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
37878 routing explicitly:
37880 send_to_smart_host:
37881 driver = manualroute
37882 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
37883 transport = remote_smtp
37885 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
37886 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
37887 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
37888 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
37889 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
37894 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
37895 .cindex "mailing lists"
37896 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
37897 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
37898 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
37900 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
37901 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
37902 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
37903 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
37907 domains = lists.example
37908 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
37911 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
37914 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
37915 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
37916 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
37917 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
37919 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
37920 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
37923 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
37924 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
37925 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
37926 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
37927 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
37929 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
37930 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
37931 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
37932 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
37933 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
37934 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
37935 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
37936 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
37937 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
37941 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
37942 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
37943 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
37944 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
37945 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
37946 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
37947 addresses are not rigorously checked.
37949 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
37950 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
37951 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
37952 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
37953 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
37957 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
37958 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
37959 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
37960 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
37961 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
37962 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
37963 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
37964 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
37965 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
37966 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
37968 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
37969 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
37970 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
37971 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
37972 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
37973 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
37974 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
37975 pre-existing messages.
37977 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
37978 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
37979 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
37980 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
37981 one level of expansion anyway.
37985 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
37986 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
37987 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
37988 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
37989 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
37990 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
37992 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
37993 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
37997 domains = lists.example
37998 local_part_suffix = -request
37999 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
38000 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
38005 domains = lists.example
38006 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38007 senders = ${if exists {$local_part_data} {lsearch;$local_part_data}{*}}
38008 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38011 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38016 domains = lists.example
38018 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
38020 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
38021 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
38022 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
38025 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
38026 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
38027 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
38028 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
38029 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
38030 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
38031 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
38032 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
38033 &"unrouteable address"& error.
38035 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
38036 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
38037 the address, giving a suitable error message.
38042 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
38044 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
38045 .cindex "envelope from"
38046 .cindex "envelope sender"
38047 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
38048 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
38049 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
38050 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
38051 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
38052 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
38054 .oindex &%errors_to%&
38055 .oindex &%return_path%&
38056 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
38057 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
38058 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
38059 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
38060 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
38061 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
38062 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
38068 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38069 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38071 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
38072 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
38073 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
38074 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
38075 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
38076 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
38077 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
38080 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
38082 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
38083 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
38084 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
38085 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
38086 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
38087 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
38089 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
38090 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
38091 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
38092 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
38096 domains = ! +local_domains
38098 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38099 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
38102 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
38103 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
38104 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
38105 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
38108 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
38109 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
38110 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
38111 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
38112 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
38116 domains = ! +local_domains
38117 transport = remote_smtp
38119 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
38120 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38123 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
38124 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
38125 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
38126 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
38129 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
38130 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
38131 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
38132 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
38133 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
38134 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
38142 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
38143 .cindex "virtual domains"
38144 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
38145 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
38149 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
38150 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
38151 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
38153 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
38154 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
38155 have login accounts on that host.
38158 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
38159 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
38160 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
38161 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
38162 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
38163 to a router of this form:
38167 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
38168 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
38171 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
38172 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
38173 domain that is being processed.
38174 The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
38175 being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
38177 When the router runs, it looks up the local
38178 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
38179 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
38180 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
38182 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
38183 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
38184 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
38185 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
38187 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
38188 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
38189 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
38193 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
38194 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
38195 transport = my_mailboxes
38197 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
38198 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
38199 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
38200 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
38201 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
38205 driver = appendfile
38206 file = /var/mail/$domain_data/$local_part_data
38209 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
38210 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
38212 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
38213 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
38214 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
38215 information about the domains.
38219 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
38220 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
38221 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
38222 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
38223 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
38224 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
38225 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
38226 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
38227 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
38228 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
38229 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
38230 example, consider this router:
38235 file = $home/.forward
38236 local_part_suffix = -*
38237 local_part_suffix_optional
38240 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
38241 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
38242 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
38243 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
38245 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
38246 save /home/$local_part_data/Mail/special
38249 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
38250 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
38251 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
38252 control over which suffixes are valid.
38254 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
38255 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
38261 local_part_suffix = -*
38262 local_part_suffix_optional
38263 file = ${lookup {.forward$local_part_suffix} dsearch,ret=full {$home} {$value}fail}
38266 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
38267 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
38268 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
38269 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
38270 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
38274 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
38275 .cindex "vacation processing"
38276 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
38277 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
38278 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
38279 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
38280 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
38283 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
38284 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
38285 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
38286 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
38288 spqr, vacation-spqr
38291 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
38292 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
38293 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
38294 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
38295 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
38299 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
38300 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
38304 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
38305 .cindex "message" "copying every"
38306 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
38307 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
38308 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
38309 each day's messages.
38311 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
38312 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
38313 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
38314 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
38318 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
38319 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
38320 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
38321 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
38322 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
38323 permanently connected.
38325 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
38326 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
38327 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
38330 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
38331 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
38332 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
38333 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
38334 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
38335 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
38336 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
38337 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
38339 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
38340 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
38341 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
38342 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
38343 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
38344 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
38347 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
38348 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
38349 intermittent host. For example:
38351 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
38353 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
38354 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
38355 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
38356 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
38357 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
38358 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
38361 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
38362 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
38363 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
38364 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
38365 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
38366 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
38367 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
38371 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
38372 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
38373 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
38374 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
38375 delivered immediately.
38377 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
38378 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
38379 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
38380 .cindex "first pass routing"
38381 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
38382 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
38383 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
38384 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
38385 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
38386 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
38387 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
38388 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
38389 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
38390 single SMTP connection.
38394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38395 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38397 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
38398 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
38399 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
38400 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
38401 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
38402 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
38403 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
38404 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
38405 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
38406 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
38409 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
38410 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
38411 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
38412 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
38413 email is not desirable.
38415 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
38416 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
38417 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
38418 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
38419 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
38420 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
38421 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
38423 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
38424 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
38425 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
38426 before sending a message to the smart host.
38428 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
38429 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
38430 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
38432 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
38433 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
38434 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
38435 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
38436 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
38437 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
38438 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
38440 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
38444 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
38445 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
38447 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
38448 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
38449 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
38450 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
38451 successful, a zero return code is given.
38453 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
38454 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
38455 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
38456 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
38457 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
38460 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
38461 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
38462 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
38464 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
38465 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
38466 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
38467 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
38468 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
38470 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
38471 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
38472 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
38474 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
38475 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
38476 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
38477 are ever generated.
38479 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
38481 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
38482 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
38483 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
38486 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
38487 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
38488 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
38489 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
38490 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
38491 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
38496 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38497 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38499 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
38500 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
38501 .cindex "log" "types of"
38502 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
38507 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
38508 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
38509 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
38510 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
38511 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
38512 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
38513 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
38514 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
38516 .cindex "reject log"
38517 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
38518 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
38519 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
38520 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
38521 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
38522 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
38523 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
38524 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
38525 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
38528 .cindex "panic log"
38529 .cindex "system log"
38530 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
38531 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
38532 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
38533 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
38534 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
38535 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
38536 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
38537 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
38538 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
38541 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
38542 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
38543 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
38545 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
38548 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
38549 ways of changing this:
38552 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
38557 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
38559 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
38562 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
38566 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
38567 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
38568 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
38569 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
38570 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
38571 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
38576 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
38577 .cindex "log" "destination"
38578 .cindex "log" "to file"
38579 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
38581 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
38582 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
38583 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
38584 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
38585 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
38586 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
38587 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
38589 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
38590 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
38591 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
38592 references to the host name:
38594 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
38596 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
38597 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
38598 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
38599 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
38600 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
38603 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
38604 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
38605 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
38606 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
38607 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
38608 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
38609 implying the use of a default path.
38611 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
38612 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
38613 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
38614 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. If no such item exists, log
38615 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
38616 equivalent to the configuration file setting:
38618 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
38620 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
38621 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
38622 that is where the logs are written.
38624 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
38625 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
38627 Here are some examples of possible Makefile settings:
38629 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
38630 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
38631 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
38632 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
38634 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
38639 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
38640 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38641 .cindex "cycling logs"
38642 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38643 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
38644 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
38645 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
38646 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
38647 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
38648 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
38650 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
38651 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
38652 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
38653 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
38654 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
38655 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
38656 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
38657 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
38658 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
38659 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
38660 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
38665 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
38666 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
38667 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
38668 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
38669 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
38670 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
38671 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
38672 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
38674 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
38675 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
38676 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
38677 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
38679 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
38680 examples of names generated by the above examples:
38682 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
38683 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
38684 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
38685 /var/log/exim/main.200212
38687 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
38688 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
38689 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
38690 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
38692 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
38693 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
38694 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
38695 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
38696 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
38697 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
38700 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
38701 /var/log/exim-panic.log
38702 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
38703 /var/log/exim/panic
38707 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
38708 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
38709 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
38710 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
38711 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
38712 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
38713 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
38714 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
38715 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
38716 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
38717 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
38718 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
38719 the time and host name to each line.
38720 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
38723 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
38725 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
38727 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
38730 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
38731 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
38732 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
38733 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
38735 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
38736 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
38737 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
38738 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
38739 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
38740 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
38741 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
38742 RFC 3164, you should set
38744 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
38746 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
38747 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
38749 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
38750 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
38751 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
38752 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
38753 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
38754 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
38755 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
38756 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
38757 name, and pid as added by syslog:
38759 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
38760 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
38761 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
38762 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
38765 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
38768 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
38769 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
38770 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
38771 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
38773 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
38774 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
38775 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
38776 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
38777 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
38778 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
38780 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
38781 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
38782 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
38785 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
38787 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
38788 without modification.
38790 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
38791 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
38792 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
38797 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
38798 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
38799 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
38800 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
38801 timestamp. The flags are:
38802 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
38803 .irow &%<=%& "message arrival"
38804 .irow &%(=%& "message fakereject"
38805 .irow &%=>%& "normal message delivery"
38806 .irow &%->%& "additional address in same delivery"
38807 .irow &%>>%& "cutthrough message delivery"
38808 .irow &%*>%& "delivery suppressed by &%-N%&"
38809 .irow &%**%& "delivery failed; address bounced"
38810 .irow &%==%& "delivery deferred; temporary problem"
38814 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
38815 .cindex "log" "reception line"
38816 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
38817 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
38818 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
38820 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
38821 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
38822 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
38824 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
38825 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
38826 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
38830 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
38834 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
38835 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
38836 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
38837 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
38838 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
38839 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
38840 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
38841 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
38842 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
38843 name in parentheses.
38845 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
38846 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
38847 the log containing text like these examples:
38849 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
38850 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
38852 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
38855 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
38856 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
38859 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
38860 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
38861 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
38862 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
38863 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
38864 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
38865 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
38866 suite that was used.
38868 .cindex log protocol
38869 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
38870 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
38871 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
38872 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
38873 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
38874 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
38875 authenticator name.
38877 .cindex "size" "of message"
38878 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
38879 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
38880 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
38881 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
38884 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
38885 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
38889 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
38890 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
38891 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
38892 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
38893 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
38894 to fit it on the page:
38896 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
38897 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
38898 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
38899 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
38900 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
38902 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
38903 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
38904 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
38905 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
38906 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
38908 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
38909 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
38910 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
38911 option, this is logged too, as a second colon-separated list item.
38912 Optionally (see the &%smtp_mailauth%& &%log_selector%&) there may be a third list item.
38914 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
38915 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
38917 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
38919 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
38920 parentheses afterwards.
38922 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
38923 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
38924 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
38925 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
38926 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
38927 remote IP address (and port if enabled)
38928 in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
38929 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
38930 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
38931 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
38932 TLS cipher information is still available.
38934 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
38935 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
38936 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
38937 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
38938 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
38940 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
38941 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
38943 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
38944 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
38947 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
38948 .cindex "discarded messages"
38949 .cindex "message" "discarded"
38950 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
38951 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
38952 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
38954 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
38955 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
38957 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
38958 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
38960 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
38961 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
38965 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
38966 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
38968 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
38969 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
38971 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
38972 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
38973 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
38975 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
38976 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
38978 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
38979 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
38980 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
38984 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
38985 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
38986 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
38987 following form is logged:
38989 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
38990 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
38992 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
38993 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
38995 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
38996 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
38997 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
38998 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
38999 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
39001 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
39002 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
39003 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
39004 flagged with &`**`&.
39008 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
39009 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
39010 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
39011 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
39012 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
39016 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
39019 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
39021 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
39022 at the end of its processing.
39027 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
39028 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
39029 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
39030 the following table:
39032 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
39033 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
39034 &`Ci `& connection identifier
39035 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39036 &`CV `& certificate verification status
39037 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39038 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
39039 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
39040 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
39041 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
39042 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
39043 &`H `& host name and IP address
39044 &`I `& local interface used
39045 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
39046 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
39047 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
39048 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
39049 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
39050 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
39051 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
39052 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
39053 &`Q `& alternate queue name
39054 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
39055 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
39056 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
39057 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
39058 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
39059 &`S `& size of message in bytes
39060 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
39061 &`ST `& shadow transport name
39062 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
39063 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
39064 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
39065 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
39066 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
39070 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
39071 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
39072 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
39075 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
39076 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
39077 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
39078 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
39079 during the first delivery attempt.
39081 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
39082 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
39083 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
39085 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
39086 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
39087 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
39088 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
39089 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
39092 .cindex "error" "ignored"
39093 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
39096 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
39097 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
39099 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
39100 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39102 A delivery set up by a router configured with
39103 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
39104 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
39108 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39111 .cindex DKIM "log line"
39112 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
39113 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
39120 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
39121 .cindex "log" "selectors"
39122 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
39123 default logging to the main log, or you can request additional logging. The value of
39124 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
39127 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
39129 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
39130 selection marked by asterisks:
39131 .itable none 0 0 3 2.8in left 10pt center 3in left
39132 .irow &`8bitmime`& "received 8BITMIME status"
39133 .irow &`acl_warn_skipped`& * "skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL"
39134 .irow &`address_rewrite`& "address rewriting"
39135 .irow &`all_parents`& "all parents in => lines"
39136 .irow &`arguments`& "command line arguments"
39137 .irow &`connection_id`& "connection identifier"
39138 .irow &`connection_reject`& * "connection rejections"
39139 .irow &`delay_delivery`& * "immediate delivery delayed"
39140 .irow &`deliver_time`& "time taken to attempt delivery"
39141 .irow &`delivery_size`& "add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines"
39142 .irow &`dkim`& * "DKIM verified domain on <= lines"
39143 .irow &`dkim_verbose`& "separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature; DKIM signing"
39144 .irow &`dnslist_defer`& * "defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups"
39145 .irow &`dnssec`& "DNSSEC secured lookups"
39146 .irow &`etrn`& * "ETRN commands"
39147 .irow &`host_lookup_failed`& * "as it says"
39148 .irow &`ident_timeout`& "timeout for ident connection"
39149 .irow &`incoming_interface`& "local interface & port on <= and => lines"
39150 .irow &`incoming_port`& "remote port on <= lines"
39151 .irow &`lost_incoming_connection`& * "as it says (includes timeouts)"
39152 .irow &`millisec`& "millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times"
39153 .irow &`msg_id`& * "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value"
39154 .irow &`msg_id_created`& "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added"
39155 .irow &`outgoing_interface`& "local interface on => lines"
39156 .irow &`outgoing_port`& "add remote port to => lines"
39157 .irow &`queue_run`& * "start and end queue runs"
39158 .irow &`queue_time`& "time on queue for one recipient"
39159 .irow &`queue_time_exclusive`& "exclude recieve time from QT times"
39160 .irow &`queue_time_overall`& "time on queue for whole message"
39161 .irow &`pid`& "Exim process id"
39162 .irow &`pipelining`& "PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines"
39163 .irow &`proxy`& "proxy address on <= and => lines"
39164 .irow &`receive_time`& "time taken to receive message"
39165 .irow &`received_recipients`& "recipients on <= lines"
39166 .irow &`received_sender`& "sender on <= lines"
39167 .irow &`rejected_header`& * "header contents on reject log"
39168 .irow &`retry_defer`& * "&<quote>&retry time not reached&</quote>&"
39169 .irow &`return_path_on_delivery`& "put return path on => and ** lines"
39170 .irow &`sender_on_delivery`& "add sender to => lines"
39171 .irow &`sender_verify_fail`& * "sender verification failures"
39172 .irow &`size_reject`& * "rejection because too big"
39173 .irow &`skip_delivery`& * "delivery skipped in a queue run"
39174 .irow &`smtp_confirmation`& * "SMTP confirmation on => lines"
39175 .irow &`smtp_connection`& "incoming SMTP connections"
39176 .irow &`smtp_incomplete_transaction`& "incomplete SMTP transactions"
39177 .irow &`smtp_mailauth`& "AUTH argument to MAIL commands"
39178 .irow &`smtp_no_mail`& "session with no MAIL commands"
39179 .irow &`smtp_protocol_error`& "SMTP protocol errors"
39180 .irow &`smtp_syntax_error`& "SMTP syntax errors"
39181 .irow &`subject`& "contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines"
39182 .irow &`tls_certificate_verified`& * "certificate verification status"
39183 .irow &`tls_cipher`& * "TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines"
39184 .irow &`tls_peerdn`& "TLS peer DN on <= and => lines"
39185 .irow &`tls_resumption`& "append * to cipher field"
39186 .irow &`tls_sni`& "TLS SNI on <= lines"
39187 .irow &`unknown_in_list`& "lookup failed in list match"
39188 .irow &`all`& "&*all of the above*&"
39190 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
39191 section &<<SECID99>>&
39193 More details on each of these items follows:
39197 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
39198 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
39199 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
39200 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
39201 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
39202 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
39204 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
39205 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
39206 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
39207 this log selector is set.
39209 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
39210 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
39211 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
39212 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
39213 such users cannot access the log).
39215 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
39216 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
39217 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
39218 parentheses between them.
39220 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
39221 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
39222 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
39223 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
39224 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
39225 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
39226 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
39227 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
39228 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
39229 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
39230 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
39231 between the caller and Exim.
39233 .cindex "log" "connection identifier"
39234 &%connection_identifier%&: An identifier for the accepted connection is added to
39235 connection start and end lines and to message accept lines.
39236 The identifier is tagged by Ci=.
39237 The value is PID-based, so will reset on reboot and will wrap.
39239 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
39240 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
39241 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
39243 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
39244 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
39245 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
39246 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
39247 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
39248 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
39250 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
39251 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
39252 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
39253 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39254 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
39256 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
39257 .cindex "size" "of message"
39258 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
39259 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
39261 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39262 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39263 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
39264 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
39266 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39267 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39268 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
39270 Also, on message delivery lines signing information (domain and selector)
39271 is added, tagged with DKIM=.
39274 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
39275 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
39276 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
39277 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
39278 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
39281 .cindex dnssec logging
39282 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
39283 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
39284 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
39285 It does not cover helo-name verification.
39286 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
39288 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
39289 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
39290 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
39291 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
39292 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
39293 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
39295 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
39296 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
39297 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
39298 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
39299 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
39301 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
39302 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
39303 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
39304 client's ident port times out.
39306 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
39307 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39308 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39309 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39310 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39311 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39312 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
39313 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
39314 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
39315 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
39316 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing
39317 &"=>"&, &"->"&, &"=="& and &"**"& lines.
39318 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39320 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
39321 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
39322 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
39323 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
39324 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
39325 on a proxied connection
39326 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
39327 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
39329 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
39330 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
39331 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
39332 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
39333 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
39334 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
39335 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
39336 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
39337 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
39338 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
39339 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
39341 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
39342 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
39343 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
39345 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
39346 .cindex millisecond logging
39347 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
39348 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
39349 appended to the seconds value.
39351 .cindex "log" "message id"
39352 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
39354 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
39355 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
39356 (submission mode) without one.
39357 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
39359 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39360 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39361 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39362 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39363 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39364 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
39365 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
39366 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
39367 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39369 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
39370 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
39371 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
39372 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
39373 containing => tags) following the IP address.
39374 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
39375 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
39376 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
39377 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
39378 local port is a random ephemeral port.
39380 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
39381 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
39382 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
39383 immediately after the time and date.
39385 .cindex log pipelining
39386 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
39387 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
39388 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
39389 The field is a single "L".
39391 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
39392 the field has a minus appended.
39394 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
39395 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
39396 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
39397 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
39398 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
39401 .cindex "log" "queue run"
39402 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
39403 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
39405 .cindex "log" "queue time"
39406 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
39407 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
39409 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39410 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
39412 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
39413 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
39414 example, &`QT=3m45s`&.
39416 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
39417 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
39418 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
39419 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39420 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
39422 .cindex "log" "recipients"
39423 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
39424 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
39425 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
39426 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
39428 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
39431 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
39432 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
39433 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
39434 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
39436 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
39437 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
39438 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
39439 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
39440 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
39442 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
39443 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
39444 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
39445 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
39448 .cindex "log" "return path"
39449 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
39450 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
39451 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
39452 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
39454 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
39455 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
39456 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
39457 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
39458 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
39460 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
39461 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
39462 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
39463 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
39466 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
39467 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
39470 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
39471 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
39472 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
39473 queue run because it another process is already delivering it or because
39475 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
39476 .cindex "&""message is frozen""&"
39477 The message that is written is either &"spool file is locked"& or
39478 &"message is frozen"&.
39480 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
39481 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
39482 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
39483 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
39484 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
39485 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
39488 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
39489 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
39490 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
39491 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
39492 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
39493 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
39494 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
39495 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
39496 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
39497 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
39499 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
39500 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
39501 reset if the daemon is restarted.
39502 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
39503 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
39504 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
39505 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
39506 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
39508 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
39509 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
39510 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
39511 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
39512 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
39513 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
39515 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
39516 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
39517 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
39518 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
39519 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
39520 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
39521 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
39522 already have their own log lines.
39524 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
39525 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
39526 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
39527 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
39528 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
39529 the same logging options.
39531 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
39532 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
39536 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
39537 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
39538 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
39539 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
39540 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
39542 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
39543 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
39544 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
39545 was accepted or used.
39547 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
39548 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
39549 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
39550 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
39551 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
39552 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
39553 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
39554 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
39556 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
39557 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
39558 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
39559 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
39560 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
39561 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
39562 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
39563 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
39564 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
39566 .cindex "log" "subject"
39567 .cindex "subject, logging"
39568 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
39569 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
39570 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
39571 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
39572 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
39574 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
39576 .cindex DANE logging
39577 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
39578 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
39580 using a CA trust anchor,
39581 &`CV=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
39582 and &`CV=no`& if not.
39584 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
39585 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
39586 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39587 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
39589 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
39590 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
39591 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39592 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
39593 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
39595 .cindex "log" "TLS resumption"
39596 .cindex "TLS" "logging session resumption"
39597 &%tls_resumption%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39598 connection and the TLS session resumed one used on a previous TCP connection,
39599 an asterisk is appended to the X= cipher field in the log line.
39601 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
39602 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
39603 .cindex SNI logging
39604 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
39605 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
39606 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
39608 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
39609 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
39610 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed, or because
39611 a bad IP address was in the list.
39615 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
39616 .cindex "message" "log file for"
39617 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
39618 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
39619 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
39620 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
39621 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
39622 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
39623 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
39624 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
39625 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
39626 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
39627 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
39629 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
39630 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
39631 &%message_logs%& option false.
39637 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39640 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
39641 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
39642 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
39643 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
39644 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
39646 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
39647 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
39648 "list what Exim processes are doing"
39649 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
39650 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
39651 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
39652 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
39654 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
39655 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
39656 "extract statistics from the log"
39657 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
39658 "check address acceptance from given IP"
39659 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
39660 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
39661 .irow &<<SECTdumpdb>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
39662 .irow &<<SECTtidydb>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
39663 .irow &<<SECTfixdb>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
39664 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
39665 .irow &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>& &'exim_msgdate'& "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)"
39668 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
39669 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
39670 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
39675 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
39676 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
39677 .cindex "process, querying"
39679 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
39680 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
39681 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
39682 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
39683 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
39684 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
39685 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
39686 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
39688 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
39689 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
39690 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
39693 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
39694 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
39695 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
39696 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
39697 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
39699 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
39700 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD`& "the command for running &'ps'&"
39701 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG`& "the argument for &'ps'&"
39702 .irow &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG`& "the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output"
39703 .irow &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG`& "the argument for the &'kill'& command"
39705 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
39707 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
39708 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
39709 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
39710 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
39711 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
39712 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
39714 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
39715 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
39719 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
39720 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
39721 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
39722 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
39726 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
39730 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
39731 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
39734 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
39735 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
39736 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
39740 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
39741 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
39742 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
39744 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
39745 Match against the size field.
39747 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
39748 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
39750 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
39751 Match messages that are older than the given time.
39754 Match only frozen messages.
39757 Match only non-frozen messages.
39759 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
39760 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
39763 The following options control the format of the output:
39767 Display only the count of matching messages.
39770 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
39774 Display message ids only.
39777 Brief format &-- one line per message.
39780 Display messages in reverse order.
39783 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
39786 The following options give alternates for configuration:
39789 .vitem &*-C*&&~<&'config&~file'&>
39790 is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
39791 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
39793 .vitem &*-E*&&~<&'path'&>
39794 can be used to specify a path for the exim binary,
39795 overriding the built-in one.
39798 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
39799 At least one selection option, or either the &*-c*& or &*-h*& option, must be given.
39803 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
39804 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
39805 .cindex "queue" "summary"
39806 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
39807 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
39808 running a command such as
39810 exim -bp | exiqsumm
39812 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
39813 it, as in the following example:
39815 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
39817 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
39818 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
39819 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
39820 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
39822 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
39823 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
39824 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
39825 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
39826 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
39827 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
39830 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
39831 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
39832 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
39833 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
39834 level"& addresses).
39839 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
39841 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
39842 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
39843 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
39844 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
39845 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
39846 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
39847 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
39848 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
39849 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
39850 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
39852 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
39854 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
39856 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
39857 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
39858 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
39860 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
39861 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
39862 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
39863 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
39864 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
39866 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
39867 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
39868 regular expression.
39870 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
39871 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
39873 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
39874 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
39878 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
39879 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
39880 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
39881 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
39882 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
39883 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
39886 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
39887 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
39888 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
39889 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
39890 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
39893 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
39894 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
39895 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
39896 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
39897 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
39898 the &%--help%& option.
39901 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
39902 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
39903 .cindex "cycling logs"
39904 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
39905 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
39906 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
39907 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
39908 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
39909 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
39910 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
39912 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
39913 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
39915 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
39916 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
39917 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
39921 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
39922 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
39923 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
39924 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
39925 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
39926 logs are handled similarly.
39928 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
39929 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
39930 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
39931 any existing log files.
39933 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
39934 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
39935 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
39936 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
39937 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
39939 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
39941 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
39942 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
39946 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
39947 .cindex "statistics"
39948 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
39949 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
39950 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
39951 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
39952 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
39954 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
39955 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
39956 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
39957 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
39958 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
39960 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
39962 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
39963 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
39964 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
39965 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
39966 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
39967 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
39968 also produced per user.
39970 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
39971 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
39972 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
39973 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
39974 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
39976 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
39977 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
39978 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
39979 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
39980 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
39981 an entirely separate message.
39983 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
39984 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
39985 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
39986 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
39987 least one address that failed.
39989 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
39990 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
39991 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
39992 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
39993 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
39994 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
39995 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
39997 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
39998 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
39999 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
40001 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
40002 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
40003 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
40005 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
40008 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
40009 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
40010 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
40011 .cindex "checking access"
40012 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
40013 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
40014 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
40015 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
40016 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
40017 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
40019 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
40020 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
40022 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
40024 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
40025 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
40026 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
40027 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
40030 550 Relay not permitted
40032 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
40033 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
40034 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
40035 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
40038 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
40039 -f himself@there.example
40041 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
40042 mandatory arguments.
40044 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
40045 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
40046 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
40050 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
40051 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
40052 .cindex "building DBM files"
40053 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
40054 .cindex "lower casing"
40055 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
40056 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
40057 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
40058 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
40059 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
40060 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
40062 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
40063 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
40064 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
40065 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
40068 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
40069 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
40070 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
40074 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
40075 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
40076 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
40077 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
40079 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
40081 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
40082 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
40084 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
40085 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
40086 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
40087 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
40088 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
40089 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
40091 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
40092 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
40093 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
40094 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
40095 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
40096 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
40097 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
40103 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
40104 .cindex "retry" "times"
40105 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
40106 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
40107 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
40108 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
40109 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
40110 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
40111 output. For example:
40113 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
40114 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
40115 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40116 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40117 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
40118 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
40119 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
40120 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
40121 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
40122 past final cutoff time
40124 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
40125 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
40126 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
40127 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
40128 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
40129 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
40132 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
40133 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
40134 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
40135 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
40136 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
40137 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
40141 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
40142 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
40143 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
40144 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
40145 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
40146 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
40147 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
40150 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
40152 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
40155 &'callout'&: the callout cache
40157 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
40159 &'tls'&: TLS session resumption data
40161 &'misc'&: other hints data
40164 The &'misc'& database is used for
40167 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
40169 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
40170 &(smtp)& transport)
40172 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
40175 Recording EHLO-time facilities advertised by hosts
40180 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECTdumpdb"
40181 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
40182 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
40183 &'exim_dumpdb'& program,
40184 taking as arguments the spool and database names.
40185 An option &'-z'& may be given to request times in UTC;
40186 otherwise times are in the local timezone.
40187 An option &'-k'& may be given to dump only the record keys.
40188 For example, to dump the retry database:
40190 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
40192 For the retry database
40193 two lines of output are produced for each entry:
40195 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
40196 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
40198 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
40199 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
40200 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
40201 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
40202 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
40203 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
40204 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
40205 and a textual description of the error.
40207 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
40208 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
40209 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
40212 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
40213 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
40214 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
40215 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
40216 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
40217 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
40222 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECTtidydb"
40223 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
40224 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
40225 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
40226 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
40227 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
40228 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
40229 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
40230 updated sufficiently often.
40232 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
40233 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
40234 the retry database:
40236 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
40238 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
40239 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
40240 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
40241 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
40242 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
40243 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
40244 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
40245 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
40246 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
40247 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
40248 whenever it removes information from the database.
40250 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
40251 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
40252 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
40253 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
40254 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
40256 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
40257 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
40258 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
40259 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
40260 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
40261 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
40262 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
40265 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
40266 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
40271 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECTfixdb"
40272 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
40273 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
40274 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
40275 getting round problems in a live system. Its interface
40276 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
40277 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
40280 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
40281 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
40282 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
40283 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
40284 by new data, for example:
40288 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
40289 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
40290 used as optional separators.
40292 Both displayed and input times are in the local timezone by default.
40293 If an option &'-z'& is used on the command line, displayed times
40299 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
40300 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
40301 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
40302 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
40303 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
40304 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
40305 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
40306 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
40307 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
40308 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
40309 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
40310 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
40311 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
40315 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
40318 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
40321 .vitem &%-interval%&
40322 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
40323 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
40325 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
40326 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
40329 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
40332 Suppress verification output.
40334 .vitem &%-retries%&
40335 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
40336 the lock (default 10).
40338 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
40339 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
40340 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
40341 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
40344 .vitem &%-timeout%&
40345 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
40346 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
40347 default), a non-blocking call is used.
40350 Generate verbose output.
40353 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
40354 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
40355 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
40356 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
40357 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
40358 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
40359 more than 30 minutes old.
40361 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
40362 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
40363 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
40364 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
40365 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
40366 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
40368 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
40369 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
40370 suppresses all output except error messages.
40374 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
40376 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
40378 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
40379 <&'some commands'&>
40382 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
40383 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
40386 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
40387 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
40389 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
40390 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
40393 .section "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)" "SECTexim_msgdate"
40394 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
40395 The &'exim_msgdate'& utility is written by Andrew Aitchison and included in the Exim distribution.
40396 This Perl script converts an Exim Mesage ID back into a human readable form.
40397 For details of &'exim_msgdate'&'s options, run &'exim_msgdate'& with the &%--help%& option.
40399 Section &<<SECTmessiden>>& (Message identification) describes Exim Mesage IDs.
40401 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40402 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40404 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
40405 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
40406 .cindex "X-windows"
40407 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
40408 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
40409 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
40410 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
40411 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
40412 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
40413 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
40414 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
40418 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
40419 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
40420 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
40421 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
40422 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
40423 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
40424 parameters are for.
40426 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
40427 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
40428 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
40430 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
40432 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
40433 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
40434 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
40435 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
40436 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
40438 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
40439 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
40441 Eximon*background: gray94
40443 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
40444 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
40445 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
40446 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
40447 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
40448 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
40449 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
40452 Eximon*highlight: gray
40455 .cindex "admin user"
40456 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
40457 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
40459 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
40460 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
40461 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
40462 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
40463 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
40465 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
40466 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
40467 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
40468 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
40469 different parts of the display.
40474 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
40475 .cindex "stripchart"
40476 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
40477 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
40478 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
40479 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
40480 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
40481 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
40482 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
40483 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
40484 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
40486 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
40487 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
40488 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
40489 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
40491 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
40492 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
40493 to a single partition.
40495 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
40496 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
40497 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
40498 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
40499 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
40500 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
40501 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
40506 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
40507 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
40508 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
40509 .cindex "window size"
40510 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
40511 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
40512 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
40513 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
40514 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
40515 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
40517 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
40518 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
40519 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
40520 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
40522 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
40523 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
40524 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
40525 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
40526 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
40527 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40529 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
40530 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
40531 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40535 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
40536 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
40537 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
40538 the main log is maintained.
40539 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
40540 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
40541 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
40542 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
40543 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
40545 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
40546 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
40547 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
40548 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
40549 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
40550 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
40551 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
40552 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
40553 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
40554 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
40555 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40557 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
40558 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
40559 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
40560 It cannot go further back up the log.
40562 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
40563 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
40564 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
40565 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
40566 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
40567 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
40569 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
40570 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
40571 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
40572 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
40573 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
40574 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
40576 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
40577 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
40578 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
40579 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
40580 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
40581 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
40582 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
40583 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
40584 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
40589 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
40590 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
40591 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
40592 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
40593 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
40594 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
40595 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
40596 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
40597 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
40598 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
40600 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
40601 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
40602 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
40603 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
40604 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
40605 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
40606 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
40608 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
40609 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
40610 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
40611 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
40612 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
40613 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
40614 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
40616 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
40617 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
40618 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
40619 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
40621 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
40622 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
40623 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
40624 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
40625 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
40626 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
40627 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
40630 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
40631 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
40633 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
40634 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
40635 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
40636 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
40637 display is updated.
40641 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
40642 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
40643 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
40644 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
40645 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
40648 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
40649 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
40650 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
40651 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
40652 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
40654 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
40656 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
40660 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
40661 in a new text window.
40663 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
40664 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
40665 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
40667 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
40668 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
40669 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
40670 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
40672 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
40673 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
40674 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
40675 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
40676 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
40678 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
40679 that the message be frozen.
40681 .cindex "thawing messages"
40682 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
40683 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
40684 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
40685 that the message be thawed.
40687 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
40688 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
40689 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
40690 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
40692 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
40693 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
40696 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
40697 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
40698 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
40699 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
40700 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
40701 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
40702 which case no action is taken.
40704 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
40705 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
40706 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
40707 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
40708 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
40709 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
40710 case no action is taken.
40712 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
40713 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
40715 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
40716 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
40717 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
40718 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
40719 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
40720 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
40721 the address is qualified with that domain.
40724 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
40725 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
40726 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
40727 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
40728 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
40729 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
40730 if no output is generated.
40732 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
40733 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
40734 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
40735 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
40737 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
40738 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
40739 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
40746 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40747 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40749 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
40750 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
40751 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
40752 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
40754 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
40755 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
40756 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
40757 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
40758 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
40759 its security as compared with other MTAs.
40761 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
40762 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
40763 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
40764 as soon as possible.
40767 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
40768 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
40769 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
40770 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
40771 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
40772 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
40775 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
40776 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
40777 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
40778 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
40779 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
40780 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
40782 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
40783 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
40784 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
40785 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
40788 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
40789 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
40790 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
40791 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
40792 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
40793 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
40794 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
40795 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
40796 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
40800 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
40801 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
40802 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
40803 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
40804 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
40805 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
40806 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
40808 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
40811 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
40812 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
40813 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
40814 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
40815 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
40820 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
40822 .cindex "root privilege"
40823 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
40824 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
40825 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
40826 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
40827 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
40828 is required for two things:
40831 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
40832 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
40835 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
40836 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
40840 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
40841 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
40842 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
40843 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
40844 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
40845 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
40846 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
40847 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
40849 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
40850 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
40851 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
40853 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
40854 uid and gid in the following cases:
40859 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
40860 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
40861 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
40862 the calling process.
40863 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
40864 option may not be used at all.
40865 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
40866 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
40867 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
40872 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
40873 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
40876 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
40877 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
40878 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
40879 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
40880 testing address verification
40883 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
40886 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
40887 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
40890 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
40893 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
40894 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
40895 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
40896 will be used during message reception.
40898 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
40899 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
40901 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
40902 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
40903 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
40904 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
40905 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
40906 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
40907 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
40908 generating bounce and warning messages.
40910 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
40911 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
40912 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
40913 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
40915 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
40916 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
40922 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
40923 .cindex "privilege, running without"
40924 .cindex "unprivileged running"
40925 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
40926 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
40927 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
40928 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
40929 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
40930 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
40931 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
40935 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
40936 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
40937 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
40938 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
40940 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
40941 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
40942 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
40943 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
40944 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
40946 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
40947 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
40948 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
40951 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
40952 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
40953 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
40955 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
40956 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
40957 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
40958 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
40959 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
40960 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
40961 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
40962 address this problem at this time.
40964 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
40965 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
40966 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
40967 be used in the most straightforward way.
40969 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
40970 number of restrictions on what you can do:
40973 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
40974 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
40975 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
40976 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
40977 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
40979 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
40980 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
40982 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
40983 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
40984 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
40985 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
40987 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
40988 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
40991 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
40992 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
40993 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
40995 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
40996 owned by the Exim user.
40998 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
40999 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
41000 mailboxes need to be created manually.
41005 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
41006 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
41007 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
41008 gives more security at essentially no cost.
41010 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
41011 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
41016 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
41017 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
41018 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
41022 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
41023 .cindex "security" "local commands"
41024 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
41025 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
41026 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
41027 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
41028 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
41031 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
41032 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
41033 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
41034 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
41035 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
41037 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
41038 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
41039 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
41040 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
41041 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
41042 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
41043 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
41045 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
41046 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
41047 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
41049 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
41050 taint checking might apply to their usage.
41052 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
41053 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
41054 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
41056 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
41057 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
41058 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
41060 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
41061 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
41062 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
41063 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
41069 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
41070 .cindex "security" "data sources"
41071 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
41072 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
41073 .cindex "PCRE2" "security"
41074 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
41075 are some issues to be aware of:
41078 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
41080 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
41082 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
41083 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE2. Be aware of what
41084 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
41085 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
41086 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
41087 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
41090 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
41091 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
41092 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
41094 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
41095 expected to yield one result.
41101 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
41102 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
41103 .cindex "IP source routing"
41104 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
41105 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
41106 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
41107 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
41111 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
41112 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
41113 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
41118 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
41119 .cindex "trusted users"
41120 .cindex "admin user"
41121 .cindex "privileged user"
41122 .cindex "user" "trusted"
41123 .cindex "user" "admin"
41124 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
41125 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
41126 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
41127 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
41128 permit a remote host to be specified.
41131 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
41132 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
41133 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
41134 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
41135 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
41136 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
41138 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
41139 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
41140 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
41141 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
41142 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
41144 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
41145 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
41146 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
41147 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
41148 includes the contents of files on the spool.
41152 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
41153 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
41154 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
41155 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
41156 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
41157 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
41159 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
41160 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
41161 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
41162 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
41163 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
41164 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
41167 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
41168 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
41169 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
41170 This affects most of the checking options,
41171 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
41174 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
41175 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
41176 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
41177 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
41178 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
41179 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
41183 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
41184 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
41185 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
41186 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
41187 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
41192 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
41193 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
41194 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
41195 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
41200 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
41201 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
41202 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
41203 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
41204 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
41208 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
41209 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
41210 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
41214 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
41215 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
41216 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
41217 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
41218 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
41219 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
41220 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
41222 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
41223 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
41228 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
41229 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
41230 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
41231 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
41235 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
41236 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
41237 enough to hold the result.
41238 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
41243 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41244 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41246 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
41247 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
41248 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
41249 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
41250 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
41251 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
41252 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
41253 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
41254 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
41255 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
41256 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
41257 themselves are recoverable.
41259 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
41260 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
41261 and should not be used as such.
41263 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
41264 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
41265 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
41268 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
41269 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
41270 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
41271 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
41272 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
41274 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
41275 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
41276 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
41277 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
41279 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
41281 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
41284 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
41286 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
41287 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
41288 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
41289 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
41290 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
41291 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
41292 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
41293 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
41296 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
41297 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
41298 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
41299 relics of crashes and can be removed.
41301 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
41302 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
41303 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
41304 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
41305 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
41306 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
41307 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
41308 normally the Exim user.
41310 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
41311 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
41312 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
41313 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
41314 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
41315 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
41316 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
41317 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
41319 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
41320 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
41321 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
41322 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
41324 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen.
41325 These contain variables, can appear in any
41326 order, and are omitted when not relevant.
41328 If there is a second hyphen after the first,
41329 the corresponding data is tainted.
41330 If there is a value in parentheses, the data is quoted for a lookup.
41332 The following word specifies a variable,
41333 and the remainder of the item depends on the variable.
41336 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41337 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
41338 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
41339 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
41340 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
41341 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
41342 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
41343 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
41344 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
41347 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41348 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
41349 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
41350 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41351 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41352 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41354 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41355 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
41356 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
41357 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41358 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41359 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41361 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
41362 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
41363 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
41365 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
41366 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
41367 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
41368 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
41369 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
41371 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
41372 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
41373 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
41374 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
41375 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
41377 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
41378 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
41379 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
41381 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
41382 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
41383 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
41385 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
41386 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
41387 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
41389 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
41390 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
41391 present if the number is greater than zero.
41393 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
41394 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
41395 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
41397 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
41398 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
41399 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
41401 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
41402 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
41405 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
41406 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
41407 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
41410 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
41411 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
41412 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
41413 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
41415 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
41416 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
41417 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
41419 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
41420 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
41421 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
41422 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
41423 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
41424 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
41426 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
41427 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
41428 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
41429 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
41430 supplied by the remote host, if any.
41432 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
41433 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
41434 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
41435 generated messages.
41438 The message is from a local sender.
41440 .vitem &%-localerror%&
41441 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
41443 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
41444 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
41445 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
41446 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
41448 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
41449 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
41450 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
41453 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
41454 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
41457 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
41458 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
41459 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
41461 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
41462 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
41463 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
41465 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
41466 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
41467 of &$spam_score_int$&.
41469 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
41470 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
41471 rather than Unix-format.
41472 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
41473 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
41475 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
41476 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
41477 certificate was verified by the server.
41479 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
41480 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
41481 name of the cipher suite that was used.
41483 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
41484 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
41485 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
41489 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
41490 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
41491 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
41492 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
41493 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
41494 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
41495 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
41496 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
41497 addresses are complete.
41499 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
41500 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
41501 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
41502 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
41503 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
41504 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
41506 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
41507 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
41508 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41510 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
41511 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
41512 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
41513 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
41517 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41518 darcy@austen.fict.example
41520 alice@wonderland.fict.example
41522 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
41523 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
41524 line is of the following form:
41526 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
41527 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
41529 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
41530 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
41531 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
41532 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
41533 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
41534 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
41535 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
41536 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
41539 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
41540 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
41541 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
41542 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
41543 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
41547 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
41548 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
41549 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
41550 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
41551 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
41552 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
41553 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
41554 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
41555 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
41556 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
41559 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
41560 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
41561 typical set of headers:
41563 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
41564 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41565 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
41566 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
41567 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
41568 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
41569 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
41570 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41571 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
41572 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41573 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41575 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
41576 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
41577 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
41578 .ecindex IIDforspo1
41579 .ecindex IIDforspo2
41580 .ecindex IIDforspo3
41582 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
41583 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
41584 an ASCII newline character.
41585 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
41586 can have an alternate format.
41587 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
41588 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
41589 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
41590 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
41591 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
41592 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
41594 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41595 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41597 .chapter "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
41598 "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC Support"
41600 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
41603 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
41604 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
41605 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
41606 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
41608 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
41609 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
41610 any original DKIM signature.
41612 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
41613 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41615 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
41617 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
41618 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
41619 (including transport filters) except cutthrough delivery.
41621 However, signing options may not depend on headers modified by
41622 routers, the transport or a transport filter.
41625 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
41626 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
41627 different signature contexts.
41630 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
41631 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
41632 Exim's standard controls.
41634 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
41635 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
41637 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
41638 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
41639 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
41640 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
41642 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
41643 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
41644 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
41645 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
41648 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
41649 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
41650 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
41651 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
41655 .subsection "Signing outgoing messages" SECDKIMSIGN
41656 .cindex DKIM signing
41658 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
41659 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
41661 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41663 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41664 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
41667 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
41668 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
41669 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
41670 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
41671 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
41673 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
41674 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
41676 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
41677 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
41678 After expansion, this can be a list.
41679 Each element in turn,
41681 .vindex "&$dkim_domain$&"
41682 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
41683 while expanding the remaining signing options.
41684 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
41685 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
41687 .option dkim_selector smtp "string list&!!" unset
41688 This sets the key selector string.
41689 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
41690 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
41691 .vindex "&$dkim_selector$&"
41692 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
41693 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
41694 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
41695 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
41697 To do, for example, dual-signing with RSA and EC keys
41698 this could be be used:
41700 dkim_selector = ec_sel : rsa_sel
41701 dkim_private_key = KEYS_DIR/$dkim_selector
41704 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
41705 This sets the private key to use.
41706 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
41707 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
41708 The result can either
41710 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
41712 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
41713 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
41715 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
41718 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
41719 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
41723 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
41725 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
41726 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
41728 The result file from the first command should be retained, and
41729 this option set to use it.
41730 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
41731 for the DNS TXT record.
41732 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
41736 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
41737 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
41740 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41742 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41743 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
41746 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
41747 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
41748 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
41749 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
41750 for some transition period.
41751 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
41754 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
41756 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
41757 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
41760 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
41762 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
41763 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
41766 Exim also supports an alternate format
41767 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
41768 of the standard, but not adopted.
41769 A future release will probably drop that support.
41771 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
41772 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
41774 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
41776 &`sha256`& &-- the default
41778 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
41781 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41783 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41786 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
41787 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
41788 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
41789 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
41790 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
41791 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
41793 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
41794 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
41795 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
41796 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
41797 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
41799 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
41800 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
41801 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
41802 either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
41803 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
41806 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
41807 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
41808 list of header names.
41809 Headers with these names, or the absence of such a header, will be included
41810 in the message signature.
41811 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
41812 whether or not each header is present in the message.
41813 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
41814 &"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
41815 and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
41817 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
41818 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
41819 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
41821 A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
41822 If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
41824 If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
41825 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
41826 name will be appended.
41828 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
41829 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
41830 If not set, no such information will be included.
41832 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the
41833 current time for the expiry tag (e.g. 1209600 for two weeks); both creation
41834 (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included unless the offset is 0 (no expiry).
41837 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
41840 .subsection "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" SECDKIMVFY
41841 .cindex DKIM verification
41843 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
41844 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
41846 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
41847 Individual classes of DKIM signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
41848 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
41849 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
41850 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
41852 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
41853 Performing verification sets up information used by the
41854 &%authresults%& expansion item.
41856 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
41857 of this section can be ignored.
41859 The results of verification are made available to the
41860 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which (for complex needs) can examine and modify them.
41861 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
41862 By default, the ACL is called once for each
41863 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
41864 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
41865 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
41866 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
41868 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
41869 a large number of expansion variables
41870 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
41871 runtime of the ACL.
41873 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
41874 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
41875 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
41876 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
41878 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
41879 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
41880 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
41881 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
41882 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
41883 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
41886 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
41888 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
41889 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
41890 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
41892 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
41894 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
41895 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
41896 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
41898 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
41901 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
41902 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
41904 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
41905 (such as the From: header)
41906 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
41907 and for the domain part if identities.
41908 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
41910 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
41911 for each matching signature.
41914 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
41915 available (from most to least important):
41919 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
41920 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
41921 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
41922 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
41924 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
41925 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined
41926 (it need do no more than accept, which is the default),
41927 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
41928 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
41929 The value is maintained for the MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
41931 Within the DKIM ACL,
41932 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
41934 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
41935 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
41937 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
41938 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
41940 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
41941 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
41943 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
41946 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
41947 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
41948 hash-method or key-size:
41950 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
41951 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
41952 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
41953 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
41954 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
41955 set dkim_verify_status = fail
41956 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
41959 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
41960 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
41961 "fail" or "invalid". One of
41963 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
41964 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
41966 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
41967 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
41969 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
41970 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
41971 means that the message body was modified in transit.
41973 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
41974 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
41975 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
41976 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
41979 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
41981 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
41982 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
41983 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
41984 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
41986 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
41987 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
41988 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
41989 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
41991 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
41992 The key record selector string.
41994 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
41995 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
41996 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
41997 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
41998 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
42001 Note that RFC 8301 says:
42003 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42005 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
42006 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
42009 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
42010 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
42011 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
42012 processing of such signatures.
42014 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
42015 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42017 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
42018 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42020 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
42021 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
42022 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
42023 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
42024 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
42025 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
42027 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
42028 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
42029 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
42030 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
42031 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
42032 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
42033 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
42034 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
42036 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
42037 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
42038 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
42040 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
42041 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
42042 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
42043 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
42044 integer size comparisons against this value.
42045 Note that Exim does not check this value.
42047 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
42048 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
42050 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
42051 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
42053 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
42054 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
42056 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
42057 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42060 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
42061 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42064 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
42065 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
42067 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
42068 Number of bits in the key.
42069 Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
42070 is verified, which is after the body hash is.
42072 Note that RFC 8301 says:
42074 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
42075 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
42078 This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
42083 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
42086 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
42087 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
42088 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
42089 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42090 This condition is only usable in a DKIM ACL.
42091 This is typically used to restrict an ACL
42092 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
42095 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
42096 warn sender_domains = gmail.com
42097 dkim_signers = gmail.com
42099 log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
42102 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
42103 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
42105 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
42106 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
42107 results against the actual result of verification,
42108 given by &$dkim_verify_status$& if that is non-empty or "none" if empty.
42110 This condition may be used in DKIM, MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42113 A basic verification might be:
42115 deny !dkim_status = pass:none:invalid
42118 A more complex use could be
42119 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
42122 deny sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
42123 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
42124 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
42125 message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
42128 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
42129 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
42130 for more information of what they mean.
42132 The condition is true if the status
42134 (or any of the list of status values)
42136 is any one of the supplied list.
42142 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
42143 .cindex SPF verification
42145 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
42146 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
42147 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
42148 the &url(http://openspf.org).
42149 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
42150 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
42151 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
42154 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
42155 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
42157 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
42158 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
42159 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
42160 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
42161 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
42163 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
42164 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42165 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42166 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42169 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42170 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
42171 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
42172 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
42173 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
42177 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
42180 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
42181 domain in the envelope-from address.
42183 .vitem &%softfail%&
42184 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
42188 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
42191 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
42192 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
42193 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
42195 .vitem &%permerror%&
42196 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
42197 You may deny messages when this occurs.
42199 .vitem &%temperror%&
42200 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
42201 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
42204 There was an error during processing of the SPF lookup
42207 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
42208 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
42209 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
42210 short-circuit fashion.
42215 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
42216 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
42217 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
42218 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why;\
42219 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
42220 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
42221 ip=$sender_host_address
42224 Note: The above mentioned URL may not be as helpful as expected. You are
42225 encouraged to replace the link with a link to a site with more
42228 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
42231 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
42233 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
42234 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
42235 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
42236 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
42237 it for logging purposes.
42239 .vitem &$spf_received$&
42240 .vindex &$spf_received$&
42241 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header (name and
42242 content) that can be added to the message. Please note that
42243 according to the SPF draft, this header must be added at the
42244 top of the header list, i.e. with
42246 add_header = :at_start:$spf_received
42248 See section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>& for further details.
42250 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
42251 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
42253 .vitem &$spf_result$&
42254 .vindex &$spf_result$&
42255 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
42256 currently one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror,
42257 temperror, or &"(invalid)"&.
42259 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
42260 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
42261 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
42262 and required in order to obtain a result.
42264 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42265 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42266 .vindex &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&
42267 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
42268 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
42269 The string is generated by the SPF library from the template configured in the main config
42270 option &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&.
42274 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42275 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
42276 .cindex SPF "best guess"
42277 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
42278 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
42279 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
42281 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
42282 for a description of what it means.
42283 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
42285 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
42286 of the spf one. For example:
42289 deny spf_guess = fail
42290 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
42293 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
42294 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
42295 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
42298 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
42299 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
42301 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
42302 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
42303 &%spf_guess%& option.
42304 For example, the following:
42307 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
42310 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
42313 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
42315 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
42316 address as the key and an IP address
42321 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
42324 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
42325 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
42331 .subsection "SRS (Sender Rewriting Scheme)" SECTSRS
42332 .cindex SRS "sender rewriting scheme"
42333 .cindex VERP "variable envelope return path"
42335 SRS can be used to modify sender addresses when forwarding so that
42336 SPF verification does not object to them.
42337 It can also be used to identify a received bounce message as
42338 likely (or not) having been trigged by a message from the
42339 local system, and for identifying dead addresses in mailing lists.
42340 It is one implementation of a VERP (Variable Envelope Return Path) method.
42342 SRS operates by encoding the original envelope sender in a new
42343 sender local part and using a domain run by the forwarding site
42344 as the new domain for the sender. Any DSN message should be returned
42345 to this new sender at the forwarding site, which can extract the
42346 original sender from the coded local part and forward the DSN to
42349 This is a way of avoiding the breakage that SPF does to forwarding.
42350 The constructed local-part will be longer than the original,
42351 leading to possible problems with very long addresses.
42352 The changing of the sender address also hinders the tracing of mail
42355 Exim can be built to include native SRS support. To do this
42356 SUPPORT_SRS=yes must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&.
42357 If this has been done, the macros _HAVE_SRS and _HAVE_NATIVE_SRS
42359 The support is limited to SRS0-encoding; SRS1 is not supported.
42361 .cindex SRS excoding
42362 To encode an address use this expansion item:
42364 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
42365 .cindex "&%srs_encode%& expansion item"
42366 .cindex SRS "expansion item"
42367 The first argument should be a secret known and used by all systems
42368 handling the recipient domain for the original message.
42369 There is no need to periodically change this key; a timestamp is also
42371 The second argument should be given as the envelope sender address before this
42372 encoding operation.
42373 If this value is empty the the expansion result will be empty.
42374 The third argument should be the recipient domain of the message when
42375 it arrived at this system.
42376 All arguments are expanded before use.
42378 The result of the expansion is the replacement envelope-from (return path)
42382 .cindex SRS decoding
42383 To decode an address use this expansion condition:
42385 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
42386 The first argument should be the recipient local part as it was received.
42387 The second argument is the site secret.
42388 Both arguments are expanded before use.
42390 If the messages is not for an SRS-encoded recipient the condition will
42392 If it is, the condition will return true and the variable
42393 &$srs_recipient$& will be set to the decoded (original) value.
42395 If the second argument is empty then the condition returns true if
42396 the first argument is in valid SRS formet, else false.
42397 The variable &$srs_recipient$& is not set for this case.
42403 SRS_SECRET = <pick something unique for your site for this. Use on all MXs.>
42409 # if outbound, and forwarding has been done, use an alternate transport
42410 domains = ! +my_domains
42411 transport = ${if eq {$local_part@$domain} \
42412 {$original_local_part@$original_domain} \
42413 {remote_smtp} {remote_forwarded_smtp}}
42418 domains = +my_domains
42419 # detect inbound bounces which are SRS'd, and decode them
42420 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {SRS_SECRET}}
42421 data = $srs_recipient
42423 inbound_srs_failure:
42426 domains = +my_domains
42427 # detect inbound bounces which look SRS'd but are invalid
42428 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {}}
42430 data = :fail: Invalid SRS recipient address
42432 #... further routers here get inbound_srs-redirected recipients
42433 # and any that were not SRS'd
42436 # transport; should look like the non-forward outbound
42437 # one, plus the max_rcpt and return_path options
42438 remote_forwarded_smtp:
42440 # single-recipient so that $original_domain is valid
42442 # modify the envelope from, for mails that we forward
42443 return_path = ${srs_encode {SRS_SECRET} {$return_path} {$original_domain}}
42450 .section DMARC SECDMARC
42451 .cindex DMARC verification
42453 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
42454 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
42455 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
42456 should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
42457 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
42459 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
42460 the libopendmarc library is used.
42462 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
42463 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
42464 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
42465 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
42466 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
42467 This description assumes
42468 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
42469 are in /usr/local/lib.
42471 .subsection Configuration SSECDMARCCONFIG
42472 .cindex DMARC configuration
42474 There are three main-configuration options:
42475 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
42477 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
42478 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
42479 defines the location of a text file of valid
42480 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
42481 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
42482 the most current version can be downloaded
42483 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
42484 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
42485 The default for the option is unset.
42486 If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
42489 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
42490 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
42491 defines the location of a file to log results
42492 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
42493 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
42494 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
42495 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
42496 directory of this file is writable by the user
42498 The default is unset.
42500 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
42501 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42502 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
42503 forensic report detailing alignment failures
42504 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
42505 and you have configured Exim to send them.
42506 If set, this is expanded and used for the
42507 From: header line; the address is extracted
42508 from it and used for the envelope from.
42509 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
42510 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
42513 .subsection Controls SSECDMARCCONTROLS
42514 .cindex DMARC controls
42516 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
42517 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
42518 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
42519 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
42520 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
42521 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
42523 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42525 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
42526 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
42527 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
42528 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
42529 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
42530 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
42531 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
42532 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
42533 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
42534 construction might be inadequate.
42536 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42538 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
42539 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
42540 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
42543 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
42546 .subsection ACL SSECDMARCACL
42547 .cindex DMARC "ACL condition"
42549 DMARC checks can be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
42550 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
42551 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
42552 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
42553 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
42554 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
42555 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
42557 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
42558 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
42559 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
42560 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
42561 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
42562 .irow &'accept'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email"
42563 .irow &'reject'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email"
42564 .irow &'quarantine'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection"
42565 .irow &'none'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral"
42566 .irow &'norecord'& "No policy section in the DMARC record for this RFC5322.From field"
42567 .irow &'nofrom'& "Unable to determine the domain of the sender"
42568 .irow &'temperror'& "Library error or dns error"
42569 .irow &'off'& "The DMARC check was disabled for this email"
42571 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
42572 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
42573 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
42574 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
42575 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
42576 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
42579 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
42580 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
42581 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
42583 Performing the check sets up information used by the
42584 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42586 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
42587 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
42588 expansion variables are available:
42591 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
42592 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
42593 .cindex DMARC result
42594 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
42595 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
42596 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
42597 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
42598 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
42600 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
42601 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
42602 Slightly longer, human readable status.
42604 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
42605 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
42606 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
42608 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
42609 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
42610 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
42611 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
42612 is any error, including no DMARC record.
42615 .subsection Logging SSECDMARCLOGGING
42616 .cindex DMARC logging
42618 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
42619 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
42620 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
42621 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
42622 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
42623 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
42624 processing or failure delivery issues).
42626 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
42627 tools, you need to:
42629 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
42631 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
42632 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
42635 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
42637 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42639 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
42640 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
42643 .subsection Example SSECDMARCEXAMPLE
42644 .cindex DMARC example
42649 warn domains = +local_domains
42650 hosts = +local_hosts
42651 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42653 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
42654 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42656 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
42657 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
42660 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
42662 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
42664 warn dmarc_status = !accept
42666 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
42668 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
42670 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
42671 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
42673 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
42674 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
42675 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
42677 deny dmarc_status = reject
42679 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
42681 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
42688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42689 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42691 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
42693 .cindex "proxy support"
42694 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
42696 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
42697 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
42700 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
42701 .cindex proxy inbound
42702 .cindex proxy "server side"
42703 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
42704 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
42706 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
42707 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
42708 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
42711 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
42712 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
42714 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
42715 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
42716 to distribute load.
42717 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
42718 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
42719 There is no logging if a host passes or
42720 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
42721 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
42723 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
42724 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
42725 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
42726 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
42727 automatically determines which version is in use.
42729 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
42730 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
42731 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
42732 Exim and the proxy server. The Proxy Protocol header must be received
42733 within &%proxy_protocol_timeout%&, which defaults to 3s.
42735 The following expansion variables are usable
42736 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
42738 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
42739 .irow $proxy_external_address "IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy"
42740 .irow $proxy_external_port "Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy"
42741 .irow $proxy_local_address "IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy"
42742 .irow $proxy_local_port "Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy"
42743 .irow $proxy_session "boolean: SMTP connection via proxy"
42745 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
42746 there was a protocol error.
42747 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
42748 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
42750 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
42751 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
42752 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
42753 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
42754 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
42755 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
42756 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
42757 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
42758 A possible solution is:
42760 # Set max number of connections per host
42762 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
42763 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
42765 defer ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
42766 message = Too many connections from this IP right now
42771 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
42772 .cindex proxy outbound
42773 .cindex proxy "client side"
42774 .cindex proxy SOCKS
42775 .cindex SOCKS proxy
42776 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
42777 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
42778 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
42781 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
42782 on an smtp transport.
42783 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
42784 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
42785 Each proxy specifier is a list
42786 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
42787 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
42789 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
42790 The list of options is in the following table:
42791 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
42792 .irow &'auth'& "authentication method"
42793 .irow &'name'& "authentication username"
42794 .irow &'pass'& "authentication password"
42795 .irow &'port'& "tcp port"
42796 .irow &'tmo'& "connection timeout"
42797 .irow &'pri'& "priority"
42798 .irow &'weight'& "selection bias"
42801 More details on each of these options follows:
42804 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
42805 .cindex proxy authentication
42806 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
42807 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
42808 for access to the proxy.
42809 Default is &"none"&.
42811 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
42814 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
42817 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
42820 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
42823 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
42824 higher values being tried first.
42825 The default priority is 1.
42827 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
42828 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
42829 weighted by this value.
42830 The default value for selection bias is 1.
42833 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
42834 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
42835 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
42837 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
42838 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
42839 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
42840 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
42842 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42843 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42845 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
42846 "Internationalisation""
42847 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
42850 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
42852 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
42853 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
42854 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
42856 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
42857 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
42858 requirement, upon libidn2.
42860 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
42861 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
42862 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
42863 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
42864 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
42865 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
42866 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
42868 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
42869 international handling for the message is enabled and
42870 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
42872 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
42873 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
42874 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
42875 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
42877 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
42878 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
42879 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
42880 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
42882 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
42883 components expanded to a-label form,
42884 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
42887 .cindex log protocol
42888 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
42889 .cindex i18n logging
42890 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
42891 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
42893 The following expansion operators can be used:
42895 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
42896 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
42897 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
42898 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
42901 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
42902 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
42904 may use the following modifier:
42906 control = utf8_downconvert
42907 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
42909 This sets a flag requiring that envelope addresses are converted to
42910 a-label form before smtp delivery.
42911 This is usually for use in a Message Submission Agent context,
42912 but could be used for any message.
42914 If a value is appended it may be:
42915 .itable none 0 0 2 5* right 95* left
42916 .irow &`1`& "mandatory downconversion"
42917 .irow &`0`& "no downconversion"
42918 .irow &`-1`& "if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host"
42920 If no value is given, 1 is used.
42922 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
42923 is initially set to -1.
42925 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
42926 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
42927 or an empty string.
42928 If non-empty it overrides value previously set
42929 (due to mua_wrapper or by an ACL control).
42932 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
42933 Configurations supporting these should inspect
42934 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
42936 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
42937 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
42938 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
42940 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
42941 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
42945 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
42946 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
42947 the following expansion operator can be used:
42949 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
42952 The string is converted from the charset specified by
42953 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
42954 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
42956 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
42957 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
42958 (which has to be a single character)
42959 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
42960 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
42962 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
42963 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
42965 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
42966 by many other IMAP servers.
42970 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
42971 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
42972 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
42975 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
42976 must be representable in UTF-16.
42979 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42980 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42982 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
42986 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
42987 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
42988 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
42989 processing actions.
42991 Most installations will never need to use Events.
42992 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
42993 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
42995 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
42996 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
42997 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
42999 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
43000 An example might look like:
43001 .cindex logging custom
43003 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
43004 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
43005 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
43006 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
43007 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
43008 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
43009 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
43010 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
43011 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
43015 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
43016 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
43017 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
43019 The current list of events is:
43020 .itable all 0 0 4 25* left 10* center 15* center 50* left
43021 .row auth:fail after both "per driver per authentication attempt"
43022 .row dane:fail after transport "per connection"
43023 .row dns:fail after both "per lookup"
43024 .row msg:complete after main "per message"
43025 .row msg:defer after transport "per message per delivery try"
43026 .row msg:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43027 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport "per recipient per host"
43028 .row msg:rcpt:defer after transport "per recipient"
43029 .row msg:host:defer after transport "per host per delivery try; host errors"
43030 .row msg:fail:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43031 .row msg:fail:internal after main "per recipient"
43032 .row tcp:connect before transport "per connection"
43033 .row tcp:close after transport "per connection"
43034 .row tls:cert before both "per certificate in verification chain"
43035 .row tls:fail:connect after main "per connection"
43036 .row smtp:connect after transport "per connection"
43037 .row smtp:ehlo after transport "per connection"
43039 New event types may be added in future.
43041 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
43042 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
43043 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
43045 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
43046 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
43047 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
43049 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
43050 should define the event action.
43052 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
43053 with the event type:
43054 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43055 .row auth:fail "smtp response"
43056 .row dane:fail "failure reason"
43057 .row dns:fail "failure reason, key and lookup-type"
43058 .row msg:defer "error string"
43059 .row msg:delivery "smtp confirmation message"
43060 .row msg:fail:internal "failure reason"
43061 .row msg:fail:delivery "smtp error message"
43062 .row msg:host:defer "error string"
43063 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer "error string"
43064 .row msg:rcpt:defer "error string"
43065 .row tls:cert "verification chain depth"
43066 .row tls:fail:connect "error string"
43067 .row smtp:connect "smtp banner"
43068 .row smtp:ehlo "smtp ehlo response"
43071 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
43073 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&,
43074 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
43075 the course of its processing:
43077 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
43080 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
43081 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
43083 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
43084 a useful way of writing to the main log.
43086 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
43087 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
43088 following will be forced:
43089 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43090 .row auth:fail "log information to write"
43091 .row tcp:connect "do not connect"
43092 .row tls:cert "refuse verification"
43093 .row smtp:connect "close connection"
43095 All other message types ignore the result string, and
43096 no other use is made of it.
43098 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
43099 then the &$host_address$& and &$host_port$& variables
43100 will be that of the proxy and not the target system.
43102 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
43103 chain element received on the connection.
43104 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
43107 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43108 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43110 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
43111 "Adding drivers or lookups"
43112 .cindex "adding drivers"
43113 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
43114 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
43115 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
43116 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
43119 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
43120 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
43122 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
43124 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
43126 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
43127 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
43128 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
43130 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
43132 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
43135 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
43136 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
43138 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
43139 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
43140 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
43141 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
43142 simple form that most lookups have.
43144 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
43145 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
43146 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
43148 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
43149 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
43151 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
43154 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
43155 as for other drivers and lookups.
43158 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
43159 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
43160 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
43161 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
43162 searched using a binary chop procedure.
43164 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
43165 the interface that is expected.
43170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43171 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43173 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43174 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
43175 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
43176 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
43178 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43183 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
43184 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
43188 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
43189 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
43190 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
43193 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43194 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////